Mazda Automobile 2008 CX 7 User Manual

CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page1  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (1,1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page3  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (3,1)  
AWord to Mazda Owners  
Thank you for choosing a Mazda. We at Mazda design and build vehicles with complete  
customer satisfaction in mind.  
To help ensure enjoyable and trouble-free operation of your Mazda, read this manual  
carefully and follow its recommendations.  
An Authorized Mazda Dealer knows your vehicle best. So when maintenance or service is  
necessary, that's the place to go.  
Our nationwide network of Mazda professionals is dedicated to providing you with the best  
possible service.  
We assure you that all of us at Mazda have an ongoing interest in your motoring pleasure  
and in your full satisfaction with your Mazda product.  
Mazda Motor Corporation  
HIROSHIMA, JAPAN  
Important Notes About This Manual  
Keep this manual in the glove box as a handy reference for the safe and enjoyable use of your Mazda. Should you  
resell the vehicle, leave this manual with it for the next owner.  
All specifications and descriptions are accurate at the time of printing. Because improvement is a constant goal at  
Mazda, we reserve the right to make changes in specifications at any time without notice and without obligation.  
Event Data Recorder  
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder. In the event of a crash, this device records data related to  
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time. These data can help provide a better  
understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur and lead to the designing of safer  
vehicles.  
Air Conditioning and the Environment  
Your Mazda's genuine air conditioner is filled with HFC134a (R134a), a refrigerant that has been found not to  
damage the earth's ozone layer. If the air conditioner does not operate properly, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
Perchlorate  
Certain components of this vehicle such as [air bag modules, seat belt pretensioners, lithium batteries, ...] may  
contain Perchlorate MaterialSpecial handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal. See  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
Please be aware that this manual applies to all models, equipment and options. As a result, you may find  
some explanations for equipment not installed on your vehicle.  
©2007 Mazda Motor Corporation  
Printed in Japan Aug. 2007(Print3)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page4  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (4,1)  
How to Use This Manual  
We want to help you get the most driving  
pleasure from your vehicle. Your owner's  
manual, when read from cover to cover,  
can do that in many ways.  
NOTE  
A NOTE provides information and sometimes  
suggests how to make better use of your  
vehicle.  
The symbol below, located on some parts  
of the vehicle, indicates that this manual  
contains information related to the part.  
Please refer to the manual for a detailed  
explanation.  
Illustrations complement the words of the  
manual to best explain how to enjoy your  
Mazda. By reading your manual, you can  
find out about the features, important  
safety information, and driving under  
various road conditions.  
The symbol below in this manual means  
Do not do thisor Do not let this  
happen.  
Index: A good place to start is the Index,  
an alphabetical listing of all information  
in your manual.  
You'll find several WARNINGs,  
CAUTIONs, and NOTEs in the manual.  
WARNING  
A WARNING indicates a situation in  
which serious injury or death could  
result if the warning is ignored.  
CAUTION  
A CAUTION indicates a situation in  
which bodily injury or damage to  
your vehicle, or both, could result if  
the caution is ignored.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page5  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (5,1)  
Table of Contents  
Interior, exterior views and part identification of your Mazda.  
Use of safety equipment, including seats, seat belt system, child-restraint  
systems and SRS air bags.  
Explanation of basic operations and controls; opening/closing and adjustment  
of various parts.  
Important information about driving your Mazda.  
Explanation of instruments and controls.  
Use of various features for drive comfort, including air-conditioning and audio  
system.  
Helpful information on what to do in an emergency.  
How to keep your Mazda in top condition.  
Important consumer information including warranties and add-on equipment.  
Technical information about your Mazda.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page6  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (6,1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page8  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (8,1)  
Your Vehicle at a Glance  
Interior Overview  
Interior Equipment (View A)  
1-2  
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page9  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (9,1)  
Your Vehicle at a Glance  
Interior Overview  
Interior Equipment (View B)  
Navigation system (if equipped) .......................................... Refer to the separate manual  
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page10  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (10,1)  
Your Vehicle at a Glance  
Interior Overview  
Interior Equipment (View C)  
Navigation system (if equipped) .......................................... Refer to the separate manual  
1-4  
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page13  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (13,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
2
Use of safety equipment, including seats, seat belt system, child-restraint  
systems and SRS air bags.  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page14  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (14,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Make sure the adjustable components  
of a seat are locked in place:  
Front Seats (Manually  
Operated Seats)  
Adjustable seats and seatbacks that  
are not securely locked are  
dangerous. In a sudden stop or  
collision, the seat or seatback could  
move, causing injury. Make sure the  
adjustable components of the seat  
are locked in place by attempting to  
slide the seat forward and backward  
and rocking the seatback.  
WARNING  
Do not modify or replace the front  
seats:  
Modifying or replacing the front seats  
such as replacing the upholstery or  
loosening any bolts is dangerous. The  
front seats contain air bag  
components essential to the  
supplemental restraint system. Such  
modifications could damage the  
supplemental restraint system and  
result in serious injury. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer if there is  
any need to remove or reinstall the  
front seats.  
qSeat Slide  
WARNING  
Adjust the driver seat only when the  
vehicle is stopped:  
Adjusting the driver's seat while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous. The  
driver could lose control of the vehicle  
and have an accident.  
Do not drive with damaged front seats:  
Driving with damaged front seats is  
dangerous. A collision, even one not  
strong enough to inflate the air bags,  
could damage the front seats which  
contain essential air bag  
To move a seat forward or backward, raise  
the lever and slide the seat to the desired  
position and release the lever.  
components. If there was a  
subsequent collision, an air bag may  
not deploy which could lead to  
injuries. Always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer inspect the front seats,  
front seat belt pretensioners and air  
bags after a collision.  
Make sure the lever returns to its original  
position and the seat is locked in place by  
attempting to push it forward and  
backward.  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page15  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (15,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Do not drive with the seatback  
unlocked:  
qSeat Recline  
The seatback plays an important role  
in your protection in a vehicle.  
Leaving the seatback unlocked is  
dangerous as it can allow passengers  
to be ejected or thrown around and  
baggage to strike occupants in a  
sudden stop or collision, resulting in  
severe injury. After adjusting the  
seatback at any time, even when  
there are no other passengers, rock  
the seatback to make sure it is locked  
in place.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the seats reclined:  
Sitting in a reclined position while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous  
because you don't get the full  
protection from seat belts. During  
sudden braking or a collision, you  
can slide under the lap belt and  
suffer serious internal injuries. For  
maximum protection, sit well back  
and upright.  
Always sit in a passenger seat properly  
with the seatback upright and feet on  
the floor:  
To change the seatback angle, lean  
forward slightly while raising the lever.  
Then lean back to the desired position and  
release the lever.  
If your vehicle is equipped with front  
passenger seat weight sensors,  
sitting in the front passenger seat  
improperly out of position or with the  
seatback reclined too far while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous as it  
can take off weight from the seat  
bottom and affect the weight  
determination of the front passenger  
sensing system. As a result the front  
passenger will not have the  
supplementary protection of the air  
bag and seat belt pretensioner, which  
could cause result in serious injury.  
Always sit upright against your  
seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
Make sure the lever returns to its original  
position and the seatback is locked in  
place by attempting to push it forward and  
backward.  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page16  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (16,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Height adjustment  
CAUTION  
When returning a rear-reclined  
seatback to its upright position,  
make sure you hold onto the  
seatback with your other hand while  
operating the lever. If the seatback is  
not supported, it will flip forward  
suddenly and could cause injury.  
To raise a head restraint, pull it up to the  
desired position.  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
q
Height Adjustment (Driver's Seat)  
By moving the seat lever up or down, the  
seat bottom height can be adjusted.  
Up  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top is  
even with the top of the passenger's ears,  
never the passenger's neck to prevent  
injury.  
Down  
qSeat Warmerí  
The front seats are electrically heated. The  
ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
qHead Restraint  
WARNING  
Press the switch to turn the seat warmer  
on or off. When the switch is in the ON  
position, the indicator light will come on.  
Always drive with the head restraints  
installed when seats are being used  
and make sure they are properly  
adjusted:  
Driving with the head restraints  
adjusted too low or removed is  
dangerous. With no support behind  
your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
2-4  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page17  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (17,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
NOTE  
Front Seats (Electrically  
Operated Seats)  
The seat temperature is regulated  
automatically by a thermostat. Other than  
turning it on or off, it cannot be adjusted.  
WARNING  
Do not modify or replace the front  
seats:  
Modifying or replacing the front seats  
such as replacing the upholstery or  
loosening any bolts is dangerous. The  
front seats contain air bag  
components essential to the  
supplemental restraint system. Such  
modifications could damage the  
supplemental restraint system and  
result in serious injury. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer if there is  
any need to remove or reinstall the  
front seats.  
Do not drive with damaged front seats:  
Driving with damaged front seats is  
dangerous. A collision, even one not  
strong enough to inflate the air bags,  
could damage the front seats which  
contain essential air bag  
components. If there was a  
subsequent collision, an air bag may  
not deploy which could lead to  
injuries. Always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer inspect the front seats,  
front seat belt pretensioners and air  
bags after a collision.  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page18  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (18,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
qSeat Recline  
CAUTION  
Ø The seat-bottom power  
adjustment is operated by motors.  
Avoid extended operation because  
excessive use can damage the  
motors.  
Ø To prevent the battery from  
running down, avoid using the  
power adjustment when the  
engine is stopped. The adjuster  
uses a large amount of electrical  
power.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the seats reclined:  
Sitting in a reclined position while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous  
because you don't get the full  
protection from seat belts. During  
sudden braking or a collision, you  
can slide under the lap belt and  
suffer serious internal injuries. For  
maximum protection, sit well back  
and upright.  
Ø Don't use the switch to make more  
than one adjustment at a time.  
Always sit in a front passenger seat  
properly with the seatback upright and  
feet on the floor:  
qSeat Slide  
If your vehicle is equipped with front  
passenger seat weight sensors,  
sitting in the front passenger seat  
improperly out of position or with the  
seatback reclined too far while the  
vehicle is moving is dangerous as it  
can take off weight from the seat  
bottom and affect the weight  
To slide the seat, move the slide lifter  
switch on the outside of the seat to the  
front or back and hold it. Release the  
switch at the desired position.  
determination of the front passenger  
sensing system. As a result the front  
passenger will not have the  
supplementary protection of the air  
bag and seat belt pretensioner, which  
could cause result in serious injury.  
Always sit upright against your  
seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page19  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:16 PM  
Black plate (19,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Change the seatback angle by pressing the  
front or rear side of the reclining switch.  
Release the switch at the desired position.  
qLumbar Support Adjustment  
To increase the seat firmness, pull the  
lever forward. Push the lever backward to  
decrease firmness.  
qHeight Adjustment  
The seat height can be adjusted by  
moving the switch up or down.  
qHead Restraint  
WARNING  
Always drive with the head restraints  
installed when seats are being used  
and make sure they are properly  
adjusted:  
Driving with the head restraints  
adjusted too low or removed is  
dangerous. With no support behind  
your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page20  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (20,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Height adjustment  
NOTE  
The seat temperature is regulated  
automatically by a thermostat. Other than  
turning it on or off, it cannot be adjusted.  
To raise a head restraint, pull it up to the  
desired position.  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top is  
even with the top of the passenger's ears,  
never the passenger's neck to prevent  
injury.  
qSeat Warmerí  
The front seats are electrically heated. The  
ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
Press the switch to turn the seat warmer  
on or off. When the switch is in the ON  
position, the indicator light will come on.  
2-8  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page21  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (21,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
Never allow a passenger to sit or stand  
on the folded seatback while the  
vehicle is moving:  
Rear Seat  
WARNING  
Do not stack cargo higher than the  
seatbacks:  
Driving with a passenger on the  
folded seatback is dangerous.  
Allowing a child to sit up on the  
folded seatback while the vehicle is  
moving is particularly dangerous. In  
a sudden stop or even a minor  
collision, a child not in a proper seat  
or child-restraint system and seat  
belt could be thrown forward, back  
or even out of the vehicle resulting in  
serious injuries or death. The child in  
the baggage area could be thrown  
into other occupants and cause  
serious injury.  
Stacking luggage or other cargo  
higher than the seatbacks, and  
placing articles on the rear seat is  
dangerous. During sudden braking  
or a collision, objects can fly around  
and become projectiles that may hit  
and injure passengers.  
Make sure luggage and cargo is  
secured before driving:  
Not securing cargo while driving is  
dangerous as it could move or be  
crushed during sudden braking or a  
collision and cause injury.  
NOTE  
When returning a rear seat to its original  
position, also replace the seat belt to its  
normal position. Verify that the seat belt pulls  
out and retracts.  
Make sure the adjustable components  
of a seat are locked in place:  
Adjustable seats that are not securely  
locked are dangerous. In a sudden  
stop or collision, the seat or seatback  
could move, causing injury.  
Do not drive with the seatback  
unlocked:  
The seatback plays an important role  
in your protection in a vehicle.  
Leaving the seatback unlocked is  
dangerous as it can allow passengers  
to be ejected or thrown around and  
baggage to strike occupants in a  
sudden stop or collision, resulting in  
severe injury. After returning the  
seatback at any time, even when  
there are no other passengers, rock  
the seatback to make sure it is locked  
in place.  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page22  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (22,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
When using the remote handle levers:  
qSplit-Folding Rear Seatback  
The seatbacks can be folded down to  
provide more space in the luggage  
compartment.  
CAUTION  
Be careful of the following when  
using the remote handle levers:  
Ø On a downward slope, the  
seatback could flip forward faster  
than on a flat area.  
To fold the seatbacks  
WARNING  
Ø On an upward slope, the seatback  
may not fold down. When the  
seatbacks cannot be folded down  
with levers, pull the rear seatback  
forward from inside the vehicle.  
Always remove the child-restraint  
system from the rear seat before  
operating the remote handle levers for  
the rear seat:  
Operating the remote handle levers  
while a rear-facing child-restraint  
system is in the rear seat is  
dangerous. It could cause injury to a  
child seated in the child-restraint  
system when the seatback suddenly  
flips forward.  
1. Unfasten the lap portion of the center-  
rear seat belt (page 2-22).  
CAUTION  
Always unfasten the lap portion of  
the belt before folding left-rear  
seatback. Leaving the lap portion of  
the belt fastened could cause  
damage to the seat belt, buckle and  
seatback.  
Make sure there is nobody in the rear  
seat area before operating the remote  
handle levers:  
Not checking the rear seat area for  
persons before folding the seatbacks  
with the remote handle levers is  
dangerous. The rear seat area is  
difficult to see from the rear of the  
vehicle. Operating the remote handle  
levers without checking could cause  
injury to a person when a seatback  
suddenly flips forward.  
2. After checking that the rear seats are  
clear, open the liftgate compartment  
and pull the remote handle levers on  
the left and right side of the liftgate  
compartment.  
CAUTION  
Before folding the seatbacks with the  
remote handle levers, make sure  
there is no cup in a rear cup holder.  
Folding the seatbacks with the  
remote handle levers while a cup is in  
the cup holder could soil or damage  
the seat bottom and seatback.  
2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page23  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (23,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
When using the rear seatback knobs:  
2. Pull on the top of the seatbacks from  
inside the vehicle to make sure they are  
locked.  
CAUTION  
When operating the rear seatback  
knob, make sure you support the  
seatback with your hand. If the  
seatback is not supported with your  
hand, it will flip forward suddenly  
and could cause injury to the finger  
that pushes the rear seatback knob  
down.  
3. Fasten the center-rear lap/shoulder belt  
and check that all seat belts are routed  
properly for passenger use (page 2-22).  
WARNING  
Always make sure the seat belts are  
fully pulled out from under the  
seatbacks:  
A seat belt caught under a seatback  
after the seatback is returned to its  
upright position is dangerous. In a  
collision or sudden stop, the seat belt  
cannot provide adequate protection.  
1. Unfasten the lap portion of the center-  
rear seat belt (page 2-22).  
CAUTION  
Always unfasten the lap portion of  
the belt before folding the rear-left  
seatback. Leaving the lap portion of  
the belt fastened could cause  
damage to the seat belt, buckle and  
seatback.  
When returning the seatback to the  
upright position, make sure there is no  
red indication:  
A rear seatback not fully returned  
and locked in the upright position is  
dangerous. Sudden stops or  
maneuvering could cause a seatback  
to flip forward suddenly resulting in  
injury. If the red indicator is visible on  
the back of the rear seatback knob,  
the seatback is not locked in the  
upright position.  
2. Support the seatback with your hand.  
3. Push the rear seatback knob down.  
Locked position  
Unlocked position  
Red indicator  
To return the seatbacks to the upright  
position  
1. Lift the seatbacks upright.  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page24  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (24,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seats  
qHead Restraint  
qArmrest  
The rear armrest in the center of the rear  
seatback can be used (no occupant in the  
center seat) or placed upright.  
WARNING  
Always drive with the head restraints  
installed when seats are being used  
and make sure they are properly  
adjusted:  
Driving with the head restraints  
adjusted too low or removed is  
dangerous. With no support behind  
your head, your neck could be  
seriously injured in a collision.  
Height adjustment  
To use a head restraint, pull it up to the  
locked position.  
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-  
catch release, then push the head restraint  
down.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top is  
even with the top of the passenger's ears,  
never the passenger's neck to prevent  
injury.  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page25  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (25,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Seat Belt Precautions  
Seat belts help to decrease the possibility of severe injury during accidents and sudden  
stops. Mazda recommends that the driver and all passengers always wear seat belts.  
All of the seat belt retractors are designed to keep the lap/shoulder belts out of the way  
when not in use.  
The driver's seat belt has no provisions for child-restraint systems and has only an  
emergency locking mode. The driver may wear it comfortably, and it will lock during a  
collision.  
However, the front passenger's seat and all rear lap/shoulder belt retractors operate in two  
modes: emergency locking mode, and for child-restraint systems, automatic locking mode.  
While we recommend you put all children in the rear seats, if you must use the front  
passenger seat for a child, slide the front passenger seat as far back as possible and make  
sure any child-restraint system is secured properly.  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page26  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (26,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
WARNING  
Always wear your seat belt and make sure all occupants are properly restrained:  
Not wearing a seat belt is extremely dangerous. During a collision, occupants not  
wearing seat belts could hit someone or things inside the vehicle or even be thrown  
out of the vehicle. They could be seriously injured or even killed. In the same  
collision, occupants wearing seat belts would be much safer.  
Do not wear twisted seat belts:  
Twisted seat belts are dangerous. In a collision, the full width of the belt is not  
available to absorb the impact. This puts more force on the bones beneath the belt,  
which could cause serious injury or death.  
Never use one seat belt on more than one person at a time:  
Using one seat belt for more than one person at a time is dangerous. A seat belt  
used in this way cannot spread the impact forces properly and the two passengers  
could be crushed together and seriously injured or even killed. Never use one belt for  
more than one person at a time and always operate the vehicle with each occupant  
properly restrained.  
Do not operate a vehicle with a damaged seat belt:  
Using a damaged seat belt is dangerous. An accident could damage the belt  
webbing of the seat belt in use. A damaged seat belt cannot provide adequate  
protection in a collision. Have an Authorized Mazda Dealer inspect all seat belt  
systems in use during an accident before they are used again.  
Have your seat belts changed immediately if the pretensioner or load limiter has  
been expended:  
One or both front air bags may deploy, and the corresponding pretensioner(s) may  
also deploy at the same time. While it is safer to use a crash-used seat belt that was  
used in an accident than no seat belt at all, using a seat belt with an expended  
pretensioner or load limiter loaded reduces the safety available to you. Like the air  
bags, the seat belt pretensioners will only function once. After they are expended,  
they will not function again and must be replaced immediately. If the seat belt  
pretensioners are not replaced, the risk of injury in a collision will increase. Always  
have an Authorized Mazda Dealer inspect the seat belt pretensioners and air bags  
after any collision. Expended seat belt pretensioners and air bags must be replaced  
after any collision which caused them to deploy. Additionally, the load limiter will  
only limit loads on the chest once in a collision and this is another reason to have the  
front seat belts inspected.  
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a  
person wearing a seat belt.  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page27  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (27,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
CAUTION  
Belt retraction may become difficult if the belts and rings are soiled, so try to keep  
them clean. For more details about cleaning the seat belts, refer to Cleaning the  
Lap/Shoulder Belt Webbing(page 8-56).  
qPregnant Women and Persons with Serious Medical Conditions  
Pregnant women should always wear seat belts. Ask your doctor for specific  
recommendations.  
The lap belt should be worn SNUGLYAND AS LOWAS POSSIBLE OVER THE HIPS.  
The shoulder belt should be worn across your shoulder properly, but never across the  
stomach area.  
Persons with serious medical conditions also should wear seat belts. Check with your  
doctor for any special instructions regarding specific medical conditions.  
qEmergency Locking Mode  
In the emergency locking mode, the belt remains comfortable on the occupant and the  
retractor will lock in position during a collision. When the seat belt is fastened, it will  
always be in the emergency locking mode until it is switched to automatic locking mode by  
pulling it all the way out to its full length. If the belt feels tight and hinders comfortable  
movement while the vehicle is stopped or in motion, it may be in the automatic locking  
mode because the belt has been pulled too far out. To return to the belt to the more  
comfortable emergency locking mode, wait until the vehicle has stopped in a safe, level  
area, retract the belt fully to convert it back to emergency locking mode and then extend it  
around you again.  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page28  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (28,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
qAutomatic Locking Mode  
Always use the automatic locking mode to keep the child-restraint system from shifting to  
an unsafe position in the event of an accident. To enable seat belt automatic locking mode,  
pull it all the way out and connect it as instructed on the child-restraint system. It will  
retract down to the child-restraint system and stay locked on it. See the section on child  
restraint (page 2-28).  
2-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page29  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (29,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Seat Belt (Except Center-  
Rear Position)  
WARNING  
Positioning the Shoulder Portion of the  
Seat Belt:  
NOTE  
Improper positioning of the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is dangerous.  
Always make sure the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is positioned  
across your shoulder and near your  
neck, but never under your arm, on  
your neck, or on your upper arm.  
When using the center-rear seat belt, refer to  
Center-Rear Position Seat Belt(page 2-22).  
qFastening the Seat Belt  
1. Grasp the tongue.  
2. Slowly pull out the lap/shoulder belt.  
4. Position the lap belt as low as possible,  
not on the abdominal area, then adjust  
the shoulder belt so that it fits snugly  
against your body.  
Belt  
Tongue  
Take up slack  
Keep low on  
hip bone  
Too high  
3. Insert the tongue into the buckle until  
you hear a click.  
WARNING  
Positioning the Lap Portion of the Seat  
Belt:  
Tongue  
The lap portion of the seat belt worn  
too high is dangerous. In a collision,  
this would concentrate the impact  
force directly on the abdominal area,  
causing serious injury. Wear the lap  
portion of the belt snugly and as low  
as possible.  
Buckle  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page30  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (30,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
qUnfastening the Seat Belt  
qShoulder Belt Adjuster  
Depress the button on the buckle. If the  
belt does not fully retract, pull it out and  
check for kinks or twists. Then make sure  
it remains untwisted as it retracts.  
Adjust the height of the shoulder belt if  
the seat belt touches your neck, or if it  
crosses your arm instead of your shoulder.  
To raise the shoulder belt adjuster, push  
the adjuster up. To lower the shoulder belt  
adjuster, pull the adjuster and slide it  
down. Make sure the adjuster is locked.  
To raise  
To lower  
Button  
NOTE  
If a belt does not fully retract, inspect it for  
kinks and twists. If it is still not retracting  
properly, have it inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
WARNING  
Positioning the Shoulder Portion of the  
Seat Belt:  
Improper positioning of the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is dangerous.  
Always make sure the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is positioned  
across your shoulder and near your  
neck, but never under your arm, on  
your neck, or on your upper arm.  
2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page31  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (31,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Front Seat Belt Pretensioner  
and Load Limiting Systems  
WARNING  
Wear seat belts only as recommended  
in this owner's manual:  
For optimum protection, the driver and  
front passenger seat belts are equipped  
with pretensioner and load limiting  
systems. For both these systems to work  
properly you must wear the seat belt  
properly.  
Incorrect positioning of the driver and  
front passenger seat belts is  
dangerous. Without proper  
positioning, the pretensioner and  
load limiting systems cannot provide  
adequate protection in an accident  
and this could result in serious injury.  
For more details about wearing seat  
belts, refer to Fastening the seat  
belts(page 2-17).  
Pretensioners:  
The front seat belt retractors remove slack  
quickly as the air bags are expanding.  
For deployment details, refer to the SRS  
Air Bag Deployment Criteria (page 2-57).  
In addition, the pretensioner system for  
the front passenger, like the front  
passenger air bag, is designed to only  
deploy in accordance with the total seated  
weight on the front passenger seat. Any  
time the air bags and seat belt  
pretensioners have fired they must be  
replaced. For details, refer to the driver  
and front passenger occupant  
classification system (page 2-60).  
Load limiter:  
The load limiting system releases belt  
webbing in a controlled manner to reduce  
belt force on the occupant's chest. While  
the most severe load on a seat belt occurs  
in frontal collisions, the load limiter has  
an automatic mechanical function and can  
activate in any accident mode with  
sufficient occupant movement.  
Even if the pretensioners have not fired,  
the load limiting function must be  
checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page32  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (32,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Have your seat belts changed  
immediately if the pretensioner or load  
limiter has been expended:  
Properly dispose of the pretensioner  
system:  
Improper disposal of the pretensioner  
system or a vehicle with non-  
deactivated pretensioners is  
One or both front air bags may  
deploy, and the corresponding  
pretensioner(s) may also deploy at  
the same time. While it is safer to use  
a crash-used seat belt that was used  
in an accident than no seat belt at  
all, using a seat belt with an  
expended pretensioner or load limiter  
loaded reduces the safety available to  
you. Like the air bags, the seat belt  
pretensioners will only function once.  
After they are expended, they will not  
function again and must be replaced  
immediately. If the seat belt  
pretensioners are not replaced, the  
risk of injury in a collision will  
increase. Always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer inspect the seat belt  
pretensioners and air bags after any  
collision. Expended seat belt  
dangerous. Unless all safety  
procedures are followed, injury could  
result. Ask an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer how to safely dispose of the  
pretensioner system or how to scrap  
a pretensioner-equipped vehicle.  
NOTE  
l
The pretensioner system will activate in a  
moderate or severe frontal, near-frontal  
collision or roll-over accident. The  
pretensioner system for the front passenger  
is designed to only deploy in accordance  
with the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat. It will not activate in most  
side or rear impacts.  
l
Some smoke (non-toxic gas) will be  
released when the air bags and  
pretensioners deploy. This does not indicate  
a fire. This gas normally has no effect on  
occupants, however, those with sensitive  
skin may experience light skin irritation. If  
residue from the deployment of the air bags  
or the front pretensioner system gets on the  
skin or in the eyes, wash it off as soon as  
possible.  
pretensioners and air bags must be  
replaced after any collision which  
caused them to deploy. Additionally,  
the load limiter will only limit loads  
on the chest once in a collision and  
this is another reason to have the  
front seat belts inspected.  
Do not modify the components or  
wiring, or use electronic testing devices  
on the pretensioner system:  
Modifying the components or wiring  
of the pretensioner system, including  
the use of electronic testing devices is  
dangerous. You could accidentally  
activate it or make it inoperable  
which would prevent it from  
activating in an accident. The  
occupants or repairers could be  
seriously injured.  
2-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page33  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (33,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Light  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Beep  
If a malfunction is detected in both the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
and the warning light, a warning beep  
sound will be heard for about 1 minute.  
After that, the one-minute beep will be  
repeated every 30 minutes.  
If the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner  
system is working properly, the warning  
light illuminates when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position or after the  
engine is cranked. The warning light turns  
off after a specified period of time.  
Have your vehicle inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding:  
A system malfunction is indicated if the  
warning light constantly flashes,  
Driving the vehicle with the air bag/  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding is dangerous.  
In a collision, the air bags and the  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
will not deploy and this could result  
in death or serious injury.  
constantly illuminates or does not  
illuminate at all when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position. If any of  
these occur, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible. The system  
may not work in an accident.  
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
to have the vehicle inspected as soon  
as possible.  
WARNING  
Never tamper with the air bag/  
pretensioner systems and always have  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer perform  
all servicing and repairs:  
Self-servicing or tampering with the  
systems is dangerous. An air bag/  
pretensioner could accidentally  
activate or become disabled causing  
serious injury or death.  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page34  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (34,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Center-Rear Position Seat  
Belt  
WARNING  
Fastening the Center-Rear Seat Belt  
with Only One Buckle:  
Before using the center-rear lap/shoulder  
belt make sure tongue (A) and anchor  
buckle (B) are fastened.  
Fastening the center-rear seat belt  
with only one buckle is dangerous. If  
only one pair of seat belt tongue and  
buckle, either tongue (A) and anchor  
buckle (B) or tongue (C) and anchor  
buckle (D), is fastened, the seat belt  
cannot provide full protection. In a  
sudden stop or collision, the user  
could slide under the belt and suffer  
serious injuries. Always make sure  
that both pairs of seat belt tongues  
and buckles are fastened properly.  
(A)  
(B)  
Positioning the Shoulder Portion of the  
Seat Belt:  
Improper positioning of the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is dangerous.  
Always make sure the shoulder  
portion of the seat belt is positioned  
across your shoulder and near your  
neck, but never under your arm, on  
your neck, or on your upper arm.  
qFastening the Seat Belt  
1. Grasp the tongue (C).  
2. Slowly pull out the lap/shoulder belt.  
3. Insert the tongue (C) into the buckle  
(D) until you hear a click.  
4. Position the lap belt as low as possible,  
not on the abdominal area, then adjust  
the shoulder belt so that it fits snugly  
against your body.  
WARNING  
Positioning the Lap Portion of the Seat  
Belt:  
(A)  
(C)  
The lap portion of the seat belt worn  
too high is dangerous. In a collision,  
this would concentrate the impact  
force directly on the abdominal area,  
causing serious injury. Wear the lap  
portion of the belt snugly and as low  
as possible.  
(B)  
(D)  
2-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page35  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (35,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
qUnfastening the Seat Belt  
CAUTION  
Depress the button on the buckle. If the  
belt does not fully retract, pull it out and  
check for kinks or twists. Then make sure  
it remains untwisted as it retracts.  
Always unfasten the lap portion of  
the belt before folding the left-rear  
seatback. Leaving the lap portion of  
the belt fastened could cause  
damage to the seat belt, buckle and  
seatback.  
NOTE  
To encourage rear seat passengers to wear  
their seat belts, we suggest leaving the center-  
rear lap position of the belt fastened at all  
times except when folding the rear seat  
forward.  
qFastening the Lap Portion of the  
Button  
Seat Belt  
NOTE  
Grasp tongue (A) and insert it into the  
anchor buckle (B) until you hear a click. It  
is now secure for passenger use.  
If a belt does not fully retract, inspect it for  
kinks and twists. If it is still not retracting  
properly, have it inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
After returning the left-rear seatback to its  
upright position, fasten the lap portion of the  
belt.  
qUnfastening the Lap Portion of  
the Seat Belt  
Insert a small object such as a key in the  
anchor buckle (B) slot.  
qStowing and pulling out the  
Center-Rear Position Seat Belt  
(A)  
(B)  
The center-rear position seat belt can be  
stowed using the following procedure.  
CAUTION  
When stowing the seat belt, make  
sure the belt is locked securely into  
the recess. If the seat belt is not  
properly stowed, it might get caught  
in the seats and be damaged.  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page36  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (36,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
To stow the seat belt, retract the belt, put  
tongues (A) and (C) together and insert  
them into the recess.  
Seat Belt Extender  
If your seat belt is not long enough, even  
when fully extended, a seat belt extender  
may be available to you at no charge from  
your Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Ceiling recess  
(A)  
This extender will be only for you and for  
the particular vehicle and seat. Even if it  
plugs into other seat belts, it may not hold  
in the critical moment of a crash.  
When ordering an extender, only order  
one that provides the necessary additional  
length to fasten the seat belt properly.  
Please contact your Authorized Mazda  
Dealer for more information.  
(C)  
To pull out the seat belt, slide tongue (A)  
with your finger while moving it  
downward, and slowly pull out the seat  
belt from the ceiling recess.  
NOTE  
Pulling out the seat belt all the way out will  
switch it to automatic locking mode. If  
automatic locking mode is not needed, retract  
the seat belt fully to convert it back to  
emergency locking mode.  
2-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page37  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (37,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
NOTE  
WARNING  
Do not use a seat belt extender unless  
it is necessary:  
When not in use, remove the seat belt extender  
and store it in the vehicle. If the seat belt  
extender is left connected, the seat belt  
Using a seat belt extender when not  
necessary is dangerous. The seat belt  
will be too long and not fit properly.  
In an accident, the seat belt will not  
provide adequate protection and you  
could be seriously injured. Only use  
the extender when it is required to  
fasten the seat belt properly.  
extender might get damaged as it will not  
retract with the rest of the seat belt and can  
easily fall out of the door when not in use and  
be damaged. In addition, the seat belt warning  
light will not illuminate and function properly.  
Do not use an improper extender:  
Using a seat belt extender that is for  
another person or a different vehicle  
or seat is dangerous. The seat belt  
will not provide adequate protection  
and the user could be seriously  
injured in an accident. Only use the  
extender provided for you and for the  
particular vehicle and seat. NEVER  
use the extender in a different vehicle  
or seat.  
Do not use an extender that is too  
long:  
Using an extender that is too long is  
dangerous. The seat belt will not fit  
properly. In an accident, the seat belt  
will not provide adequate protection  
and you could be seriously injured.  
Do not use the extender or choose  
one shorter in length if the distance  
between the extender's buckle and  
the center of the user's body is less  
than 15cm (6 in).  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page38  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (38,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Driver seated/Front passenger not  
seated  
Seat Belt Warning Light/Beep  
The belt minder is a supplemental  
warning to the seat belt warning function.  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened  
when the ignition switch is turned to the  
ON position, the warning light/beep  
operates to give you further reminders  
according to the chart below.  
The seat belt warning light illuminates  
and a beep sound will be heard if the  
driver's seat belt is not fastened when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position.  
Vehicle speed  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Seat belt  
Conditions of operation  
Indicator  
Beep  
Condition  
Result  
The driver's seat belt is not The warning light  
fastened when the ignition flashes and a beep  
switch is turned to the ON sound will be heard  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
position.  
for about 6 seconds.  
The driver's seat belt is  
fastened while the warning  
light and the beep sound are  
activated.  
The warning light  
turns off and the beep  
sound stops.  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
The driver's seat belt is  
The warning light will  
fastened before the ignition not illuminate and the  
switch is turned to the ON beep sound will not be  
position.  
heard.  
qBelt Minder  
NOTE  
The belt minder can be deactivated. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to deactivate and  
restore the seat belt minder.  
2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page39  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (39,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Seat Belt Systems  
Driver seated/Front passenger seated  
The seat belt warning function reminds  
the front passenger to fasten the seat belt  
according to the chart below.  
Vehicle speed  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Seat belt  
(Driver)  
Seat belt  
(Passenger)  
Indicator  
Beep  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
Placing heavy items on the front  
passenger seat may cause the front  
passenger seat belt warning function to  
operate depending on the weight of the  
item.  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
NOTE  
l
To allow the front passenger seat weight  
sensor to function properly, do not place  
and sit on an additional seat cushion on the  
front passenger seat. The sensor may not  
function properly because the additional  
seat cushion could cause sensor  
interference.  
l
When a small child sits on the front  
passenger seat, it is possible that neither  
the warning light nor the warning beep  
operate.  
2-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page40  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (40,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Child Restraint Precautions  
Mazda strongly urges the use of child-restraint systems for children small enough to use  
them.  
You are required by law to use a child-restraint system for children in the U.S. and Canada.  
Check your local and state or provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety  
of children riding in your vehicle.  
Whatever child-restraint system you consider, please pick the appropriate one for the age  
and size of the child, obey the law and follow the instructions that come with the individual  
child-restraint system.  
A child who has outgrown child-restraint systems should sit in the rear and use seat belts,  
both lap and shoulder. If the shoulder belt crosses the neck or face, move the child closer to  
the center of the vehicle in the outboard seats, and towards the buckle on the right if the  
child is seated on the center seat.  
Statistics confirm that the rear seat is the best place for all children up to 12 years of age,  
and more so with a supplemental restraint system (air bags).  
A rear-facing child-restraint system should NEVER be used on the front seat with the air  
bag system activated. The front passenger's seat is also the least preferred seat for other  
child-restraint systems.  
To reduce the chance of injuries caused by deployment of the front passenger air bag, your  
vehicle is equipped with the front passenger seat weight sensors. These sensors deactivate  
the front passenger front and side air bags and also the front passenger seat belt  
pretensioner system when the total seated weight on the front passenger seat is less than  
approximately 30 kg (66 lb).  
When an infant or small child sits on the front passenger seat, the system shuts off the front  
passenger air bag, so make sure the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light  
illuminates.  
Even if the front passenger air bag is shut off, Mazda strongly recommends that children be  
properly restrained and child-restraint systems of all kinds are properly secured on the rear  
seats which are the best place for children.  
For more details, refer to Front passenger seat weight sensors(page 2-60).  
2-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page41  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (41,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
WARNING  
Use the correct size child-restraint system:  
For effective protection in vehicle accidents and sudden stops, a child must be  
properly restrained using a seat belt or child-restraint system depending on age and  
size. If not, the child could be seriously injured or even killed in an accident.  
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and always keep the child-restraint system  
buckled down:  
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it  
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Make  
sure any child-restraint system is properly secured in place according to the child-  
restraint system manufacturer's instructions. When not in use, remove it from the  
vehicle or fasten it with a seat belt, or latch it down to BOTH LATCH lower anchors  
for LATCH child-restraint systems, and attach the corresponding tether anchor.  
Always secure a child in a proper child-restraint system:  
Holding a child in your arms while the vehicle is moving is extremely dangerous. No  
matter how strong the person may be, he or she cannot hold onto a child in a  
sudden stop or collision and it could result in serious injury or death to the child or  
other occupants. Even in a moderate accident, the child may be exposed to air bag  
forces that could result in serious injury or death to the child, or the child may be  
slammed into an adult, causing injury to both child and adult.  
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint system in the front seat with an air bag that  
could deploy:  
Rear-facing child-restraint systems on the front seat are particularly dangerous even  
though you may feel assured that a front passenger air bag will not deploy based on  
the fact that the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.  
The child-restraint system can be hit by a deploying air bag and moved violently  
backward resulting in serious injury or death to the child.  
2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page42  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (42,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Do not install a front-facing child-restraint system on the front passenger seat unless  
it is unavoidable:  
In a collision, the force of a deploying air bag could cause serious injury or death to  
the child. If installing a front-facing child-restraint system on the front passenger  
seat is unavoidable, move the front passenger seat as back as possible.  
Seating a child in a child-restraint system on the front passenger seat is dangerous:  
Your vehicle is equipped with front passenger seat weight sensors. Even with front  
passenger seat weight sensors, if you must use the front passenger seat to seat a  
child, using a child-restraint system on the front passenger seat under the following  
conditions increases the danger of the front passenger air bag deploying and could  
result in serious injury or death to the child.  
Ø The total seated weight of the child with the child-restraint system on the front  
passenger seat is approximately 30 kg (66 lb) or more with a child in the child-  
restraint system.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seat with the child in the child-restraint  
system.  
Ø A rear passenger or luggage pushing or pulling down on the front passenger  
seatback.  
Ø A rear passenger puts their feet on the front seat rails.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seatback or hung on the head restraint.  
Ø The seat is washed.  
Ø Liquids are spilled on the seat.  
Ø The front passenger seat is moved backward, pushing into luggage or other items  
placed behind it.  
Ø The front passenger seatback contacts the rear seat.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed between the front passenger seat and driver  
seat.  
Ø Any accessories increasing the total seated weight on the front passenger seat are  
attached to the front passenger seat.  
The designated positions with seat belts on the rear seats are the safest places for  
children. Always use seat belts and child restraints.  
2-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page43  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (43,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Do not allow a child to lean over or against the side window of a vehicle with side  
and curtain air bags:  
It is dangerous to allow anyone to lean over or against the side window, the area of  
the front passenger seat, the front and rear window pillars and the roof edge along  
both sides from which the side and curtain air bags deploy, even if a child-restraint  
system is used. If the vehicle is equipped with side and curtain air bags, the impact of  
inflation could cause serious injury or death to the child. Furthermore, leaning over  
or against the front door could block the side and curtain air bags and eliminate the  
advantages of supplemental protection. With the front air bag and the additional  
side air bag that comes out of the front seat, the rear seat is always a better location  
for children. Do not allow a child to lean over or against the side window, even if the  
child is seated in a child-restraint system.  
Never use one seat belt on more than one person at a time:  
Using one seat belt for more than one person at a time is dangerous. A seat belt  
used in this way cannot spread the impact forces properly and the two passengers  
could be crushed together and seriously injured or even killed. Never use one belt for  
more than one person at a time and always operate the vehicle with each occupant  
properly restrained.  
Always remove the child-restraint system from the rear seat before operating the  
remote handle levers for the rear seat:  
Operating the remote handle levers while a rear-facing child-restraint system is in  
the rear seat is dangerous. It could cause injury to a child seated in the child-  
restraint system when the seatback suddenly flips forward.  
CAUTION  
A seat belt or child-restraint system can become very hot in a closed vehicle during  
warm weather. To avoid burning yourself or a child, check them before you or your  
child touches them.  
NOTE  
Your Mazda is equipped with LATCH lower anchors for attachment of specially designed LATCH  
child-restraint systems in the rear seat. When using these anchors to secure a child-restraint system,  
refer to LATCH Child-Restraint Systems(page 2-41).  
2-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page44  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (44,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
qRear Outboard Seat Child-  
Installing Child-Restraint  
Systems  
Restraint System Installation  
Follow these instructions when using a  
child-restraint system, unless you are  
attaching a LATCH-equipped child-  
restraint system to the rear LATCH lower  
anchors. Refer to LATCH Child-  
Restraint Systems(page 2-41).  
Accident statistics reveal that a child is  
safer in the rear seat. The front passenger's  
seat is clearly the worst choice for any  
child under 12, and with rear-facing child-  
restraint systems it is clearly unsafe due to  
air bags.  
NOTE  
Follow the child-restraint system  
Some child-restraint systems now come  
with tethers and therefore must be  
installed on the seats that take tethers to  
be effective. In your Mazda, tethered  
child-restraint systems can only be  
accommodated in the three positions on  
the rear seat.  
manufacturer's instructions carefully. If you  
are not sure whether you have a LATCH  
system or tether, check in the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions and follow  
them accordingly. Depending on the type of  
child-restraint system, it may not employ seat  
belts which are in automatic locking mode.  
Even if your vehicle is equipped with  
front passenger seat weight sensors (page  
2-60), which automatically deactivates the  
front passenger air bag, a rear seat is the  
safest place for a child of any age or size.  
1. Make sure the seatback is securely  
latched by pushing it back until it is  
fully locked.  
2. Secure the child-restraint system with  
the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.  
See the manufacturer's instructions on  
the child-restraint system for belt  
routing instructions.  
Some child-restraint systems also employ  
specially designed LATCH attachments;  
refer to LATCH Child-Restraint  
Systems(page 2-41).  
3. To get the retractor into the automatic  
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt  
portion of the seat belt until the entire  
length of the belt is out of the retractor.  
WARNING  
Tethered Child-Restraint Systems Work  
Only on Tether-Equipped Rear Seats:  
Installation of a tether equipped  
child-restraint system in the front  
passenger's seat defeats the safety  
design of the system and will result in  
an increased chance of serious injury  
if the child-restraint system goes  
forward without benefit of being  
tethered.  
Place tether equipped child-restraint  
systems where there are tether  
anchors.  
2-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page45  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (45,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
4. Push the child-restraint system firmly  
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt  
retracts as snugly as possible. Clicking  
from the retractor will be heard during  
retraction if the system is in the  
automatic locking mode. If the belt  
does not lock the seat down tight,  
repeat this step.  
Anchor bracket location  
Tether strap position  
Tether strap  
NOTE  
Inspect this function before each use of the  
child-restraint system. You should not be able  
to pull the shoulder belt out of the retractor  
while the system is in the automatic locking  
mode. When you remove the child-restraint  
system, be sure the belt fully retracts to return  
the system to emergency locking mode before  
occupants use the seat belts.  
5. If your child-restraint system requires  
the use of a tether strap, refer to the  
manufacturer's instructions to hook and  
tighten the tether strap after raising the  
head restraint.  
2-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page46  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (46,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
qCenter-Rear Seat Child-Restraint  
WARNING  
Use the tether and tether anchor only  
for a child-restraint system:  
System Installation  
Follow these instructions when using a  
child-restraint system, unless you are  
attaching a LATCH-equipped child-  
restraint system to the rear LATCH lower  
anchors. Refer to LATCH Child-  
Restraint Systems(page 2-41).  
Using the tether or tether anchor to  
secure anything but a child-restraint  
system is dangerous. This could  
weaken or damage the tether or  
tether anchor and result in injury.  
Always route the tether strap between  
the head restraint and the seatback:  
Routing the tether strap on top of the  
head restraint is dangerous. In a  
collision the tether strap could slide  
off the head restraint and loosen the  
child-restraint system. The child-  
restraint system could move which  
may result in death or injury to the  
child.  
WARNING  
Use the tether and tether anchor only  
for a child-restraint system:  
Using the tether or tether anchor to  
secure anything but a child-restraint  
system is dangerous. This could  
weaken or damage the tether or  
tether anchor and result in injury.  
Always attach the tether strap to the  
correct tether anchor position:  
Attaching the tether strap to the  
incorrect tether anchor position is  
dangerous. In a collision, the tether  
strap could come off and loosen the  
child-restraint system. If the child-  
restraint system moves it could result  
in death or injury to the child.  
Always attach the tether strap to the  
correct tether anchor position:  
Attaching the tether strap to the  
incorrect tether anchor position is  
dangerous. In a collision, the tether  
strap could come off and loosen the  
child-restraint system. If the child-  
restraint system moves it could result  
in death or injury to the child.  
NOTE  
Follow the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions carefully. If you  
are not sure whether you have a LATCH  
system or tether, check in the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions and follow  
them accordingly. Depending on the type of  
child-restraint system, it may not employ seat  
belts which are in automatic locking mode.  
1. Make sure the seatback is securely  
latched by pushing it back until it is  
fully locked.  
2-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page47  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (47,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
2. Secure the child-restraint system with  
the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.  
See the manufacturer's instructions on  
the child-restraint system for belt  
routing instructions.  
NOTE  
Inspect this function before each use of the  
child-restraint system. You should not be able  
to pull the shoulder belt out of the retractor  
while the system is in the automatic locking  
mode. When you remove the child-restraint  
system, be sure the belt fully retracts to return  
the system to emergency locking mode before  
occupants use the seat belts.  
3. To get the retractor into the automatic  
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt  
portion of the seat belt until the entire  
length of the belt is out of the retractor.  
Type A  
1. If your child-restraint system requires  
the use of a tether strap, hook and  
tighten the tether strap. First, remove  
the anchor bracket cover on the rear  
end trim.  
4. Push the child-restraint system firmly  
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt  
retracts as snugly as possible. Clicking  
from the retractor will be heard during  
retraction if the system is in the  
automatic locking mode. If the belt  
does not lock the seat down tight,  
repeat this step.  
2. Flip over the trunk board.  
Trunk board  
2-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page48  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (48,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
3. Fold the trunk board into the position  
shown in the figure.  
Type B  
1. If your child-restraint system requires  
the use of a tether strap, hook and  
tighten the tether strap. First, pull up  
the front part of the trunk board and  
remove the anchor bracket cover on the  
trunk board.  
4. Latch the hook onto the anchor  
bracket, and tighten the tether strap  
following the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions.  
2. Pass the tether strap through the hole.  
5. Push the trunk board down to its  
original position.  
2-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page49  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (49,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
3. Latch the hook onto the anchor  
bracket.  
qIf You Must Use the Front Seat  
for Children  
If you cannot put all children in the rear  
seat, at least put the smallest children in  
the rear and be sure the largest child up  
front uses the shoulder belt over the  
shoulder.  
NEVER put a rear-facing child-restraint  
system on the front passenger seat, even  
with a seat weight sensor equipped  
vehicle.  
This seat is also not set up for tethered  
child-restraint systems, put them in one of  
the rear seat positions set up with tether  
anchors.  
Likewise the LATCH child-restraint  
system cannot be secured in the front  
passenger's seat and should be used in the  
rear seat.  
4. Push the trunk board down to its  
original position, and tighten the tether  
strap following the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions.  
Don't allow anyone to sleep against the  
side window if you have an optional side  
and curtain air bag, it could cause serious  
injuries to an out of position occupant. As  
children more often sleep in cars, it is  
better to put them in the rear seat. If  
installing the child-restraint system on the  
front seat is unavoidable, follow these  
instructions when using a front-facing  
child-restraint system in the front  
passenger's seat.  
NOTE  
l
To check if your front seats have side air  
bags:  
Mazda vehicles equipped with side air bag  
will have a SRS AIRBAGtag on the  
outboard shoulder of the front seats.  
l
To check if your vehicle has curtain air  
bags:  
Mazda vehicles equipped with curtain air  
bag will have an SRS AIRBAGmarking  
on the window pillars along the roof edge.  
2-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page50  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (50,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Do not allow a child to lean over or  
against the side window of a vehicle  
with side and curtain air bags:  
It is dangerous to allow anyone to  
lean over or against the side window,  
the area of the front passenger seat,  
the front and rear window pillars and  
the roof edge along both sides from  
which the side and curtain air bags  
deploy, even if a child-restraint  
WARNING  
Always move the front passenger seat  
as far back as possible if installing a  
front-facing child-restraint system on it  
is unavoidable:  
As your vehicle has front air bags  
and doubly so if your vehicle has side  
air bags, a front-facing child-  
restraint system should be put on the  
front passenger seat only when it is  
unavoidable.  
Even if the front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light  
illuminates, always move the seat as  
far back as possible, because the  
force of a deploying air bag could  
cause serious injury or death to the  
child.  
system is used. If the vehicle is  
equipped with side and curtain air  
bags, the impact of inflation could  
cause serious injury or death to the  
child. Furthermore, leaning over or  
against the front door could block  
the side and curtain air bags and  
eliminate the advantages of  
supplemental protection. With the  
front air bag and the additional side  
air bag that comes out of the front  
seat, the rear seat is always a better  
location for children. Do not allow a  
child to lean over or against the side  
window, even if the child is seated in  
a child-restraint system.  
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint  
system in the front seat with an air bag  
that could deploy:  
Rear-facing child-restraint systems  
on the front seat are particularly  
dangerous.  
Even in a moderate collision, the  
child-restraint system can be hit by a  
deploying air bag and moved  
violently backward resulting in  
serious injury or death to the child.  
Even though you may feel assured  
that the front passenger air bag will  
not deploy based on the fact that the  
front passenger air bag deactivation  
indicator light illuminates.  
qFront Passenger's Seat Child-  
Restraint System Installation  
1. Slide the seat as far back as possible.  
2-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page51  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (51,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
2. Secure the child-restraint system with  
the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.  
See the manufacturer's instructions on  
the child-restraint system for belt  
routing instructions.  
5. Make sure the front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light illuminates  
after installing a child-restraint system  
on the front passenger seat.  
Refer to Front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light on page  
3. To get the retractor into the automatic  
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt  
portion of the seat belt until the entire  
length of the belt is out of the retractor.  
4. Push the child-restraint system firmly  
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt  
retracts as snugly as possible. Clicking  
from the retractor will be heard during  
retraction if the system is in automatic  
locking mode. If the belt does not lock  
the seat down tight, repeat the previous  
step and also this one.  
NOTE  
l
Inspect this function before each use of the  
child-restraint system. You should not be  
able to pull the shoulder belt out of the  
retractor while the system is in the  
automatic locking mode. When you remove  
the child-restraint system, be sure the belt  
fully retracts to return the system to  
emergency locking mode before occupants  
use the seat belts.  
l
Follow the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions carefully.  
Depending on the type of child-restraint  
system, it may not employ seat belts which  
are in automatic locking mode.  
2-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page52  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (52,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
WARNING  
Do not seat a child in a child-restraint  
system on the front passenger seat if  
the front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light does not  
illuminated:  
While it is always better to install any  
child-restraint system on the rear  
seat, it is imperative that a child-  
restraint system ONLY be used on the  
front passenger seat if the  
deactivation indicator light  
illuminates when the child is seated  
in the child-restraint system (page  
2-60). Seating a child in a child-  
restraint system installed on the front  
passenger seat with the front  
passenger air bag deactivation  
indicator light not illuminated is  
dangerous. If this indicator light does  
not illuminate even when the total  
seated weight is less than  
approximately 30 kg (66 lb), this  
means that the front passenger front  
and side air bags, and seat belt  
pretensioner are ready for  
deployment. If an accident were to  
deploy an air bag, a child in a child-  
restraint system sitting in the front  
passenger seat could be seriously  
injured or killed. If the indicator light  
does not illuminate after seating a  
child in a child-restraint system on  
the front passenger seat, seat a child  
in a child-restraint system on the rear  
seat and consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
2-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page53  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (53,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
LATCH Child-Restraint Systems  
Your Mazda is equipped with LATCH lower anchors for attachment of specially designed  
LATCH child-restraint systems in the rear seat. Both anchors must be used, otherwise the  
seat will bounce around and put the child in danger. Most LATCH child-restraint systems  
must also be used in conjunction with a tether to be effective. If they have a tether you  
must use it to better assure your child's safety.  
WARNING  
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the use of the child-restraint system:  
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it  
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Make  
sure the child-restraint system is properly secured in place according to the child-  
restraint system manufacturer's instructions.  
Never attach two child-restraint systems to the same LATCH lower anchor:  
Attaching two child-restraint systems to the same LATCH lower anchor is dangerous.  
In a collision, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold two child-restraint  
system attachments, and it may break, causing serious injury or death. If you use the  
seat position for another child-restraint system when an outboard LATCH position is  
occupied, use the center seat belts instead, and the tether if tether-equipped.  
Make sure the child-restraint system is properly secured:  
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it  
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Follow  
the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions on belt routing to secure the  
seat just as you would with a child in it so that nobody is tempted to put a child in  
an improperly secured seat later on. When not in use, remove it from the vehicle or  
fasten it with a seat belt, or latch it down to BOTH LATCH lower anchors for LATCH  
child-restraint systems.  
Make sure there are no seat belts or foreign objects near or around the LATCH child-  
restraint system:  
Not following the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions when installing  
the child-restraint system is dangerous. If seat belts or a foreign object prevent the  
child-restraint system from being securely attached to the LATCH lower anchors and  
the child-restraint system is installed improperly, the child-restraint system could  
move in a sudden stop or collision causing serious injury or death to the child or  
other occupants. When installing the child-restraint system, make sure there are no  
seat belts or foreign objects near or around the LATCH lower anchors. Always follow  
the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions.  
2-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page54  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (54,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
Anchor bracket location  
q
Child-Restraint System Installation  
Procedure (Rear Outboard Seats)  
1. Make sure the seatback is securely  
latched by pushing it back until it is  
fully locked.  
2. Expand the open seams on the rear of  
the seat bottom slightly to verify the  
locations of the LATCH lower anchors.  
Tether strap position  
Tether strap  
NOTE  
The markings above the LATCH lower anchors  
indicate the locations of LATCH lower  
anchors for the attachment of a child-restraint  
system.  
3. Secure the child-restraint system using  
BOTH LATCH lower anchors,  
following the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instruction.  
4. If your child-restraint system came  
equipped with a tether, that probably  
means it is very important to properly  
secure the tether for child safety. Please  
carefully follow the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions  
when installing tethers.  
2-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page55  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (55,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
q
Child-Restraint System Installation  
Procedure (Center-Rear Seat)  
WARNING  
Use the tether and tether anchor only  
for a child-restraint system:  
The LATCH lower anchors at the center  
of the rear seat are much further apart than  
the sets of LATCH lower anchors for  
child-restraint system installation at other  
seating positions. Child-restraint systems  
with rigid LATCH attachments cannot be  
installed on the center seating position.  
Some LATCH equipped child-restraint  
systems can be placed in the center  
Using the tether or tether anchor to  
secure anything but a child-restraint  
system is dangerous. This could  
weaken or damage the tether or  
tether anchor and result in injury.  
Always route the tether strap between  
the head restraint and the seatback:  
Routing the tether strap on top of the  
head restraint is dangerous. In a  
collision the tether strap could slide  
off the head restraint and loosen the  
child-restraint system. The child-  
restraint system could move which  
may result in death or injury to the  
child.  
position and will reach the nearest  
LATCH lower anchors which are 400 mm  
(15.75 in) apart. LATCH compatible  
child-restraint systems (with attachments  
on belt webbing) can be used at this  
seating position only if the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions state  
that the child-restraint system can be  
installed to LATCH lower anchors that are  
400 mm (15.75 in) apart. Do not attach  
two child-restraint systems to the same  
LATCH lower anchor. If your child-  
restraint system has a tether, it must also  
be used for your child's optimum safety.  
Always attach the tether strap to the  
correct tether anchor position:  
Attaching the tether strap to the  
incorrect tether anchor position is  
dangerous. In a collision, the tether  
strap could come off and loosen the  
child-restraint system. If the child-  
restraint system moves it could result  
in death or injury to the child.  
2-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page56  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (56,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
3. Secure the child-restraint system using  
BOTH LATCH lower anchors,  
following the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions.  
WARNING  
Use the tether and tether anchor only  
for a child-restraint system:  
Using the tether or tether anchor to  
secure anything but a child-restraint  
system is dangerous. This could  
weaken or damage the tether or  
tether anchor and result in injury.  
Type A  
1. If your child-restraint system came  
equipped with a tether, that probably  
means it is very important to properly  
secure the tether for child safety. First,  
remove the anchor bracket cover on the  
rear end trim.  
Always attach the tether strap to the  
correct tether anchor position:  
Attaching the tether strap to the  
incorrect tether anchor position is  
dangerous. In a collision, the tether  
strap could come off and loosen the  
child-restraint system. If the child-  
restraint system moves it could result  
in death or injury to the child.  
1. Make sure the seatback is securely  
latched by pushing it back until it is  
fully locked.  
2. Expand the open seams on the rear of  
the seat bottom slightly to verify the  
locations of the LATCH lower anchors.  
2. Flip over the trunk board.  
Trunk board  
NOTE  
The markings above the LATCH lower anchors  
indicate the locations of LATCH lower  
anchors for the attachment of a child-restraint  
system.  
2-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page57  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (57,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
3. Fold the trunk board into the position  
shown in the figure.  
Type B  
1. If your child-restraint system requires  
the use of a tether strap, hook and  
tighten the tether strap. First, pull up  
the front part of the trunk board and  
remove the anchor bracket cover on the  
trunk board.  
4. Latch the hook onto the anchor  
bracket, and tighten the tether strap  
following the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions.  
2. Pass the tether strap through the hole.  
5. Push the trunk board down to its  
original position.  
2-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page58  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (58,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
Child Restraint  
3. Latch the hook onto the anchor  
bracket.  
4. Push the trunk board down to its  
original position, and tighten the tether  
strap following the child-restraint  
system manufacturer's instructions.  
2-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page59  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (59,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Precautions  
The front and side supplemental restraint systems (SRS) include up to 6 air bags. Please  
verify which kinds of air bags are equipped on your vehicle by locating the SRS  
AIRBAGlocation indicators. These indicators are visible in the area where the air bags  
are installed.  
The air bags are installed in the following locations:  
l
The steering wheel hub (driver air bag)  
The front passenger dashboard (front passenger air bag)  
The outboard sides of the front seatbacks (side air bags)  
The front and rear window pillars, and the roof edge along both sides (curtain air bags)  
l
l
l
The air bag supplemental restraint systems are designed to provide supplemental protection  
in certain situations so seat belts are always important in the following ways:  
Without seat belt usage, the air bags cannot provide adequate protection during an accident.  
Seat belt usage is necessary to:  
l
Keep the occupant from being thrown into an inflating air bag.  
Reduce the possibility of injuries during an accident that is not designed for air bag  
l
inflation, such as rear impact.  
Reduce the possibility of injuries in frontal, near frontal, side collisions or roll-over  
l
accidents that are not severe enough to activate the air bags.  
Reduce the possibility of being thrown from your vehicle.  
Reduce the possibility of injuries to lower body and legs during an accident because the  
l
l
air bags provide no protection to these parts of the body.  
Hold the driver in a position which allows better control of the vehicle.  
l
Your vehicle is also equipped with a driver and front passenger occupant  
classification system. For details, refer to the driver and front passenger occupant  
classification system (page 2-60).  
Small children must be protected by a child-restraint system as stipulated by law in every  
state and province. In certain states and provinces, larger children must use a child-restraint  
system (page 2-28).  
Carefully consider which child-restraint system is necessary for your child and follow the  
installation directions in this Owner's Manual as well as the child-restraint system  
manufacturer's instructions.  
2-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page60  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (60,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
WARNING  
Seat belts must be worn in air bag equipped vehicles:  
Depending only on the air bags for protection during an accident is dangerous.  
Alone, air bags may not prevent serious injuries. The appropriate air bags can be  
expected to inflate only in the first accident, such as frontal, near frontal, side  
collisions or roll-over accident that are at least moderate. Vehicle occupants should  
always wear seat belts.  
Children should not ride in the front passenger seat:  
Placing a child, 12 years or under, in the front seat is dangerous. The child could be  
hit by a deploying air bag and be seriously injured or even killed. Even if the front  
passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates, always move the front  
passenger seat as far back as possible. A sleeping child is more likely to lean against  
the door and be hit by the side air bag in a moderate, right-side collision. Whenever  
possible, always secure a child 12 years and under on the rear seats with an  
appropriate child-restraint system for the child's age and size.  
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint system in the front seat with an air bag that  
could deploy:  
Rear-facing child-restraint systems on the front seat are particularly dangerous even  
though you may feel assured that a front passenger air bag will not deploy based on  
the fact that the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.  
The child-restraint system can be hit by a deploying air bag and moved violently  
backward resulting in serious injury or death to the child.  
Do not sit too close to the driver and front passenger air bags:  
Sitting too close to the driver and front passenger air bag modules or placing hands  
or feet on them is extremely dangerous. The driver and front passenger air bags  
inflate with great force and speed. Serious injuries could occur if someone is too  
close. The driver should always hold onto only the rim of the steering wheel. The  
front seat passenger should keep both feet on the floor. Front seat occupants should  
adjust their seats as far back as possible and always sit upright against the  
seatbacks with seat belts worn properly.  
2-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page61  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (61,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Sit in the center of the seat and wear seat belts properly:  
Sitting too close to the side air bag modules or placing hands on them and sleeping  
up against the door or hanging out the windows is extremely dangerous. The side  
and curtain air bags inflate with great force and speed directly expand along the  
door on the side the car is hit. Serious injury could occur if someone is sitting too  
close to the door or leaning against a window, or if rear seat occupants grab the  
sides of the front seatbacks. Give the side and curtain air bags room to work by  
sitting in the center of the seat while the vehicle is moving with seat belts worn  
properly.  
Do not attach objects on or around the area where driver and front passenger air  
bags deploy:  
Attaching an object to the driver and front passenger air bag modules or placing  
something in front of them is dangerous. In an accident, an object could interfere  
with air bag inflation and injure the occupants.  
Do not attach objects on or around the area where a side air bag deploys:  
Attaching things to the front seat in such a way as to cover the outboard side of the  
seat in any way is dangerous. In an accident the object could interfere with the side  
air bag, which inflates from the outboard side of the front seats, impeding the added  
protection of the side air bag system or redirecting the air bag in a way that is  
dangerous. Furthermore, the bag could be cut open releasing the gas.  
Do not hang net bags, map pouches or backpacks with side straps on the front  
seats. Never use seat covers on the front seats. Always keep the side air bag modules  
in your front seats free to deploy in the event of a side collision.  
Do not attach objects on or around the area where a curtain air bag deploys:  
Attaching objects to the areas where the curtain air bag activates such as on the  
windshield glass, side door glass, front and rear window pillars and along the roof  
edge and assist grips is dangerous. In an accident the object could interfere with the  
curtain air bag, which inflates from the front and rear window pillars and along the  
roof edge, impeding the added protection of the curtain air bag system or redirecting  
the air bag in a way that is dangerous. Furthermore, the bag could be cut open  
releasing the gas.  
Do not place hangers or any other objects on the assist grips. When hanging clothes,  
hang them on the coat hook directly. Always keep the curtain air bag modules free  
to deploy in the event of a side collision or roll-over accident.  
Do not place luggage or other objects under the front seats:  
Placing luggage or other objects under the front seats is dangerous. The components  
essential to the supplemental restraint system could be damaged, and in the event of  
a side collision, the appropriate air bags may not deploy, which could result in death  
or serious injury. To prevent damage to the components essential to the  
supplemental restraint system, do not place luggage or other objects under the front  
seats.  
2-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page62  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (62,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Do not touch the components of the supplemental restraint system after the air bags  
have inflated:  
Touching the components of the supplemental restraint system after the air bags  
have inflated is dangerous. Immediately after inflation, they are very hot. You could  
get burned.  
Never install any front-end equipment to your vehicle:  
Installation of front-end equipment, such as frontal protection bar (kangaroo bar,  
bull bar, push bar, or other similar devices), snowplow, or winches, is dangerous. The  
air bag crash sensor system could be affected. This could cause air bags to inflate  
unexpectedly, or it could prevent the air bags from inflating during an accident.  
Front occupants could be seriously injured.  
Do not modify the suspension:  
Modifying the vehicle suspension is dangerous. If the vehicle's height or the  
suspension is modified, the vehicle will be unable to accurately detect a collision or  
roll-over accident resulting in incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the  
possibility of serious injuries.  
Do not use tires or wheels other than those specified for your Mazda:  
Use of any tire or wheel other than those specified for your Mazda (page 10-6) is  
dangerous. Use of such wheels will prevent the vehicle's accident detections system  
from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in incorrect or  
unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.  
Do not overload your vehicle:  
Overloading your vehicle is dangerous as is could prevent the air bag crash sensor  
system from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in  
incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.  
The gross axle weight rating (GAWR) and the gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR) for  
your vehicle are on the Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label on the driver's door  
frame. Do not exceed these ratings.  
Do not drive the vehicle off-road:  
Driving your Mazda off-road is dangerous because the vehicle has not been designed  
to do such. Driving the vehicle off-road could prevent the air bag crash sensor system  
from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in incorrect or  
unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.  
2-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page63  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (63,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Do not modify the supplemental restraint system:  
Modifying the components or wiring of the supplemental restraint system is  
dangerous. You could accidentally activate it or make it inoperable. Do not make  
any modifications to the supplemental restraint system. This includes installing trim,  
badges, or anything else over the air bag modules. It also includes installing extra  
electrical equipment on or near system components or wiring. An Authorized Mazda  
Dealer can provide the special care needed in the removal and installation of front  
seats. It is important to protect the air bag wiring and connections to assure that the  
bags do not accidentally deploy, the driver seat slide position sensor and front  
passenger seat weight sensors are not damaged and that the seats retain an  
undamaged air bag connection.  
NOTE  
l
When an air bag deploys, a loud inflation noise can be heard and some smoke will be released.  
Neither is likely to cause injury, however, the texture of the air bags may cause light skin injuries  
on body parts not covered with clothing through friction.  
l
Should you sell your Mazda, we urge you to tell the new owner of its air bag systems and that  
familiarization with all instructions about them, from the Owner's Manual, is important.  
2-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page64  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (64,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Supplemental Restraint System Components  
(3)  
(4)  
(2)  
(5)  
(6)  
(1)  
(7)  
(8)  
(9)  
(12)  
(3)  
(11)  
(8)  
(8)  
(9)  
(10)  
(1) Driver seat slide position sensor (page 2-60)  
(2) Side and curtain inflators and air bags  
(3) Driver/Front passenger dual stage inflators and air bags  
(4) Air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light (page 2-56)  
(5) Crash and roll-over sensors, and diagnostic module (SAS unit)  
(6) Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light (page 2-60)  
(7) Front air bag sensor  
(8) Side crash sensor  
(9) Front seat belt pretensioner and load limiting systems (page 2-19)  
(10) Front passenger seat weight sensors (page 2-60)  
(11) Front passenger seat weight sensor control module  
(12) Driver and front passenger seat belt buckle switches (page 2-64)  
2-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page65  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (65,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
How the SRS Air Bags Work  
Your Mazda is equipped with the following types of SRS air bags. SRS air bags are  
designed to work together with the seat belts to help to reduce injuries during an accident.  
The SRS air bags are designed to provide further protection for passengers in addition to  
the seat belt functions. Be sure to wear seat belts properly.  
qFront Seat Belt Pretensioners  
The front seat belt pretensioners are designed to deploy in moderate or severe frontal, near  
frontal collisions or roll-over accidents.  
qDriver Air Bag  
The driver air bag is mounted in the steering wheels.  
When air bag crash sensors detect a frontal impact of greater than moderate force, the  
driver's air bag inflates quickly helping to reduce injury mainly to the driver's head or chest  
caused by directly hitting the steering wheel.  
The driver, dual stage air bag controls air bag inflation in two energy stages. During an  
impact of moderate severity the driver air bag deploys with lesser energy, whereas during  
more severe impacts, it deploys with more energy.  
2-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page66  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (66,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
qFront Passenger Air Bag  
The front passenger air bag is mounted in the front passenger dashboard.  
The inflation mechanism for the front passenger air bag is the same as the driver's air bag,  
as mentioned above. In addition, the front passenger air bag is designed to only deploy in  
accordance with the total seated weight on the front passenger seat. For details, refer to the  
driver and front passenger occupant classification system (page 2-60).  
qSide Air Bags  
The side bags are mounted in the outboard sides of the front seatbacks.  
When the air bag crash sensors detect a side impact of greater than moderate force, the  
system inflates the side air bag only on the side in which the vehicle was hit. The side air  
bag inflates quickly to reduce injury to the driver or front passenger's chest caused by  
directly hitting interior parts such as a door or window. In addition, the front passenger side  
air bag is designed to only deploy in accordance with the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat. For details, refer to the driver and front passenger occupant classification  
system (page 2-60).  
2-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page67  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (67,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
qCurtain Air Bags  
The curtain air bags are mounted in the front and rear window pillars, and the roof edge  
along both sides.  
When the air bag crash sensors detect a side impact of greater than moderate force, the  
curtain air bag inflates quickly and helps to reduce injury mainly to the rear outboard  
passenger's head caused by directly hitting interior parts such as a door or window.  
In a side impact:  
Greater than moderate impact to one side of the vehicle will cause the curtain air bag on  
that side only to inflate.  
The only one side of curtain air bag will deploy  
only on the side the vehicle receives the force of  
the impact.  
In a roll-over:  
In response to a vehicle roll-over, both the curtain air bags inflate.  
Both curtain air bags will deploy after  
the roll-over accident is detected.  
2-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page68  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (68,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
qAir Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Light  
If the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system is working properly, the warning light  
illuminates when the ignition switch is turned to the ON position or after the engine is  
cranked. The warning light turns off after a specified period of time.  
A system malfunction is indicated if the warning light constantly flashes, constantly  
illuminates or does not illuminate at all when the ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position. If any of these occur, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
The system may not work in an accident.  
WARNING  
Never tamper with the air bag/pretensioner systems and always have an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer perform all servicing and repairs:  
Self-servicing or tampering with the systems is dangerous. An air bag/pretensioner  
could accidentally activate or become disabled causing serious injury or death.  
qAir Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Beep  
If a malfunction is detected in both the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system and the  
warning light, a warning beep sound will be heard for about 1 minute. After that, the one-  
minute beep will be repeated every 30 minutes.  
Have your vehicle inspected at an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning  
beep sounding:  
Driving the vehicle with the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning beep  
sounding is dangerous. In a collision, the air bags and the front seat belt  
pretensioner system will not deploy and this could result in death or serious injury.  
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the vehicle inspected as soon as  
possible.  
2-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page69  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (69,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria  
This chart indicates the applicable SRS equipment that will deploy depending on the type of collision.  
(The illustrations are the representative case of collisions.)  
Types of collision  
A severe frontal/near frontal  
collision  
A severe side  
collision  
A roll-over/near  
roll-over  
A rear collision  
SRS  
equipment  
Front seat  
belt  
X*(both sides)  
X*(both sides)  
pretensioner  
Driver air  
bag  
No air bag and front  
seat belt  
X
Front  
passenger air  
bag  
pretensioner will be  
activated in a rear  
collision.  
X*  
Side air bag  
X*(impact side only)  
Curtain air  
bag  
X (impact side only)  
X (both sides)  
X: The SRS air bag equipment is designed to deploy in a collision.  
*: The front passenger front and side air bags and the seat belt pretensioner are designed to deploy depending on  
the condition of the total seated weight on the front passenger seat.  
2-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page70  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (70,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Limitations to SRS Air Bag  
In severe collisions or roll-overs such as those described previously in SRS Air Bag  
Deployment Criteria, the applicable SRS air bag equipment will deploy. However, in  
some accidents, the equipment may not deploy depending on the type of collision and its  
severity.  
Limitations to front/near front collision detection:  
The following illustrations are examples of front/near front collisions that may not be  
detected as severe enough to deploy the SRS air bag equipment.  
Frontal offset impact to the vehicle  
Impacts involving trees or poles  
Rear-ending or running under a truck's tail gate  
Limitations to side collision detection:  
The following illustrations are examples of side collisions that may not be detected as  
severe enough to deploy the SRS air bag equipment.  
Side impacts with two-wheeled vehicles  
Side impacts involving trees or poles  
2-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page71  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (71,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Limitations to roll-over detection:  
The following illustrations are examples of accidents that may not be detected as a roll-  
over accident. Therefore, the front seat belt pretensioners and curtain air bags may not  
deploy.  
Pitch end over end  
2-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page72  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (72,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Driver and Front Passenger Occupant Classification System  
First, please read Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Precautions(page 2-47)  
carefully.  
qDriver Seat Slide Position Sensor  
Your vehicle is equipped with a driver seat slide position sensor as a part of the  
supplemental restraint system. The sensor is located under the driver seat. The sensor  
determines whether the driver seat is fore or aft of a reference position and sends the seat  
position to the diagnostic module (SAS unit). The SAS unit is designed to control the  
deployment of the driver air bag depending on how close the driver seat is to the steering  
wheel.  
The air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light flashes if the sensor has a  
possible malfunction (page 2-56)(Air Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning  
Light).  
qFront Passenger Seat Weight Sensors  
Your vehicle is equipped with a front passenger seat weight sensors as a part of the  
supplemental restraint system. These sensors are located under both of the front passenger  
seat rails. These sensors determine the total seated weight on the front passenger seat. The  
SAS unit is designed to prevent the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt  
pretensioner system from deploying if the total seated weight is less than approximately 30  
kg (66 lb).  
To reduce the chance of injuries caused by deployment of the front passenger air bag, the  
system deactivates the front passenger front and side air bags and also the seat belt  
pretensioner system when:  
l
There is no passenger in the front passenger seat. (The front passenger air bag  
deactivation indicator light does not illuminate.)  
The total seated weight on the front passenger seat is less than approximately 30 kg (66  
l
lb). (The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.)  
This system shuts off the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner  
system, so make sure the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates  
according to the following table.  
The air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light flashes and the front  
passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates if the sensors have a possible  
malfunction. If this happens, the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt  
pretensioner system will not deploy.  
2-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page73  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (73,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light  
This indicator light illuminates to remind you that the front passenger front and side air  
bags and seat belt pretensioner will not deploy during a collision.  
If the front passenger weight sensors are normal, the indicator light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON position. For a specified of time it goes out.  
The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates or is off under the following conditions:  
Front passenger seat  
Total seated weight on the Front passenger air bag Front passenger front and  
belt pretensioner  
front passenger seat  
deactivation indicator light  
side air bags  
Deactivated  
Deactivated  
system  
Empty (Not occupied)*  
OFF  
ON  
Deactivated  
Less than approx. 30 kg  
(66 lb)  
Deactivated  
Ready  
Approx. 42 kg (93 lb) or  
more  
OFF  
Ready  
* If the front passenger seat belt is buckled, the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates,  
however this does not indicate a malfunction.  
Curtain air bag is ready for inflating despite the chart above.  
If the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON position and does not illuminate as indicated in the  
above chart, do not allow a child to sit in the front passenger seat and consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible. The system may not work properly in an  
accident.  
2-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page74  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (74,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
WARNING  
Do not decrease the total seated weight on the front passenger seat:  
When an adult or large child sits on the front passenger seat, decreasing the total  
seated weight on the front passenger seat from the total seated weight of  
approximately 42 kg (93 lb) required for air bag deployment is dangerous. The front  
passenger seat weight sensors will detect the reduced total seated weight condition  
and the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system  
will not deploy during an accident. The front passenger will not have the  
supplementary protection of the air bag, which could result in serious injury.  
Decreasing the total seated weight on the front passenger seat from the total seated  
weight of approximately 42 kg (93 lb) could result in an air bag not deploying under  
the following conditions, for example:  
Ø A rear passenger pushes up on the front passenger seat with the feet.  
Ø Luggage or other items placed under the front passenger seat or between the  
front passenger seat and driver seat that push up the front passenger seat  
bottom.  
Ø The front passenger seat occupant sits in a manner that does not place the entire  
weight of the occupant on the seat such as by sitting too close to the door,  
grasping the assist grip or the rim of the moonroof and sitting with the seatback  
reclined too far.  
Ø Any accessories which might decrease the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat are attached to the front passenger seat.  
The front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner systems will  
deactivate if the total seated weight on the front passenger seat is close to 30 kg (66  
lb) and they will reactivate before the weight exceeds 42 kg (93 lb).  
2-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page75  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (75,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Do not increase the total seated weight on the front passenger seat:  
When an infant or small child sits on the front passenger seat, increasing the total  
seated weight on the front passenger seat from the total seated weight of  
approximately 30 kg (66 lb) is dangerous. The front passenger seat weight sensors  
will detect the increased total seated weight, which could result in the unexpected  
deployment of the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner  
system in an accident and may cause serious injury. Increasing the total seated  
weight on the front passenger seat beyond the total seated weight of approximately  
30 kg (66 lb) could result in the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt  
pretensioner system deployment in an accident under the following conditions, for  
example:  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seat with the child in the child-restraint  
system.  
Ø A rear passenger or luggage push or pull down on the front passenger seatback.  
Ø A rear passenger steps on the front passenger seat rails with the feet.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed on the seatback or hung on the head restraint.  
Ø The seat is washed.  
Ø Liquids are spilled on the seat.  
Ø The front passenger seat is moved backward, pushing into luggage or other items  
placed behind it.  
Ø The front passenger seatback contacts the rear seat.  
Ø Luggage or other items are placed between the front passenger seat and driver  
seat.  
Ø Any accessories which might increase the total seated weight on the front  
passenger seat are attached to the front passenger seat.  
The front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner systems will  
deactivate if the total seated weight on the front passenger seat is close to 30 kg (66  
lb) and they will reactivate before the weight exceeds 42 kg (93 lb).  
CAUTION  
Ø To assure proper deployment of the front air bag and to prevent damage to the  
sensors in the front seat bottoms:  
Ø
Do not place sharp objects on the front seat bottoms or leave heavy luggage on  
them.  
Ø
Do not spill any liquids on the front seats or under the front seats.  
Ø To allow the sensors to function properly, always perform the following:  
Ø
Adjust the front seats as far back as possible and always sit upright against the  
seatbacks with seat belts worn properly.  
If you place your child on the front passenger seat, secure the child-restraint  
system properly and slide the front passenger seat as far back as possible (page  
2-38).  
Ø
2-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page76  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (76,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
NOTE  
l
The system requires about 10 seconds to alternate between turning the front passenger front and  
side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system on or off.  
l
The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light may illuminate repeatedly if luggage or  
other items are put on the front passenger seat, or if the temperature of the vehicle's interior  
changes suddenly.  
l
l
The front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light may illuminate for 10 seconds if the total  
seated weight on the front passenger seat changes.  
If the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate after installing a  
child-restraint system on the front passenger seat, install the child-restraint system on the rear  
seat and consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
qDriver and Front Passenger Buckle Switches  
The buckle switches on the front seat belts detect whether or not the front seat belts are  
securely fastened and further control the deployment of the air bags.  
2-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page77  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (77,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
Monitoring and Maintenance  
qConstant Monitoring  
The following components of the air bag systems are monitored by a diagnostic system:  
l
SAS unit  
Front air bag sensor  
Air bag modules  
Side crash sensors  
Air bag/Front seat belt pretensioner system warning light  
Front seat belt pretensioners  
Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light  
Related wiring  
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Driver seat slide position sensor  
Front passenger seat weight sensors  
l
The diagnostic module continuously monitors the system's readiness. This begins when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON position and continues while the vehicle is being  
driven.  
qMaintenance  
The air bag systems do not require regular maintenance. But if any of the following occurs,  
take your vehicle to an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible:  
l
The air bag system warning light flashes.  
The air bag system warning light remains illuminated.  
The air bag system warning light does not illuminate when the ignition switch is turned  
l
l
to the ON position.  
The air bag system warning beep sound will be heard.  
The air bags have deployed.  
Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate when the ignition  
l
l
l
switch is turned to the ON position or does not illuminate as indicated in the chart. For  
more details about this indicator light and this chart, refer to Front passenger seat  
weight sensors(page 2-60).  
2-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page78  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (78,1)  
Essential Safety Equipment  
SRS Air Bags  
WARNING  
Do not operate a vehicle with damaged air bag/seat belt pretensioner system  
components:  
Expended or damaged air bag/seat belt pretensioner system components must be  
replaced after any collision which caused them to deploy or damage them. Only a  
trained Authorized Mazda Dealer can fully evaluate these systems to see that they  
will work in any subsequent accident. Driving with an expended or damaged air bag  
or pretensioner unit will not afford you the necessary protection in the event of any  
subsequent accident which could result in serious injury or death.  
Do not remove interior air bag parts:  
Removing any components such as the front seats, front dashboard, the steering  
wheel or parts on the front and rear window pillars and along the roof edge,  
containing air bag parts or sensors is dangerous. These parts contain essential air  
bag components. The air bag could accidentally activate and cause serious injuries.  
Always have an Authorized Mazda Dealer remove these parts.  
Dispose of the air bag properly:  
Improper disposal of an air bag or a vehicle with live air bags in it can be extremely  
dangerous. Unless all safety procedures are followed, injury can result. Ask an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer how to safely dispose of an air bag or how to scrap an air  
bag equipped vehicle.  
NOTE  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary restraint  
system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in accordance with a  
certified physician, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer, refer to Customer Assistance (U.S.A.)”  
(page 9-2).  
2-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page79  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (79,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
3
Explanation of basic operations and controls; opening/closing and adjustment  
of various parts.  
Advanced Keysí ...................................................................... 3-2  
Moonroofí ............................................................................. 3-40  
Theft-Deterrent Systemí ........................................................ 3-51  
íSome models.  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page80  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (80,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Advanced Keysí  
The advanced keyless functions (advanced keyless entry and start system) enables the  
following operations while the advanced key is being carried (page 3-7).  
l
Locking/unlocking the doors and the liftgate without operating the key.  
Starting the engine without operating the key.  
l
The advanced key enables additional functions other than those with the advanced keyless  
functions (page 3-13).  
l
The following operations are possible using the transmitter of the keyless entry system  
from a distance (Lock/Unlock/Panic button):  
l
Locking/unlocking the doors and the liftgate.  
Opening the power windows and the moonroof.  
Turning on the alarm.  
l
l
l
Locking/unlocking the doors or starting the engine using the auxiliary key.  
WARNING  
Do not leave the keys in your vehicle with children and keep them in a place where  
your children will not find or play with them:  
Leaving children in a vehicle with the key is dangerous. This could result in someone  
being badly injured or even killed. These new kinds of keys are fascinating to  
children. They could play with power windows or other controls, or even make the  
vehicle move.  
Radio waves from the advanced key may affect medical equipment such as  
pacemakers:  
Before using the advanced key near people who use medical equipment, ask the  
medical equipment manufacturer or your physician if radio waves from the  
advanced key will affect the equipment.  
NOTE  
l
The driver must carry the advanced key to ensure the system functions properly.  
l
Refer to Immobilizer System (page 3-46) for information regarding keys and engine starting.  
l
(With theft-deterrent system)  
Refer to Theft-Deterrent System (page 3-51) for information regarding keys and the prevention of  
vehicle and vehicle contents theft.  
3-2  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page81  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (81,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Panic button  
Lock button  
Auxiliary key  
Unlock button  
Operation indicator light  
Key code number plate  
A code number is stamped on the plate attached to the key set; detach this plate and store it  
in a safe place (not in the vehicle) for use if you need to make a replacement key.  
Also write down the code number and keep it in another safe and handy place, but not in  
the vehicle.  
If your key is lost, consult your Authorized Mazda Dealer with the code number ready.  
CAUTION  
Ø Because the advanced key uses low-intensity radio waves, it may not function  
correctly under the following conditions:  
Ø
The advanced key is carried with communication devices such as cellular  
phones.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
The advanced key contacts or is covered by a metal object.  
The advanced key is near electronic devices such as personal computers.  
Non-Mazda genuine electronic equipment is installed in the vehicle.  
There is equipment which discharges radio waves near the vehicle.  
If the vehicle is near equipment such as wireless pay devices installed at certain  
gas stations.  
Ø The advanced key may consume battery power excessively if it receives high-  
intensity radio waves. Do not place the advanced key near electronic devices such  
as televisions or personal computers.  
Ø To avoid damage to the advanced key, DO NOT:  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Drop the advanced key.  
Get the advanced key wet.  
Disassemble the advanced key.  
Expose the advanced key to high temperatures on places such as the  
dashboard or hood, under direct sunlight.  
Place heavy objects on the advanced key.  
Put the advanced key in an ultrasonic cleaner.  
Put any magnetized objects close to the advanced key.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page82  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (82,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
l
Battery life is about one year. Replace the battery when the KEY indicator light (green) flashes in  
the instrument cluster.  
Refer to Advanced Key Battery Dead Warning on page 3-17.  
l
Additional advanced keys can be obtained at an Authorized Mazda Dealer. Up to 6 advanced keys  
can be used with the advanced keyless functions per vehicle.  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page83  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (83,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Replacing the battery at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer is recommended to prevent  
damage to the advanced key. If replacing  
the battery by yourself, follow the  
instruction below.  
qAdvanced Key Maintenance  
CAUTION  
Ø Make sure the battery is installed  
with the correct pole facing  
upward. Battery leakage could  
occur if it is not installed correctly.  
Ø When replacing the battery, be  
careful not to bend the electrical  
terminals or get oil on them. Also  
be careful not to get dirt in the  
transmitter as it could be  
damaged.  
Replacing the advanced key battery  
1. Pull out the auxiliary key.  
Ø There is the danger of explosion if  
the battery is not correctly  
replaced.  
Ø Replace only with the same type  
battery (CR2025 or equivalent).  
Ø Dispose of used batteries  
according to the following  
instructions.  
2. Release the cap using a flathead  
screwdriver, then rotate and remove the  
cap.  
Ø
Insulate the plus and minus  
terminals of the battery using  
cellophane or equivalent tape.  
Never disassemble.  
Never throw the battery into  
fire or water.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Never deform or crush.  
The following conditions indicate that the  
battery power is low:  
Cap  
l
The KEY indicator light (green) flashes  
in the instrument cluster when the  
engine is turned off.  
The system does not operate and the  
l
operation indicator light on the  
transmitter does not flash when the  
buttons are pressed.  
The system's operational range is  
reduced.  
CAUTION  
Do not turn the cap excessively. The  
cap may be damaged.  
l
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page84  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (84,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
3. Insert a flathead screwdriver into the  
crack and press the battery out.  
qService  
If you have a problem with the advanced  
keyless functions, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If your advanced key is lost or stolen,  
bring all remaining advanced keys to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible for a replacement and to make  
the lost or stolen advanced key  
inoperative.  
CAUTION  
Radio equipment like this is governed  
by laws in the United States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void  
the user's authority to operate the  
equipment.  
4. Insert the new battery (CR2025 or  
equivalent) with the positive pole (  
facing the ( ) mark on the cap.  
)
5. Rotate and close the cap.  
Cap  
6. Reinsert the auxiliary key.  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page85  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (85,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Starting the engine  
Operation Using Advanced  
Keyless Functions  
The operational range for starting the  
engine includes nearly the entire cabin  
area except for the luggage compartment.  
qOperational Range  
Interior transmitter  
The system operates only when the driver  
is in the vehicle or within operational  
range while the advanced key is being  
carried.  
NOTE  
When the battery power is low, or in places  
where there are high-intensity radio waves or  
noise, the operational range may become  
narrower or the system may not operate.  
Operational range  
Locking, unlocking the doors and the  
liftgate  
NOTE  
l
The luggage compartment is out of the  
operational range, however, starting the  
engine may be possible.  
The engine may not start if the advanced  
key is placed in the following areas:  
The operational range for locking/  
unlocking the doors is an area of up to 80  
cm (2.6 ft) from the center of the front  
door handles.  
The operational range for locking/  
unlocking the liftgate is an area of up to  
80 cm (2.6 ft) from the center of the  
liftgate.  
l
l
Around the dashboard  
In the storage compartments such as the  
l
glove box  
l
Starting the engine may be possible even if  
Exterior transmitter  
the advanced key is outside of the vehicle  
and extremely close to a door and window,  
however, always start the engine from the  
driver's seat.  
If the vehicle is started and the advanced  
key is not in the vehicle, the vehicle will not  
restart after it is shut off and the ignition  
switch is turned to the lock position.  
l
If the advanced key is detected within  
operational range, the operation indicator  
light located in the instrument cluster  
flashes momentarily.  
Operational range  
NOTE  
The system may not operate if you are too  
close to the windows, door handles, or liftgate.  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page86  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (86,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
qLocking, Unlocking with Request  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash once to  
indicate that the doors and the liftgate are  
locked.  
Switch  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by pressing the request switch  
on the front doors or the liftgate while the  
advanced key is being carried.  
Front doors  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-51).  
To unlock  
Driver's door request switch  
Request switch  
To unlock the driver's door, press the  
request switch. A beep sound will be  
heard twice and the hazard warning lights  
will flash twice.  
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press  
the request switch again within 3 seconds  
and two more beep sounds will be heard.  
Liftgate  
NOTE  
Request switch  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash twice to  
indicate that the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-51).  
To lock  
Front passenger door/liftgate request  
switch  
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the request switch. A beep sound will be  
heard once and the hazard warning lights  
will flash once.  
To unlock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the request switch. A beep sound will be  
heard twice and the hazard warning lights  
will flash twice.  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page87  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (87,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
l
(Auto re-lock function)  
NOTE  
l
After unlocking doors and the liftgate by  
pressing the request switch, all doors and  
the liftgate will automatically lock and the  
hazard warning light will flash if any of the  
following operations are not performed  
within about 30 seconds.  
The request switch on the driver's door can  
be used to close the power windows and the  
moonroof.  
Refer to the following pages:  
Opening/Closing the Power Windows (page  
l
A door or the liftgate is opened.  
The auxiliary key is inserted into the  
Opening/Closing the Moonroof (page 3-42)  
l
l
Confirm that all doors and the liftgate are  
ignition switch.  
The start knob is pushed.  
securely locked.  
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
l
l
when any door or the liftgate is open.  
l
A beep sound is heard for confirmation  
qStarting the Engine  
when the doors and the liftgate are locked/  
unlocked using the request switch. If your  
prefer, the beep sound can be turned off  
(page 3-18).  
Ignition switch positions  
Without a traditional key, some of the  
ignition switch functions are different.  
l
The setting can be changed so that the  
doors and the liftgate are locked  
automatically without pressing the request  
switch (page 3-18).  
(Auto-lock function)  
A beep sound is heard when all doors and  
the liftgate are closed while the advanced  
key is being carried. All doors and the  
liftgate are locked automatically after about  
3 seconds when the advanced key is out of  
the operational range. Also, the hazard  
warning lights flash once. (Even if the  
driver is in the operational range, all doors  
and the liftgate are locked automatically  
after about 30 seconds.)  
If you are out of the operational range  
before the doors and the liftgate are  
completely closed or another advanced key  
is left in the vehicle, the auto-lock function  
will not work. Always make sure that all  
doors and the liftgate are closed and locked  
before leaving the vehicle.  
Start knob  
LOCK (Released)  
The steering wheel locks to help protect  
against theft.  
LOCK (Depressed)  
The ignition switch can be turned to the  
ACC position when the KEY indicator  
light (green) illuminates in the instrument  
cluster.  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page88  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (88,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
WARNING  
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position, the sound of the fuel pump motor  
operating near the fuel tank can be heard. This  
does not indicate an abnormality.  
Before leaving the driver's seat, always  
put the key or start knob to LOCK  
position, set the parking brake and  
make sure the shift lever is in P:  
Intentionally placing the key or start  
knob into LOCK position is much  
more important where you will not  
be removing the key to leave the  
vehicle and because leaving it in  
other positions will disable some of  
the vehicle security systems and run  
the battery down.  
START  
The engine is started in this position. It  
will crank until you release the start knob;  
then it returns to the ON position. The  
brake warning light can be checked after  
the engine is started (page 5-38).  
Starting the engine  
Leaving the driver's seat without  
putting the ignition switch in LOCK  
position, setting the parking brake  
and the shift lever is in P is  
dangerous. Unexpected vehicle  
movement could occur. This could  
cause an accident.  
NOTE  
l
Engine-starting is controlled by the spark  
ignition system.  
This system meets all Canadian  
Interference-Causing Equipment Standard  
requirements regulating the impulse  
electrical field strength of radio noise.  
l
The advanced key must be carried because  
NOTE  
the advanced key carries an immobilizer  
chip that must communicate with the engine  
controls at short range.  
l
If turning the ignition switch is difficult,  
jiggle the steering wheel from side to side.  
l
The ignition switch cannot be turned from  
l
When starting the engine, be sure the start  
the ACC position to the LOCK position  
when the shift lever is not in P.  
knob is securely attached before trying to  
operate it. If the knob becomes detached  
from the ignition switch, re-attach it by  
pushing it on to the ignition switch.  
ACC (Accessory)  
The steering wheel unlocks and some  
electrical accessories will operate.  
NOTE  
The Advanced Keyless Entry System does not  
function in the ACC position, and the doors  
will not lock/unlock using the transmitter or  
request switches even if the advanced key is  
carried away from the vehicle.  
ON  
This is the normal running position after  
the engine is started. The warning lights  
(except brakes) should be inspected  
before the engine is started (page 5-38).  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page89  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (89,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
1. Make sure the advanced key is being  
carried.  
NOTE  
In the following cases, the KEY warning light  
(red) illuminates and the engine will not start.  
2. Occupants should fasten their seat  
belts.  
l
The advanced key battery is dead.  
l
The advanced key is out of operational  
range.  
3. Make sure the parking brake is on.  
4. Depress the brake pedal.  
l
The advanced key is placed in areas where  
it is difficult for the system to detect the  
signal (page 3-7).  
A key from another manufacturer similar to  
the advanced key is in the operational  
range.  
5. Put the vehicle in park (P). If you must  
restart the engine while the vehicle is  
moving, shift into neutral (N).  
l
NOTE  
The starter will not operate if the shift lever is  
not in P or N.  
8. Turn the ignition switch to the ACC  
position while pushing the start knob  
in.  
6. Push the start knob slowly all the way  
in.  
9. Turn the ignition switch from the ACC  
position to the START position and  
hold (up to 10 seconds at a time) until  
the engine starts.  
7. Verify that the KEY indicator light  
(green) illuminates in the instrument  
cluster. The KEY warning light (red)  
means you cannot continue to start the  
engine using the Advanced Keyless  
System. You may have to use the  
auxiliary key instead (page 3-19).  
CAUTION  
Don't try the starter for more than 10  
seconds at a time. If the engine stalls  
or fails to start, wait 10 seconds  
before trying again. Otherwise, you  
may damage the starter and drain  
the battery.  
10. After starting the engine, let it idle for  
about 10 seconds.  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page90  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (90,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
l
In extremely cold weather or after the  
When turning the ignition switch to the  
LOCK position, the ignition switch has to  
be pushed in from the ACC position and  
turned. Without being pushed in, the  
ignition switch stops at the ACC position  
and the vehicle battery may be discharged  
if the ignition switch is left in the ACC  
position. When leaving the vehicle, make  
sure the ignition switch is turned to the  
LOCK position.  
vehicle has not been driven in several days,  
let the engine warm up without operating  
the accelerator.  
Whether the engine is cold or warm, it  
should be started without use of the  
accelerator.  
l
Turning off the engine  
1. Move the shift lever to the P position.  
l
If the vehicle is left with the ignition switch  
not in the LOCK position, a beep sound is  
heard and the indicator light flashes to  
notify the driver.  
2. Turn the ignition switch from the ON  
position to the ACC position.  
NOTE  
Refer to Warning Beep (page 3-16).  
When the engine is turned off and the ignition  
switch it turned from the ACC position to the  
LOCK position, the KEY indicator light  
(green) flashes in the instrument cluster for  
about 30 seconds if the battery power of the  
advanced key is low. Replace the battery with a  
new one.  
Refer to Battery Replacement (page 3-6).  
3. Push in the start knob from the ACC  
position and turn it to the LOCK  
position.  
CAUTION  
When leaving the vehicle, make sure  
the ignition switch is turned to the  
LOCK position.  
3-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page91  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (91,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Transmitter  
Operation Using Advanced  
Key Functions  
Lock button  
qKeyless Entry System  
This system uses the more traditional key  
buttons to remotely lock and unlock the  
doors and the liftgate, and opens the  
power windows, and opens the power  
windows and the moonroof.  
Panic button  
Unlock button  
It can also help you signal for attention.  
Press the buttons slowly and carefully.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
The keyless entry system is designed to  
l
(U.S.A.)  
operate up to about 2.5 m (8 ft) from the  
center of the vehicle, but this may vary due  
to local conditions.  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
l
The system does not operate when the  
ignition switch is not in the LOCK position  
or the start knob is pushed in.  
l
With the start knob installed in the LOCK  
position, the system is fully operational. If  
the ignition switch is not in the LOCK  
position or the start knob is pushed in, the  
system does not operate.  
l
(CANADA)  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
l
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
by pressing the lock button while any door  
or the liftgate is open. The hazard warning  
lights will also not flash.  
l
If the transmitter does not operate when  
pressing a button or the operational range  
becomes too small, the battery may be  
dead. To install a new battery, refer to  
Maintenance (page 3-5).  
NOTE  
The unlock button can be used to open the  
power windows and the moonroof, but the lock  
button cannot be used to close the power  
windows and the moonroof.  
Refer to the following pages:  
Opening/Closing the Power Windows (page  
Opening/Closing the Moonroof (page 3-42)  
The operation indicator light flashes when  
the buttons are pressed.  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page92  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (92,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Lock button  
NOTE  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash twice to  
indicate that all doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked.  
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the lock button. A beep sound will be  
heard once and the hazard warning lights  
will flash once.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
To confirm that all doors and the liftgate  
have been locked, press the lock button  
again within 5 seconds. If they are closed  
and locked, the horn will sound.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-51).  
NOTE  
NOTE  
Auto re-lock function  
After unlocking with the transmitter, all doors  
and the liftgate will automatically lock if one  
of the doors or the liftgate is not opened within  
about 30 seconds.  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash once to  
indicate that all doors and the liftgate are  
locked.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-51).  
l
Panic button  
If you witness from a distance someone  
attempting to break into or damage your  
vehicle, pressing the panic button will  
activate the vehicle's alarm.  
NOTE  
l
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
NOTE  
when any door or the liftgate is open.  
Confirm that all doors and the liftgate are  
locked visually or audibly by use of the  
double click.  
The panic button will work whether any door  
or the liftgate is open or closed.  
l
(Turning on the alarm)  
Pressing the panic button for 1 second or  
more will trigger the alarm for about 2  
minutes and 30 seconds, and the  
following will occur:  
Unlock button  
To unlock the driver's door, press the  
unlock button. A beep will be heard twice  
and the hazard warning lights will flash  
twice.  
l
The horn sounds intermittently.  
l
The hazard warning lights flash.  
NOTE  
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press  
the unlock button again within 3 seconds  
and two more beep sounds will be heard.  
However, if the driver is too close to the  
vehicle the panic button may not function.  
(Turning off the alarm)  
The alarm stops by pressing any button on  
the transmitter.  
3-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page93  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (93,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
qAuxiliary Key Function  
Advanced Key Suspend  
Function  
Use the auxiliary key stored in the  
advanced key in the event of a dead  
transmitter battery or malfunction.  
If one advanced key is left in the vehicle  
and a second advanced key is used to lock  
it, the functions of the advanced key left  
in the vehicle is temporarily suspended to  
prevent theft of the vehicle.  
Removing the auxiliary key  
Pull out the auxiliary key from the  
advanced key.  
The following are inoperable:  
l
Starting the engine using the start  
knob.  
l
Operating the request switches.  
To restore these functions, perform any  
one of the following:  
l
Press the lock or unlock button on the  
advanced key which has had its  
functions temporarily suspended.  
While carrying another advanced key,  
l
push in the start knob until the KEY  
indicator light (green) illuminates.  
Insert the auxiliary key and turn the  
l
Locking, unlocking the doors  
ignition switch to the ON position.  
The doors can be locked/unlocked using  
the auxiliary key, refer to Locking,  
Unlocking with Key (page 3-25).  
Starting the engine  
The engine can be started with the  
auxiliary key, refer to Ignition Switch  
(page 5-2).  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page94  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (94,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
qAdvanced Key Removed from  
Warning and Beep Sounds  
Vehicle Warning Beep  
q
System Malfunction Warning Beep  
Under the following conditions, a beep  
sound will be heard 6 times and the KEY  
warning light (red) will flash continuously  
when the start knob has not been returned  
to the LOCK position to notify the driver  
that the advanced key has been removed.  
The KEY warning light (red) will stop  
flashing when the advanced key is back  
inside the vehicle:  
If any malfunction occurs in the advanced  
keyless function, the KEY warning light  
(red) in the instrument cluster illuminates  
continuously and beep sounds will be  
heard.  
CAUTION  
If the KEY warning light (red) remains  
illuminated, do not continue to drive  
the vehicle with the advanced keyless  
function. Park the vehicle in a safe  
place and use the auxiliary key to  
continue driving the vehicle. Have the  
vehicle inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
Refer to Ignition Switch (page 5-2).  
l
The start knob has not been returned to  
the LOCK position, the driver's door is  
open, and the advanced key is removed  
from the vehicle.  
However the beep sound will be heard  
continuously when the start knob is in  
the ACC position and the door is open  
due to the activation of the warning  
beep sound indicating that the start  
knob is not in the LOCK position.  
The start knob has not been returned to  
the LOCK position and all the doors  
are closed after removing the advanced  
key from the vehicle.  
qStart Knob Not in LOCK  
l
Warning Beep  
If the start knob is in the ACC position  
and the driver's door is opened, a  
NOTE  
continuous beep sound will be heard to  
notify the driver that the start knob has not  
been returned to the LOCK position. In  
this case, the keyless entry system does  
not operate, the car cannot be locked, and  
the battery will run down.  
Because the advanced key utilizes low-intensity  
radio waves, the Advanced Key Removed From  
Vehicle Warning may activate if the advanced  
key is carried together with a metal object or it  
is placed in a poor signal reception area.  
qRequest Switch Inoperable  
Warning Beep  
Under the following conditions, if the  
request switch for a front door or the  
liftgate is pressed while the advanced key  
is being carried, a beep will be heard 6  
times to indicate that the front doors and  
the liftgate cannot be locked.  
l
A door or the liftgate is open (door ajar  
included).  
3-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page95  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (95,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
l
The start knob has not been returned to  
the LOCK position.  
The auxiliary key is inserted into the  
ignition switch.  
qAdvanced Key Left-in-vehicle  
Warning Beep  
l
If an advanced key is left in the vehicle  
cabin and all the doors and the liftgate are  
locked using a separate advanced key, a  
beep sound is heard for about 10 seconds  
to remind the driver that the advanced key  
has been left in the vehicle cabin. If this  
happens, the doors and the liftgate lock  
but the functions of the advanced key left  
in the vehicle cabin may be temporarily  
suspended. Perform the following  
qAdvanced Key Battery Dead  
Warning  
When the start knob is returned to the  
ACC or LOCK position from the ON  
position, the KEY indicator light (green)  
flashes for approximately 30 seconds  
indicating that the remaining battery  
power is low. Replace with a new battery  
before the advanced key becomes  
unusable.  
procedure to restore the functions of the  
advanced key (page 3-15).  
Refer to Advanced Key Maintenance  
(page 3-5).  
NOTE  
The advanced key can be set so that the KEY  
indicator light (green) does not flash even if  
the battery power is low.  
Refer to Setting Change (page 3-18).  
q
Engine Start Not Permitted Warning  
Under the following conditions, the KEY  
warning light (red) flashes to inform the  
driver that the start knob will not rotate to  
the ACC position even if it is pushed in  
from the LOCK position.  
l
The advanced key battery is dead.  
The advanced key is not within  
l
operational range.  
The advanced key is placed in areas  
l
where it is difficult for the system to  
detect the signal (page 3-7).  
A key from another manufacturer  
l
similar to the advanced key is in the  
operational range.  
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page96  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (96,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
Setting Change (Function Customization)  
The following function settings are possible. These settings can only be changed by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
After Setting  
Change  
Setting  
Function  
At Initial Setting  
Advanced key battery KEY indicator light (green) flashes to indicate  
dead indicator that the advanced key battery power is low.  
Lock/unlock operation A beep sound is heard to confirm that all doors or  
Activated  
Deactivated  
confirmation beep  
the liftgate have been locked/unlocked.  
Activated  
Deactivated  
Activated  
sound*1  
When all doors and the liftgate are closed and the  
advanced key is being carried and out of  
operational range, all the doors and the liftgate  
automatically lock after 3 seconds.  
Autolock function*2  
Deactivated  
(Even if the driver is in the operational range, all  
doors and the liftgate are locked automatically  
after about 30 seconds.)  
*1: When the autolock function is operating, the warning sound will be heard regardless of the setting.  
*2: When Autolock function is enabled, windows will not automatically close. You must close before leaving  
vehicle.  
3-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page97  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (97,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Advanced Keyless Entry and Start System  
When Warning Indicator/Beep is Activated  
Under the following conditions, warning beeps are heard and a warning/indicator light in  
the instrument cluster illuminates to notify the driver of improper operation of the  
advanced key to prevent theft of the vehicle (page 3-16).  
Warning  
What to check  
When a door is open, a continuous beep sound will be Check whether the start knob has been returned to the  
heard.  
LOCK position.  
When a door is open, 6 beep sounds are heard, and the  
KEY warning light (red) in the instrument cluster  
flashes.  
Check whether the advanced key has been removed  
from the vehicle.  
When a door is closed, a beep sound is heard 6 times,  
and the KEY warning light (red) in the instrument  
cluster flashes.  
Check whether the advanced key has been removed  
from the vehicle.  
Check whether the advanced key has been left in the  
vehicle.  
When attempting to lock the doors, a beep sound is  
heard.  
Check whether the start knob has been returned to the  
LOCK position.  
Check whether a door or the liftgate is open.  
The advanced key battery power is low. Replace the  
battery with a new one.  
Refer to Advanced Key Maintenance on page 3-5.  
When the KEY indicator light (green) flashes in the  
instrument cluster.  
The advanced key is malfunctioning. Park the vehicle in  
When the KEY warning light (red) remains illuminated a safe place, and use the auxiliary key to continue  
in the instrument cluster.  
driving the vehicle. Have the vehicle inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page98  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (98,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
A code number is stamped on the plate  
attached to the key set; detach this plate  
and store it in a safe place (not in the  
vehicle) for use if you need to make a  
replacement key.  
Keys (with Retractable  
Type Key)  
WARNING  
NOTE  
Do not leave the keys in your vehicle  
with children and keep them in a place  
where your children will not find or  
play with them:  
Write down the code number and keep it in a  
separate safe and convenient place, but not in  
the vehicle.  
If your key is lost, consult your Authorized  
Mazda Dealer and have your code number  
ready.  
Leaving children in a vehicle with the  
key is dangerous. This could result in  
someone being badly injured or even  
killed. These new kinds of keys are  
fascinating to children. They could  
play with power windows or other  
controls, or even make the vehicle  
move.  
Key extend/retract method (Retractable  
type key)  
To extend the key, press the release  
button.  
NOTE  
l
Refer to Immobilizer System (page 3-48) for  
information regarding keys and engine  
starting.  
l
(With theft-deterrent system)  
Refer to Theft-Deterrent System (page 3-51)  
for information regarding keys and the  
prevention of vehicle and vehicle contents  
theft.  
The keys operate all locks.  
To retract the key, rotate it into the holder  
while pressing the release button.  
Retractable  
type key  
Key code number plate  
3-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page99  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (99,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qTransmitter  
Keyless Entry System  
This system remotely locks and unlocks  
the doors and the liftgate, and opens the  
power windows and the moonroof.  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
It can also help you signal for attention.  
Press the buttons slowly and carefully.  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to the transmitter,  
do not:  
Operation  
indicator light  
Panic button  
Ø Drop the transmitter.  
Ø Get the transmitter wet.  
Ø Disassemble the transmitter.  
Ø Expose the transmitter to any kind  
of magnetic field.  
Ø Expose the transmitter to high  
temperatures on places such as  
the dashboard or hood, under  
direct sunlight.  
NOTE  
l
(U.S.A.)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
NOTE  
l
The keyless entry system is designed to  
l
(CANADA)  
operate up to about 2.5 m (8 ft) from the  
center of the vehicle, but this may vary due  
to local conditions.  
The system doesn't operate when the key is  
in the ignition switch.  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
l
l
Doors and the liftgate cannot be locked by  
pressing the lock button while any other  
door or the liftgate is open. Also, the hazard  
warning lights will not flash.  
NOTE  
l
The unlock button can be used to open the  
power windows and the moonroof, but the lock  
button cannot be used to close the power  
windows and the moonroof.  
If the transmitter does not operate when  
pressing a button or the operation range  
becomes too small, the battery may be  
dead. To install a new battery, refer to  
Maintenance (page 3-23).  
Refer to the following pages:  
l
Opening/Closing the Power Windows (page  
Opening/Closing the Moonroof (page 3-42)  
Additional transmitters can be obtained at  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer. Up to 3  
transmitters can be used with the keyless  
entry system per vehicle. Bring all  
transmitters to an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer when additional transmitters are  
required.  
The operation indicator light flashes when  
the buttons are pressed.  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page100  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (100,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Lock button  
NOTE  
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
The hazard warning lights will flash twice to  
indicate that all doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked.  
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press  
the lock button and the hazard warning  
lights will flash once.  
(With theft-deterrent system)  
To confirm that all doors and the liftgate  
have been locked, press the lock button  
again within 5 seconds. If they are closed  
and locked, the horn will sound.  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
l
The hazard warning lights only flash when  
the theft deterrent system is armed or  
turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-51).  
NOTE  
l
(Without theft-deterrent system)  
NOTE  
Auto re-lock function  
After unlocking with the transmitter, all doors  
and the liftgate will automatically lock if one  
of the doors or the liftgate is not opened within  
about 30 seconds.  
The hazard warning lights will flash once  
to indicate that all doors and the liftgate  
are locked.  
l
(With theft-deterrent system)  
l
The hazard warning lights will not flash.  
The hazard warning lights only flash  
l
when the theft deterrent system is armed  
or turned off, refer to the theft-deterrent  
system (page 3-51).  
Panic button  
If you witness from a distance someone  
attempting to break into or damage your  
vehicle, pressing the panic button will  
activate the vehicle's alarm.  
NOTE  
l
All doors and the liftgate cannot be locked  
when any door or the liftgate is open and  
the key is in the ignition switch.  
Confirm that all doors and the liftgate are  
locked visually or audibly by use of the  
double click.  
NOTE  
The panic button will work whether any door  
or the liftgate is open or closed.  
l
Turning on the alarm  
Unlock button  
Pressing the panic button for 1 second or  
more will trigger the alarm for about 2  
minutes and 30 seconds, and the  
following will occur:  
To unlock the driver's door, press the  
unlock button and the hazard warning  
lights will flash twice.  
l
The horn sounds intermittently.  
The hazard warning lights flash.  
l
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press  
the unlock button again within 3 seconds.  
Turning off the alarm  
Press any button on the transmitter.  
3-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page101  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (101,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
2. Insert a screwdriver into the slot and  
push the tab to remove the key from  
the transmitter.  
qTransmitter Maintenance  
If the buttons on the transmitter are  
inoperable and the operation indicator  
light does not flash, the battery may be  
dead.  
Tab  
Replace with a new battery before the  
transmitter becomes unusable.  
CAUTION  
Ø Install the battery with the positive  
pole ( ) facing down. Battery  
leakage could occur if it is not  
installed correctly.  
Ø When replacing the battery, be  
careful not to bend the electrical  
terminals or get oil on them. Also  
be careful not to get dirt in the  
transmitter as it could be  
damaged.  
3. Insert a screwdriver into the slot and  
gently pry open the transmitter.  
Ø There is the danger of explosion if  
the battery is not correctly  
replaced.  
Ø Replace only with the same type  
battery (CR1620 or equivalent).  
Ø Dispose of used batteries  
according to the following  
instructions.  
Ø
Insulate the plus and minus  
terminals of the battery using  
cellophane or equivalent tape.  
Never disassemble.  
Never throw the battery into  
fire and/or water.  
Never deform or crush.  
4. Remove the battery.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Replacing the transmitter battery  
1. Unfold the key (page 3-20).  
A
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page102  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (102,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
5. Put in the new battery (CR1620 or  
equivalent) with the positive pole (  
facing down.  
Door Locks  
WARNING  
)
Always take all children and pets with  
you or leave a responsible person with  
them:  
Leaving a child or a pet unattended  
in a parked vehicle is dangerous. In  
hot weather, temperatures inside a  
vehicle can become high enough to  
cause brain damage or even death.  
Do not leave the keys in your vehicle  
with children and keep them in a place  
where your children will not find or  
play with them:  
6. Align the front and back covers and  
snap the transmitter shut.  
Leaving children in a vehicle with the  
key is dangerous. This could result in  
someone being badly injured or even  
killed. They could play with power  
windows or other controls, or even  
make the vehicle move.  
7. Install the key to the transmitter.  
qService  
If you have a problem with the keyless  
entry system, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
Keep all doors locked when driving:  
Unlocked doors in a moving vehicle  
are dangerous. Passengers can fall  
out if a door is accidentally opened  
and can more easily be thrown out in  
an accident.  
If your transmitter is lost or stolen, bring  
all remaining transmitters to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible for a replacement and to make  
the lost or stolen transmitter inoperative.  
Always close all the windows, lock the  
doors and take the key with you when  
leaving your vehicle unattended:  
Leaving your vehicle unlocked is  
dangerous as children could lock  
themselves in a hot vehicle, which  
could result in death. Also, a vehicle  
left unlocked becomes an easy target  
for thieves and intruders.  
CAUTION  
Radio equipment like this is governed  
by laws in the United States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void  
the user's authority to operate the  
equipment.  
3-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page103  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (103,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qLocking, Unlocking with Key  
qLocking, Unlocking with Door-  
Lock Knob  
The driver's door can be locked/unlocked  
with the key.  
Turn the key toward the front to unlock,  
toward the back to lock.  
To lock any door from the inside, push the  
door-lock knob.  
To unlock, pull it out.  
This does not operate the other door  
locks.  
Unlock  
Lock  
Lock  
Unlock  
qLocking, Unlocking with Request  
Switch (with Advanced Key)  
To lock any door with the door-lock knob  
from the outside, push the door-lock knob  
to the lock position and close the door.  
This does not operate the other door  
locks.  
The doors can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the request switch while  
carrying the advanced key outside the  
vehicle, refer to Operations Using  
Advanced Keyless Functions (page 3-7).  
Door-lock knob  
qLocking, Unlocking with  
Transmitter (with Advanced Key)  
The doors can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-13).  
q
Locking, Unlocking with Transmitter  
(with Retractable Type Key)  
The doors can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-21).  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page104  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (104,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
Locking, unlocking with key  
l
(With advanced key)  
The driver's door cannot be locked using  
the door-lock knob from the outside.  
All doors and the liftgate lock  
automatically when the driver's door is  
locked with the key. All doors and the  
liftgate unlock when the driver's door is  
unlocked and the key is held in the unlock  
position for one second or longer.  
l
(With retractable type key)  
The driver's door cannot be locked using  
the door-lock knob from the outside if the  
key is in the ignition switch.  
l
When locking the doors this way, be careful  
not to leave the key inside the vehicle.  
qPower Door Locks  
Vehicle lock-out prevention  
Unlock  
(With advanced key)  
The vehicle lock-out prevention feature  
prevents you from locking yourself out of  
the vehicle. All doors and the liftgate will  
automatically unlock if they are locked  
using the power door locks with any door  
or the liftgate open.  
Lock  
NOTE  
Holding the key in the unlocked position in the  
driver's door lock for about a second unlocks  
all doors and the liftgate. To unlock only the  
driver's door, insert the key into the driver's  
door lock and turn the key briefly to the unlock  
position and then immediately return it to the  
center position.  
(With retractable type key)  
The vehicle lock-out prevention feature  
prevents you from locking yourself out of  
the vehicle. With the key in the ignition  
switch, all doors and the liftgate will  
automatically unlock if they are locked  
using the power door locks with any door  
or the liftgate open.  
3-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page105  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (105,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Locking, unlocking with door-lock  
switch  
qRear Door Child Safety Locks  
These locks are intended to help prevent  
children from accidentally opening the  
rear doors. Use them both whenever a  
child rides in the vehicle.  
All doors and the liftgate lock  
automatically when lock side is pushed.  
They all unlock when unlock side is  
pushed.  
If you slide the child safety lock to the  
lock position before closing that door, the  
door cannot be opened from the inside.  
The door can be opened only by pulling  
the outside handle.  
Unlock  
Lock  
Lock  
Locking, unlocking with request switch  
(with advanced key)  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by operating the request switch  
on the front doors and the liftgate while  
carrying the advanced key outside the  
vehicle, refer to Operations Using  
Unlock  
Advanced Keyless Functions (page 3-7).  
Locking, unlocking with transmitter  
(with advanced key)  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by operating the keyless entry  
system transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry  
System (page 3-13).  
Locking, unlocking with transmitter  
(with retractable type key)  
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/  
unlocked by operating the keyless entry  
system transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry  
System (page 3-21).  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page106  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (106,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qLocking, Unlocking with  
Liftgate  
Transmitter (with Advanced Key)  
WARNING  
Never allow a person to ride in the  
luggage compartment:  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-13).  
Allowing a person to ride in the  
luggage compartment is dangerous.  
The person in the luggage  
compartment could be seriously  
injured or killed during sudden  
braking or a collision.  
q
Locking, Unlocking with Transmitter  
(with Retractable Type Key)  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the keyless entry system  
transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry System  
(page 3-21).  
Do not drive with the liftgate open:  
Exhaust gas in the cabin of a vehicle  
is dangerous. An open liftgate in a  
moving vehicle will cause exhaust  
gas to be drawn into the cabin. This  
gas contains CO (carbon monoxide),  
which is colorless, odorless, and  
highly poisonous, and it can cause  
loss of consciousness and death.  
Moreover, an open liftgate could  
cause occupants to fall out in an  
accident.  
qLocking, Unlocking with Door-  
Lock Switch  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the door-lock switch, refer to  
Power Door Locks (page 3-26).  
qOpening and Closing the Liftgate  
Opening the liftgate  
Pull up on the handle.  
qLocking, Unlocking with Key  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
inserting the key into the driver's door key  
slot, refer to Power Door Locks (page  
qLocking, Unlocking with Request  
Switch (with Advanced Key)  
The liftgate can be locked/unlocked by  
operating the request switch while  
carrying the advanced key outside the  
vehicle, refer to Operations Using  
Advanced Keyless Functions (page 3-7).  
3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page107  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (107,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
qLuggage Compartment  
If the vehicle battery is dead or there is a  
malfunction in the electrical system and the  
liftgate cannot be unlocked, perform the  
following procedure as an emergency measure  
to unlock it:  
WARNING  
Do not place luggage or other cargo on  
top of the luggage compartment cover:  
Placing luggage or other cargo on  
top of the luggage compartment  
cover is dangerous. During sudden  
braking or a collision, the cargo  
could become a projectile that could  
hit and injure someone. The vehicle  
has a light weight luggage  
1. Remove the cap on the interior surface of  
the liftgate with a flathead screwdriver.  
compartment cover to keep the  
contents of your luggage area out of  
sight; it will not retain heavy objects  
that are not tied down in an accident  
such as a rollover. Tie down all heavy  
objects, whether luggage or cargo,  
using the tie down hooks.  
Cap  
Make sure luggage and cargo is  
secured before driving:  
2. Turn the lever to the right to unlock the  
liftgate.  
Not securing cargo while driving is  
dangerous as it could move or be  
crushed during sudden braking or a  
collision and cause injury.  
Lever  
CAUTION  
Make sure the luggage compartment  
cover is firmly secured. If it is not  
firmly secured, it could unexpectedly  
disengage resulting in injury.  
After performing this emergency measure,  
have the vehicle inspected at an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
Closing the liftgate  
Use both hands to push the liftgate down  
until the lock snaps shut. Do not slam it.  
Pull up on the liftgate to make sure it is  
securely latched.  
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page108  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (108,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Luggage compartment coverí  
Installing the cover  
3. Slowly pull out the cover and insert it  
into the retainers.  
1. Insert the left end of the retractor bar  
into the notch.  
Hook  
retainer  
Removing the cover  
Reverse the procedure for installation.  
2. Squeeze the spring holder on right end  
of the retractor bar inward, then insert  
it into the notch.  
3-30  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page109  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (109,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
q
Operating the Front Power Windows  
Power Windows  
NOTE  
l
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position for the power windows to  
operate.  
Each passenger power window can be  
operated with each door switch when the  
power window lock switch on the driver's  
door is in the unlocked position (page  
WARNING  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing a window:  
l
Each passenger power window can also be  
operated by the power window master  
control switches on the driver's door.  
Closing power windows are  
dangerous. A person's hands, head,  
or even neck could be caught by the  
window and result in serious injury  
or even death.  
This warning applies especially to  
children.  
Owner master control switch  
Driver's window  
Left rear window  
Always lock all passenger power  
windows with the power window lock  
switch on the driver's side while  
children are in the vehicle, and never  
allow children to play with power  
window switches:  
Front passenger's  
window  
Right rear window  
l
Leaving the power window switches  
unlocked while children are in the  
vehicle is dangerous. Power window  
switches that are not locked with the  
power window lock switch would  
allow children to operate power  
windows unintentionally which could  
result in serious injury if a child's  
hands, head or neck becomes caught  
by the window.  
The following functions can be performed  
for the front power windows using the  
power window master control switches on  
the driver's door or front passenger's door  
switch.  
l
Manual opening/closing  
Auto-opening/closing  
Two-step down function  
l
l
CAUTION  
To prevent burning out the fuse and  
damaging the power window system,  
do not open or close more than three  
windows at once.  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page110  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (110,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Manual opening/closing  
NOTE  
(POWER WINDOW RESET PROCEDURE)  
If the battery was disconnected during vehicle  
maintenance, or for other reasons such as a  
switch continues to be operated after the  
window is fully open/close, the power windows  
will not fully open and close automatically.  
Resetting of the automatic function can be  
performed using the master control switches  
and the front passenger door switch.  
To open a power window to the desired  
position, lightly hold down the switch.  
To close the power window to the desired  
position, lightly pull up the switch.  
Master control switches  
Close  
Driver's  
Open  
The power window auto function reset  
window  
procedure can be done on one or both door  
switches. The power window auto function will  
only resume on the side that has been reset.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.  
Front passenger's  
window  
2. Make sure that the power window lock  
switch located on the driver's door is not  
depressed.  
Front passenger switch  
3. Press the switch and fully open the power  
window.  
Close  
Open  
4. Pull up the switch to fully close the power  
window and continue holding the switch for  
about 2 seconds after the window fully  
closed.  
5. Repeat Steps 3-4 for each front power  
window.  
6. Make sure that the power windows operate  
correctly using the door switches.  
Auto-opening/closing  
To fully open a power window  
automatically, press the switch completely  
down.  
To fully close the power window  
automatically, pull the switch completely  
up.  
Two-step down function  
With the power window completely  
closed, press the switch lightly and it will  
open and stop about 3 cm (1 in) from the  
top.  
If you continue to press and hold the  
switch, the window will resume opening  
all the way.  
To stop the power window partway, pull  
or press the switch in the opposite  
direction and then release it.  
3-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page111  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (111,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
Pressing the power window switch once when  
the window is fully closed will only open it  
about 3 cm (1 in) to allow convenient  
ventilation of the cabin.  
The two-step down function cannot be  
canceled if the procedure is not completed  
within the specified times, or the procedure  
is changed along the way. To redo the  
procedure, first turn the ignition switch to  
the LOCK position and proceed from the  
beginning.  
Canceling the two-step down function  
To cancel the two-step down function for  
the front power windows, carry out the  
following procedure using the master  
control switches.  
l
If you are unable to cancel the function  
despite carrying out the cancellation  
procedure, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON  
position and complete the following  
procedure within 5 seconds:  
Restoring the two-step down function  
With the two-step down function in the  
canceled state, repeat the previous  
procedure for canceling the function on  
each door switch and it will be restored.  
Press the power window switch 2 times  
firmly, then pull it 2 times firmly.  
Master control switches  
NOTE  
Driver's  
window  
If you are unable to restore the function despite  
doing the restore procedure, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Jam-safe window  
If a person's hands, head or an object  
blocks the window during the manual  
closing operation or the auto-closing  
operation, the window will stop and open  
halfway.  
Front passenger's  
window  
2. Turn the ignition switch to the LOCK  
position.  
WARNING  
3. With the ignition switch in the LOCK  
position, and within 40 seconds, turn  
the ignition switch to the ON position  
and complete the following procedure  
within 5 seconds:  
Make sure nothing blocks the window  
just before it reaches the fully closed  
position or while fully holding up the  
power window switch:  
Blocking the power window just  
before it reaches the fully closed  
position or while fully holding up the  
power window switch is dangerous.  
In this case, the jam-safe function  
cannot prevent the window from  
stopping. If fingers are caught,  
serious injuries could occur.  
Press the power window switch 2 times  
firmly, then pull 2 times firmly.  
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page112  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (112,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
NOTE  
q
Operating the Rear Power Windows  
l
Depending on driving conditions, a closing  
The power windows may be operated  
when the power window lock switch on  
the driver's door is in the unlocked  
position.  
power window could stop and start opening  
when the window feels a shock that is  
similar to something blocking it.  
In the event the jam-safe function activates  
and the power window cannot be closed  
automatically, pull and hold the switch fully  
and the window will close.  
A rear power windows may be opened or  
closed using the power window master  
control switches on the driver's door.  
l
The jam-safe window function does not  
operate until the system is re-initialized.  
Left rear window  
Engine-off power window operation  
The power window can be operated for  
about 40 seconds after the ignition switch  
is turned from the ON position to the  
ACC or LOCK position with all doors  
closed. If either front door is opened, the  
power window will be inoperable.  
Right rear window  
NOTE  
Power window lock switch  
l
For engine-off operation of the power  
window, the switch must be held up firmly  
throughout window closure because the  
auto-closing function will be inoperable.  
The two-step down function is inoperable  
during engine-off operation.  
To open the power window to the desired  
position, hold down the switch.  
To close the power window to the desired  
position, pull up the switch.  
l
Close  
Open  
3-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page113  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (113,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Engine-off power window operation  
NOTE  
When the power window lock switch is in the  
locked position, the light on front passenger's  
power window switch turns off. The light may  
be difficult to see depending on the  
The power windows can be operated for  
about 40 seconds after the ignition switch  
is turned from the ON position to the  
ACC or LOCK position with all doors  
closed. If either front door is opened, the  
power windows will be inoperable.  
surrounding brightness.  
qOpening/Closing the Power  
Windows from Outside  
qPower Window Lock Switch  
The front power windows can be opened  
or closed from outside the vehicle after  
the doors and the liftgate are closed.  
The front power windows may be  
operated when the power window lock  
switch on the driver's door is in the lock  
or unlocked position.  
With the lock switch in the unlocked  
position, all power windows on each door  
can be operated.  
With the lock switch in the locked  
position, only the driver's side power  
window can be operated.  
WARNING  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing a window:  
Locked position  
Unlocked position  
Closing power windows are  
dangerous. A person's hands, head,  
or even neck could be caught by the  
window and result in serious injury  
or even death.  
This warning applies especially to  
children.  
NOTE  
The power windows cannot be opened or  
closed from outside the vehicle under the  
following condition:  
WARNING  
Unless a passenger needs to operate a  
power window, keep the power window  
lock switch in the locked position:  
Unintentional power window  
l
A door or the liftgate is opened.  
l
The key is inserted into the ignition switch.  
l
(With advanced key)  
operation is dangerous. A person's  
hands, head, or neck could be caught  
by the window and result in serious  
injury.  
The start knob is in any position except  
LOCK.  
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page114  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (114,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Opening  
Advanced key  
Because nobody likes getting into a very  
hot car, Mazda has introduced a way to  
open the two front windows and the  
moonroof as you approach the vehicle to  
get the air moving before you get in.  
Lock button  
Panic button  
Unlock button  
WARNING  
Use the auto-window function only  
when you can see the vehicle and it is  
in a secure area:  
Do not let children play with your  
keys. If they open the window  
without your knowing, the open  
windows are an even bigger  
invitation to a thief than leaving the  
doors unlocked.  
Retractable type key  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
The windows can be opened for  
ventilating the cabin before getting in the  
vehicle.  
With unlock button (Keyless entry  
system)  
Press once, then press again within 1.5  
seconds and hold.  
Panic button  
After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the two front windows and the  
moonroof open while the unlock button is  
pressed.  
To stop the windows and the moonroof  
while opening, release the button.  
If the operation is performed from the  
beginning again, the windows and the  
moonroof open.  
NOTE  
l
The unlock button does not operate unless  
it is pressed twice sequentially.  
The lock button cannot be used to close the  
power windows.  
l
With key  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
3-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page115  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (115,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
2. Turn the key toward the front and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the windows fully open  
automatically.  
2. Turn the key toward the back and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
locked, the windows close as long as  
the key is turned.  
Open  
Close  
To stop this operation, turn the key to the  
center position, then turn it toward the  
front again.  
With request switch on the driver's  
door (Advanced key)  
1. If the doors and the liftgate are locked,  
unlock them.  
NOTE  
The window opening operation also can be  
stopped by turning the key toward the back.  
However, the doors and the liftgate will lock.  
2. Press and hold the request switch on  
the driver's door. After the doors and  
the liftgate are locked, the windows  
close as long as the request switch is  
pressed.  
Closing  
The windows can be closed in case they  
are left open after getting out of the  
vehicle.  
NOTE  
(With advanced key)  
If the auto-lock function (page 3-8) has been  
activated, the doors and the liftgate  
automatically lock as you walk away from the  
vehicle, however, the power windows cannot  
be closed. When leaving the vehicle, close the  
windows using the power window switch  
inside the vehicle, the key, or a request switch.  
Request switch  
With key  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page116  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (116,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qFuel-Filler Lid  
Fuel-Filler Lid and Cap  
To open, pull up the remote fuel-filler lid  
release.  
WARNING  
When removing the fuel cap, loosen the  
cap slightly and wait for any hissing to  
stop. Then remove it:  
Fuel spray is dangerous. Fuel can  
burn skin and eyes and cause illness  
if ingested. Fuel spray is released  
when there is pressure in the fuel  
tank and the fuel cap is removed too  
quickly.  
Remote fuel-filler  
lid release  
Before refueling, stop the engine, and  
always keep sparks and flames away  
from the filler neck:  
Fuel vapor is dangerous. It could be  
ignited by sparks or flames causing  
serious burns and injuries.  
Additionally, use of the incorrect fuel  
filler cap or not using a fuel filler cap  
may result in fuel leak, which could  
result in serious burns or death in an  
accident.  
qFuel-Filler Cap  
To remove the filler cap, turn it  
counterclockwise.  
To close the filler cap, turn it clockwise  
until two or more clicks are heard.  
Open  
CAUTION  
Always use only a genuine Mazda  
fuel cap or an approved equivalent,  
available at an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer. The wrong cap can result in a  
serious malfunction of the fuel and  
emission control systems. It may also  
cause the check engine light in the  
instrument cluster to illuminate.  
Close  
3-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page117  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (117,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Hood  
CAUTION  
Make sure the fuel-filler cap is  
tightened securely. The check engine  
light may illuminate when the cap  
isn't tightened securely. If the light  
remains on (even after you have  
tightened the cap securely, driven,  
and restarted the engine several  
times), it may indicate a different  
problem. Contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING  
Always check that the hood is closed  
and securely locked:  
A hood that is not closed and  
securely locked is dangerous as it  
could fly open while the vehicle is  
moving and block the driver's vision  
which could result in a serious  
accident.  
qOpening the Hood  
1. With the vehicle parked, pull the  
release handle to unlock the hood.  
Release handle  
2. Insert your hand into the hood opening  
and Slide the hood latch to the right  
and lift the hood.  
3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page118  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (118,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
3. Grasp the support rod in the padded  
area and secure it in the stay hole  
indicated by the arrow to hold the hood  
open.  
Moonroofí  
The moonroof can be opened or closed  
electrically only when the ignition switch  
is in the ON position.  
Slide switch  
Pad  
Support rod  
Clip  
Tilt switch  
qClosing the Hood  
WARNING  
1. Check under the hood area to make  
certain all filler caps are in place and  
all loose items (e.g. tools, oil  
Do not let passengers stand up or  
extend part of the body through the  
open moonroof while the vehicle is  
moving:  
containers, etc.) have been removed.  
2. Insert the support rod in its clip while  
holding up the hood. Verify that the  
support rod is secured in the clip before  
closing the hood.  
Extending the head, arms, or other  
parts of the body through the  
moonroof is dangerous. The head or  
arms could hit something while the  
vehicle is moving. This could cause  
serious injury or death.  
3. Close the hood so that it locks securely.  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing the moonroof:  
A closing moonroof is dangerous. The  
hands, head, or even neck of a  
person especially a childcould  
be caught in it as it closes, causing  
serious injury or even death.  
NOTE  
After washing your Mazda or after it rains,  
wipe the water off the moonroof before  
operating it to avoid water penetration which  
could cause rust and water damage to your  
headliner.  
3-40  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page119  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (119,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
To stop sliding partway, push any part of  
the tilt or slide switch.  
qOperating the Moonroof  
Tilt Operation  
The rear of the moonroof can be tilted  
open to provide more ventilation.  
To fully tilt automatically, momentarily  
push the rear of the tilt switch.  
To fully close automatically, momentarily  
push the front of the tilt or slide switch.  
Open  
To stop tilting partway, push any part of  
the tilt or slide switch.  
Close  
Close  
Power moonroof initialization  
procedure  
If the battery had been disconnected  
during vehicle maintenance or for other  
reasons, the moonroof may not fully open  
or close. The moonroof's jam-safe  
Tilt up  
function does not function while the  
moonroof is initializing. Carry out the  
following procedure to resume operation:  
Close  
Close  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON  
position.  
Slide Operation  
To fully open automatically, momentarily  
push the rear of the slide switch.  
To fully close automatically, momentarily  
push the front of the tilt or slide switch.  
2. Push the rear of the tilt switch, to  
partially tilt open the rear of the  
moonroof.  
NOTE  
If the re-initialization procedure is performed  
while the moonroof is in the slide position  
(partially open) it closes before the rear tilts  
opens.  
3. Repeat the procedure in Step 2. The  
rear of the moonroof tilts open to the  
fully open position, then closes a little.  
3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page120  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (120,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Opening  
qEngine-off Moonroof Operation  
Because nobody likes getting into a very  
hot car, Mazda has introduced a way to  
open the two front windows and the  
moonroof as you approach the vehicle to  
get the air moving before you get in.  
The moonroof can be operated for about  
40 seconds after the ignition switch is  
turned from the ON position to the ACC  
or LOCK position with all doors closed. If  
any door is opened, the moonroof will be  
inoperable.  
WARNING  
Use the auto-moonroof function only  
when you can see the vehicle and it is  
in a secure area:  
NOTE  
For engine-off operation of the moonroof, the  
switch must be pushed firmly throughout  
moonroof closure because the auto-closing  
function will be inoperable.  
Do not let children play with your  
keys. If they open the moonroof  
without your knowing, the open  
moonroof is an even bigger invitation  
to a thief than leaving the doors  
unlocked.  
qOpening/Closing the Moonroof  
from Outside  
The moonroof can be opened or closed  
from outside the vehicle after the doors  
and the liftgate are closed.  
The moonroof can be opened for  
ventilating the cabin before getting in the  
vehicle.  
WARNING  
Make sure the opening is clear before  
closing the moonroof:  
With unlock button (Keyless entry  
system)  
Closing the moonroof is dangerous. A  
person's hands, head, or even neck  
could be caught by the moonroof and  
result in serious injury or even death.  
This warning applies especially to  
children and pets.  
Press once, then press again within 1.5  
seconds and hold.  
After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the two front windows and the  
moonroof open as long as the unlock  
button is pressed.  
Advanced key  
NOTE  
The moonroof cannot be opened or closed  
from outside the vehicle under the following  
condition:  
Lock button  
l
A door or the liftgate is opened.  
l
The key is inserted into the ignition switch.  
Panic button  
l
Unlock button  
(With advanced key)  
The start knob is pushed into the ignition  
switch.  
3-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page121  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (121,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
Retractable type key  
2. Turn the key toward the front and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
unlocked, the moonroof fully opens  
automatically.  
Lock button  
Unlock button  
Panic button  
Open  
To stop the windows and the moonroof  
from opening, release the button.  
If the operation is performed from the  
beginning again, the windows and the  
moonroof open.  
To stop this operation, turn the key to the  
center position, then turn it toward the  
front again.  
NOTE  
l
The unlock button does not operate unless  
NOTE  
it is pressed twice sequentially.  
The lock button cannot be used to close the  
moonroof.  
The moonroof opening operation also can be  
stopped by turning the key toward the back.  
However, the doors and the liftgate will lock.  
l
With key  
Closing  
The moonroof can be closed in case it is  
left open after getting out of the vehicle.  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
NOTE  
(With advanced key)  
If the auto-lock function (page 3-8) has been  
activated, the doors and the liftgate  
automatically lock as you walk away from the  
vehicle, however, for safety reasons, the  
moonroof cannot be closed. When leaving the  
vehicle, close the moonroof using the tilt or  
slide switch inside the vehicle, the key, or a  
request switch.  
With key  
1. Insert the key in the driver's door key  
cylinder.  
3-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page122  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (122,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
2. Turn the key toward the back and hold  
it. After the doors and the liftgate are  
locked, the moonroof closes as long as  
the key is turned.  
qJam-safe Moonroof  
If a person's hands, head or an object  
blocks the moonroof during closing  
operation, the moonroof will stop and  
open halfway.  
WARNING  
Make sure nothing blocks the  
moonroof just before it reaches the  
fully closed position:  
Blocking the moonroof just before it  
reaches the closed position is  
dangerous.  
Close  
In this case, the jam-safe function  
cannot prevent the moonroof from  
stopping. If fingers are caught,  
serious injuries could occur.  
With request switch on the driver's  
door (Advanced key)  
NOTE  
1. If the doors and the liftgate are locked,  
unlock them.  
l
Depending on driving conditions, a closing  
moonroof could stop and start opening  
when the moonroof feels a shock that is  
similar to something blocking it.  
2. Press the request switch on the driver's  
door and hold it. After the doors and  
the liftgate are locked, the moonroof  
closes as long as the request switch is  
pressed.  
l
The moonroof's jam-safe function does not  
function while the moonroof is initializing.  
Request switch  
3-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page123  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (123,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Doors and Locks  
qSunshade  
The sunshade can be opened and closed  
by hand.  
The sunshade opens automatically when  
the moonroof is opened, but must be  
closed by hand.  
Sunshade  
CAUTION  
Ø The sunshade does not tilt. To  
avoid damaging the sunshade, do  
not push up on it.  
Ø Do not close the sunshade while  
the moonroof is opening. Trying to  
force the sunshade closed could  
damage it.  
3-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page124  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (124,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
Immobilizer System (with  
Advanced Key)  
CAUTION  
Do not allow the following when  
starting the engine with the auxiliary  
key due to an advanced key dead  
battery or other malfunction.  
Otherwise the signal from the  
auxiliary key will not be received  
correctly and the engine may not  
start.  
The immobilizer system allows the engine  
to start only with an advanced key the  
system recognizes.  
If someone attempts to start the engine  
with an unrecognized key, the engine will  
not start, thereby helping to prevent the  
theft of your vehicle.  
Ø Metal parts of other keys or metal  
objects touch the key grip.  
Ø Spare auxiliary keys or keys for  
other vehicles equipped with an  
immobilizer system touch or come  
near the auxiliary key.  
Ø Equipment containing electronic  
components or cards with  
CAUTION  
Ø Radio equipment like this is  
governed by laws in the United  
States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could  
void the user's authority to  
operate the equipment.  
Ø To avoid damage to the key, do  
not:  
magnetic strips such as credit  
cards come near the auxiliary key.  
NOTE  
l
(U.S.A.)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Drop the key.  
Get the key wet.  
Expose the key to any kind of  
magnetic field.  
Expose the key to high  
temperatures on places such as  
the dashboard or hood, under  
direct sunlight.  
Ø
l
(CANADA)  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
3-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page125  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (125,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
NOTE  
l
qOperation  
The engine may not start and the security  
indicator light may illuminate or flash if the  
advanced key is placed in an area where it  
is difficult for the system to detect the  
signal, such as on the dashboard, or in the  
glove box. Move the advanced key to  
another place, turn the ignition switch to  
the LOCK position, and then restart the  
engine.  
Arming  
The system is armed when the ignition  
switch is turned from the ON position to  
the ACC or LOCK position. The security  
indicator light in the instrument cluster  
flashes every 2 seconds until the system is  
disarmed.  
l
Signals from a TVor radio station, or from  
a transceiver or a mobile telephone could  
interfere with your immobilizer system. If  
you are using the proper advanced key and  
the engine fails to start, check the security  
indicator light. If the indicator light is  
flashing, turn the ignition switch to the  
ACC or LOCK position and wait for a  
while, then restart the engine. If it doesn't  
start after 3 or more tries, contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Disarming  
The system is disarmed when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position with  
the registered advanced key.  
The security indicator light illuminates for  
about 3 seconds and goes out.  
l
If the security indicator light flashes  
continuously while you are driving, don't  
shut off the engine. Go to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer and have it checked. If the  
engine is shut off while the indicator light is  
flashing, you won't be able to restart it.  
Since the electronic codes are reset when  
repairing the immobilizer system, the  
advanced key (including auxiliary key) are  
needed. Bring all the advanced keys  
(including auxiliary keys) to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If the engine doesn't start with the correct  
ignition key, and the security indicator  
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the  
system may have a malfunction. Consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
l
3-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page126  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (126,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
qMaintenance  
Immobilizer System  
If you have a problem with the  
immobilizer system or the key, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
(without Advanced Key)  
The immobilizer system allows the engine  
to start only with a key the system  
recognizes.  
NOTE  
l
The advanced keys (including auxiliary key)  
carry a unique electronic code. For this  
reason, and to assure your safety, obtaining  
a replacement advanced key (including  
auxiliary key) requires some waiting time.  
They are only available through an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
If someone attempts to start the engine  
with an unrecognized key, the engine will  
not start, thereby helping to prevent the  
theft of your vehicle.  
CAUTION  
l
Always keep a spare advanced key in case  
one is lost. If an advanced key is lost,  
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as  
soon as possible.  
Ø Radio equipment like this is  
governed by laws in the United  
States.  
Changes or modifications not  
expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could  
void the user's authority to  
operate the equipment.  
Ø To avoid damage to the key, do  
not:  
l
If you lose an advanced key (including  
auxiliary key), an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
will reset the electronic codes of your  
remaining advanced keys (including  
auxiliary keys) and immobilizer system.  
Bring all the remaining advanced keys  
(including auxiliary keys) to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer to reset.  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Drop the key.  
Starting the vehicle with a key that has not  
been reset is not possible.  
Get the key wet.  
Expose the key to any kind of  
magnetic field.  
Expose the key to high  
temperatures on places such as  
the dashboard or hood, under  
direct sunlight.  
Ø
qModification and Add-On  
Equipment  
Mazda cannot guarantee the immobilizer  
system's operation if the system has been  
modified or if any add-on equipment has  
been installed to it.  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to your vehicle, do  
not modify the system or install any  
add-on equipment to the immobilizer  
system or the vehicle.  
3-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page127  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (127,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
NOTE  
CAUTION  
l
(U.S.A.)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
this device must accept any interference  
received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
When starting the engine do not  
allow the following, as the engine  
may not start due to the electronic  
signal from the ignition key not being  
transmitted correctly.  
Ø A key ring rests on the key grip.  
l
(CANADA)  
This device complies with RSS-210 of  
Industry CANADA. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions: (1) this device  
may not cause interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause  
undesired operation of the device.  
Ø Metal parts of other keys or metal  
objects touch the key grip.  
qOperation  
Arming  
The system is armed when the ignition  
switch is turned from the ON to the ACC  
position.  
The security indicator light in the  
instrument panel flashes every 2 seconds  
until the system is disarmed.  
Ø Spare keys or keys for other  
vehicles equipped with an  
immobilizer system touch or come  
near the key grip.  
Disarming  
The system is disarmed when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position with  
the correct ignition key.  
The security indicator light illuminates for  
about 3 seconds and goes out.  
Ø Devices for electronic purchases, or  
security passage touch or come  
near the key.  
3-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page128  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (128,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
If the engine doesn't start with the correct  
ignition key, and the security indicator  
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the  
system may have a malfunction. Consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qMaintenance  
If you have a problem with the  
immobilizer system or the key, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
l
The keys carry a unique electronic code.  
l
If the security indicator light comes on and  
stays on when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position, the engine will not start.  
For this reason, and to assure your safety,  
obtaining replacement key requires some  
waiting time. They are only available  
through an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
l
Signals from a TVor radio station, or from  
a transceiver or a mobile telephone, could  
interfere with your immobilizer system. If  
you are using the proper key and your  
engine fails to start, check the security  
indicator light. If it is flashing, remove the  
ignition key and wait 2 seconds or more,  
then reinsert it and try starting the engine  
again. If it doesn't start after 3 or more  
tries, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
l
Always keep a spare key, in case one is lost.  
If a key is lost, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
l
If you lose a key, an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer will reset the electronic codes of  
your remaining keys and immobilizer  
system. Bring all the remaining keys to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to reset.  
Starting the vehicle with a key that has not  
been reset is not possible.  
l
If the security indicator light flashes  
continuously while you are driving, don't  
shut off the engine. Go to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer and have it checked. If you  
shut off the engine while the light is  
qModification and Add-On  
Equipment  
flashing you won't be able to restart it.  
Since the electronic codes are reset when  
repairing the immobilizer system, the keys  
are needed. Bring all the existing keys to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Mazda cannot guarantee the immobilizer  
system's operation if the system has been  
modified or if any add-on equipment has  
been installed to it.  
l
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to your vehicle, do  
not modify the system or install any  
add-on equipment to the immobilizer  
system or the vehicle.  
3-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page129  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (129,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
l
Opening the hood by operating the  
hood release handle.  
Theft-Deterrent Systemí  
If the system is triggered again, the lights  
and horn will activate until a door or the  
liftgate is unlocked with the key or with  
the transmitter.  
(With advanced key)  
The lights and horn can also be  
If the theft deterrent system detects an  
inappropriate entry into the vehicle, which  
could result in the vehicle or its contents  
being stolen, the alarm alerts the  
surrounding area of an abnormality by  
sounding the horn and flashing the hazard  
warning lights.  
deactivated by pressing a request switch.  
Refer to Operation on page 3-51.  
qHow to Arm the System  
NOTE  
l
The theft-deterrent system operates with the  
1. Remove the key from the ignition  
switch.  
key or the keyless entry system transmitter.  
l
(With advanced key)  
(With advanced key)  
Turn the start knob to the LOCK  
position.  
The theft-deterrent system can also be  
operated using a request switch or the start  
knob.  
The system operates only when the driver is  
in the vehicle or within operational range  
while the advanced key is being carried.  
2. Make sure the hood is closed. Close  
and lock all doors and the liftgate from  
the outside using the key or press the  
lock button on your keyless entry  
system transmitter.  
l
The system will not function unless it is  
properly armed. To properly secure the  
vehicle, always make sure all windows are  
completely closed and all doors and the  
liftgate are locked before leaving the  
vehicle. Remember to take your key and  
transmitter.  
(With advanced key)  
Press a request switch or the lock  
button on the transmitter.  
(Without advanced key)  
The following method will also arm the  
theft-deterrent system:  
Close the hood and the liftgate . Press  
the area on the door-lock switch  
marked “ ” once. Close all doors.  
qOperation  
System triggering conditions  
The horn sounds intermittently and the  
hazard warning lights flash for about 25  
seconds when the system is triggered by  
any one of the following:  
The hazard warning lights will flash once.  
The theft deterrent system can also be  
armed by activating the auto re-lock  
function with all the doors, the liftgate and  
the hood closed.  
l
Forcing open a door, the hood or the  
liftgate.  
l
Unlocking a door with the inside door-  
NOTE  
lock knob.  
Unlocking a door with the door lock  
Locking the doors with the inside door-lock  
knob will not arm the system.  
l
switch.  
3. After 20 seconds, the system is fully  
armed.  
l
Opening a door by operating an inside  
door-lock knob.  
íSome models.  
3-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page130  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (130,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
l
NOTE  
(With advanced key)  
l
l
Auto re-lock function  
Press a request switch or the unlock  
button on the transmitter.  
Turn the start knob to the ON  
position.  
After unlocking with the transmitter or the  
request switch, all doors and the liftgate  
will automatically lock and the hazard  
warning lights will flash if any of the  
following operations are not performed  
within about 30 seconds.  
l
The hazard warning lights will flash twice  
to indicate that the system is turned off.  
l
A door or the liftgate is opened.  
The auxiliary key inserted into the  
l
qTo Stop an Alarm  
ignition switch (with advanced key).  
The start knob is pushed (with advanced  
A triggered alarm can be turned off by  
any one of the following methods:  
l
key).  
l
Unlock a door with the key.  
Press the unlock button on the keyless  
entry system transmitter.  
The engine is started with the ignition  
l
The system will disarm if one of the  
l
following operations takes place within 20  
seconds after closing and locking all the  
doors and the liftgate:  
l
key or the start knob.  
(With advanced key)  
l
Pressing the unlock button on the  
l
transmitter.  
Any door or the liftgate is opened.  
Unlocking a door with the inside door-  
l
Press a request switch.  
Press the unlock button on the  
l
l
l
transmitter.  
lock knob.  
The hood is opened.  
The key is inserted in the ignition switch.  
(With advanced key)  
l
NOTE  
l
If you have any problem with the theft-  
deterrent system, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
l
The start knob is pressed into the  
ignition switch or a request switch is  
pressed.  
qTheft-Deterrent Labels  
l
The ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position.  
To rearm the system, do the arming  
procedure again.  
qTo Turn off an Armed System  
An armed system can be turned off by any  
one of the following methods:  
l
Unlock a door with the key.  
Press the unlock button on the keyless  
l
entry system transmitter.  
Insert the key into the ignition switch  
l
and turn it to the ON position.  
A label indicating that your vehicle is  
equipped with a Theft-Deterrent System is  
in the glove box.  
3-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page131  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (131,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Security System  
Mazda recommends that you affix it to the  
lower rear corner of a front door window.  
3-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page132  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (132,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Steering Wheel and Mirrors  
Steering Wheel  
Mirrors  
qOutside Mirrors  
WARNING  
Never adjust the steering wheel while  
the vehicle is moving:  
Check the mirror angles before driving.  
Mirror type  
Adjusting the steering wheel while  
the vehicle is moving is dangerous.  
Moving it can very easily cause the  
driver to abruptly turn to the left or  
right. This can lead to loss of control  
or an accident.  
Flat type (driver's side)  
Flat surface mirror.  
Convex type (front passenger side)  
The mirror has single curvature on its  
surface.  
WARNING  
qTilt Steering Wheel  
Be sure to look over your shoulder  
before changing lanes:  
To change the angle of the steering wheel,  
stop the vehicle, pull the tilt wheel release  
lever under the steering column down,  
adjust the wheel, then push the release  
lever up to lock the column.  
Changing lanes without taking into  
account the actual distance of the  
vehicle in the convex mirror is  
dangerous. You could have a serious  
accident. What you see in the convex  
mirror is closer than it appears.  
Tilt wheel release  
lever  
Power mirror  
The ignition switch must be in the ACC  
or ON position.  
To adjust:  
1. Press the left or right side of the  
selector switch to choose the left or  
right side mirror.  
After adjusting, push the wheel up and  
down to be certain it's locked before  
driving.  
3-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page133  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (133,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Steering Wheel and Mirrors  
2. Depress the mirror switch in the  
appropriate direction.  
Mirror defrosterí  
To turn on the mirror defrosters, turn the  
ignition switch to the ON position and  
push the rear window defroster switch  
(page 5-59).  
Selector switch  
Outside mirror  
qRearview Mirror  
Mirror switch  
Rearview mirror adjustment  
Before driving, adjust the rearview mirror  
to center on the scene through the rear  
window.  
After adjusting the mirror, lock the control  
by placing the selector switch in the  
middle position.  
Folding the mirror  
Fold the outside mirror rearward until it is  
flush with the vehicle.  
Reducing glare from headlights  
Adjust the mirror with the day/night lever  
in the day position.  
Push the lever forward for day driving.  
Pull it back to reduce glare from  
headlights.  
Day/Night lever  
WARNING  
Always return the outside mirrors to  
the driving position before you start  
driving:  
Driving with the outside mirrors  
folded in is dangerous. Your rear view  
will be restricted, and you could have  
an accident.  
Day  
Night  
íSome models.  
3-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page134  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (134,1)  
Knowing Your Mazda  
Steering Wheel and Mirrors  
WARNING  
Do not stack cargo or objects higher  
than the seatbacks:  
Cargo stacked higher than the  
seatbacks is dangerous. It can block  
your view in the rearview mirror,  
which might cause you to hit another  
car when changing lanes.  
3-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page135  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (135,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
4
Important information about driving your Mazda.  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page136  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (136,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Fuel and Engine Exhaust Precautions  
Fuel Requirements  
Vehicles with catalytic converters or oxygen sensors must use ONLY UNLEADED FUEL,  
which will reduce exhaust emissions and keep spark plug fouling to a minimum.  
Your Mazda will perform best with fuel listed in the table.  
Fuel  
Octane Rating*(Anti-knock index)  
Premium unleaded fuel  
91 [ (R+M)/2 method] (96 RON) recommended  
* U.S. federal law requires that octane ratings be posted on gasoline station pumps.  
This vehicle is designed to use 91 [ (R+M)/2 method] (96RON) or higher gasoline for best  
performance. If 91 [ (R+M)/2 method] (96RON) is not available, 87[ (R+M)/2 method]  
(91RON) gasoline can be used. Use of gasoline lower than 91 [ (R+M)/2 method]  
(96RON) can decrease performance, deteriorate shift quality and cause engine knocking  
during its use.  
CAUTION  
Ø USE ONLY UNLEADED FUEL.  
Leaded fuel is harmful to the catalytic converter and oxygen sensors and will lead  
to deterioration of the emission control system and or failures.  
Ø Your vehicle can only use oxygenated fuels containing no more than 10% ethanol  
by volume. Damage to your vehicle may occur when ethanol exceeds this  
recommendation, or if the gasoline contains any methanol. Stop using gasohol of  
any kind if your vehicle engine is performing poorly.  
Ø Never add fuel system additives. Never add cleaning agents other than those  
specified by Mazda. Other cleaning agents and additives may damage the system.  
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Gasoline blended with oxygenates such as alcohol or ether compounds are generally  
referred to as oxygenated fuels. The common gasoline blend that can be used with your  
vehicle is ethanol blended at no more than 10%. Gasoline containing alcohol, such as  
ethanol or methanol, may be marketed under the name Gasohol.  
Vehicle damage and drivability problems resulting from the use of the following may not  
be covered by the Mazda warranty.  
l
Gasohol containing more than 10% ethanol.  
Gasoline or gasohol containing methanol.  
Leaded fuel or leaded gasohol.  
l
l
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page137  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (137,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Fuel and Engine Exhaust Precautions  
Emission Control System  
Your vehicle is equipped with an emission control system (the catalytic converter is part of  
this system) that enables your vehicle to comply with existing exhaust emissions  
requirements.  
WARNING  
Never park over or near anything flammable:  
Parking over or near anything flammable, such as dry grass, is dangerous. Even with  
the engine turned off, the exhaust system remains very hot after normal use and  
could ignite anything flammable. A resulting fire could cause serious injury or death.  
CAUTION  
Ignoring the following precautions could cause lead to accumulate on the catalyst  
inside the converter or cause the converter to get very hot. Either condition will  
damage the converter and cause poor performance.  
Ø USE ONLY UNLEADED FUEL.  
Ø Don't drive your Mazda with any sign of engine malfunction.  
Ø Don't coast with the ignition switch turned off.  
Ø Don't descend steep grades in gear with the ignition switch turned off.  
Ø Don't operate the engine at high idle for more than 2 minutes.  
Ø Don't tamper with the emission control system. All inspections and adjustments  
must be made by a qualified technician.  
Ø Don't push-start or pull-start your vehicle.  
NOTE  
Under U.S. federal law, any modification to the original-equipment emission control system before  
the first sale and registration of a vehicle is subject to penalties. In some states, such modification  
made on a used vehicle is also subject to penalties.  
NOTE  
While the engine is off, the sound of a valve opening and closing can be heard at the middle rear of  
the vehicle, however this does not indicate an abnormality. Your vehicle has a self-checking device  
and it operates while the engine is off.  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page138  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (138,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Fuel and Engine Exhaust Precautions  
Engine Exhaust (Carbon Monoxide)  
WARNING  
Do not drive your vehicle if you smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle:  
Engine exhaust gas is dangerous. This gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), which is  
colorless, odorless, and poisonous. When inhaled, it can cause loss of consciousness  
and death. If you smell exhaust gas inside your vehicle, keep all windows fully open  
and contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer immediately.  
Do not run the engine when inside an enclosed area:  
Running the engine inside an enclosed area, such as a garage, is dangerous. Exhaust  
gas, which contains poisonous carbon monoxide, could easily enter the cabin. Loss  
of consciousness or even death could occur.  
Open the windows or adjust the heating or cooling system to draw fresh air when  
idling the engine:  
Exhaust gas is dangerous. When your vehicle is stopped with the windows closed  
and the engine running for a long time even in an open area, exhaust gas, which  
contains poisonous carbon monoxide, could enter the cabin. Loss of consciousness or  
even death could occur.  
Clear snow from underneath and around your vehicle, particularly the tail pipe,  
before starting the engine:  
Running the engine when a vehicle is stopped in deep snow is dangerous. The  
exhaust pipe could be blocked by the snow, allowing exhaust gas to enter the cabin.  
Because exhaust gas contains poisonous carbon monoxide, it could cause loss of  
consciousness or even death to occupants in the cabin.  
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page139  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (139,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Before Starting the Engine  
Before Getting In  
After Getting In  
l
l
l
l
Be sure the windows, outside mirrors,  
and outside lights are clean.  
Inspect inflation pressures and  
condition of tires.  
Look under the vehicle for any sign of  
fluid leaks.  
If you plan to back up, make sure  
nothing is in your way.  
Are all doors closed and locked?  
Is the seat adjusted properly?  
Are the inside and outside mirrors  
adjusted?  
Is everyone's seat belt fastened?  
Check all gauges.  
Check all warning lights when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position.  
Release the parking brake and make  
sure the brake warning light goes off.  
l
l
l
l
l
l
NOTE  
l
Engine oil, engine coolant, brake fluid, washer  
fluid, and other fluid levels should be  
inspected. See Maintenance, Section 8.  
Always be thoroughly familiar with your  
Mazda.  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page140  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (140,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Break-In Period  
Money-Saving Suggestions  
No special break-in is necessary, but a few  
precautions in the first 1,000 km (600  
miles) may add to the performance,  
economy, and life of your Mazda.  
How you operate your Mazda determines  
how far it will travel on a tank of fuel. Use  
these suggestions to help save money on  
fuel and repairs.  
l
l
Don't race the engine.  
Don't maintain one constant speed,  
Avoid long warm-ups. Once the engine  
l
runs smoothly, begin driving.  
Avoid fast starts.  
Keep the engine tuned. Follow the  
l
either slow or fast, for a long period of  
time.  
Don't drive constantly at full-throttle or  
l
l
maintenance schedule (page 8-3) and  
have an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
perform inspections and servicing.  
high engine rpm for extended periods  
of time.  
Avoid unnecessary hard stops.  
Avoid full-throttle starts.  
Don't tow a trailer.  
l
l
Use the air conditioner only when  
l
necessary.  
Slow down on rough roads.  
Keep the tires properly inflated.  
Don't carry unnecessary weight.  
l
l
l
l
l
Don't rest your foot on the brake pedal  
while driving.  
Keep the wheels in correct alignment.  
Keep windows closed at high speeds.  
Slow down when driving in crosswinds  
l
l
l
and headwinds.  
WARNING  
Never stop the engine when going  
down a hill:  
Stopping the engine when going  
down a hill is dangerous. This causes  
the loss of power steering and power  
brake control, and may cause  
damage to the drivetrain. Any loss of  
steering or braking control could  
cause an accident.  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page141  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (141,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
qRoll-over  
Hazardous Driving  
WARNING  
qDriving on Slippery Surface  
Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvers when driving this  
vehicle:  
WARNING  
Be extremely careful if it is necessary to  
downshift on slippery surfaces:  
Downshifting into lower gear while  
driving on slippery surfaces is  
Sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvering of this vehicle is  
dangerous as it could result in the  
increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle roll-over, personal  
injury or death.  
This vehicle has a higher center of  
gravity. Vehicles with a higher center  
of gravity such as utility and AWD  
vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of  
gravity.  
Utility and AWD vehicles are not  
designed for cornering at speeds as  
any more than low profile sports cars  
are designed to perform satisfactorily  
under off-road conditions. In  
addition, utility vehicles have a  
significantly higher rollover rate than  
other types of vehicles.  
RSC might help if you get into  
trouble, but then it might not be able  
to allow you to fully recover, always  
drive carefully with the vehicle's  
height in mind.  
dangerous. The sudden change in tire  
speed could cause the tires to skid.  
This could lead to loss of vehicle  
control and an accident.  
Do not rely on ABS as a substitute for  
safe driving:  
The ABS cannot compensate for  
unsafe and reckless driving, excessive  
speed, tailgating (following another  
vehicle too closely), driving on ice and  
snow, and hydroplaning (reduced tire  
friction and road contact because of  
water on the road surface). You can  
still have an accident.  
When driving on ice or in water, snow,  
mud, sand, or similar hazards:  
l
Be cautious and allow extra distance  
for braking.  
Avoid sudden braking and sudden  
maneuvering.  
Do not pump the brakes. Continue to  
press down on the brake pedal.  
If you get stuck, select a lower gear and  
accelerate slowly. Do not spin the front  
wheels.  
l
l
Drive carefully when the vehicle is  
loaded by lowering vehicle speed and  
applying the brakes earlier:  
l
Abrupt maneuvering and sudden  
braking when driving a loaded  
vehicle is dangerous as the driving  
behavior of a vehicle with a high  
center of gravity is different when it is  
loaded compared to when it is not,  
and could result in the loss of vehicle  
control and an accident.  
l
For more traction in starting on  
slippery surfaces such as ice or packed  
snow, use sand, rock salt, chains,  
carpeting, or other nonslip material  
under the front wheels.  
NOTE  
Use snow chains only on the front wheels.  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page142  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (142,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Rocking the Vehicle  
Winter Driving  
l
Carry emergency gear, including tire  
chains, window scraper, flares, a small  
shovel, jumper cables, and a small bag  
of sand or salt.  
WARNING  
Do not spin the wheels at more than 56  
km/h (35 mph), and do not allow  
anyone to stand behind a wheel when  
pushing the vehicle:  
Ask an Authorized Mazda Dealer to  
perform the following precautions:  
When the vehicle is stuck, spinning  
the wheels at high speed is  
dangerous. The spinning tire could  
overheat and explode. This could  
cause serious injuries.  
l
Have the proper ratio of antifreeze in  
the radiator.  
Refer to Engine Coolant on page 8-21.  
Inspect the battery and its cables. Cold  
l
reduces battery capacity.  
Inspect the ignition system for damage  
l
and loose connections.  
Use washer fluid made with  
antifreezebut don't use engine  
coolant antifreeze for washer fluid  
(page 8-27).  
CAUTION  
Too much rocking may cause engine  
overheating, transaxle failure, and  
tire damage.  
l
l
Don't use the parking brake in freezing  
If you must rock the vehicle to free it from  
snow, sand or mud, depress the  
accelerator slightly and slowly move the  
shift lever from D to R.  
weather as the parking brake may  
freeze. Instead, shift to P and block the  
rear wheels.  
qSnow Tires  
Use snow tires on all four wheels  
Don't go faster than 120 km/h (75 mph)  
while driving with snow tires. Inflate  
snow tires 30 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi)  
more than recommended on the tire  
pressure label (driver's door frame), but  
never more than the maximum cold-tire  
pressure shown on the tires.  
WARNING  
Use only the same size and type tires  
(snow, radial, or non-radial) on all four  
wheels:  
Using tires different in size or type is  
dangerous. Your vehicle's handling  
could be greatly affected and result  
in an accident.  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page143  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (143,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Installing the chains  
CAUTION  
Check local regulations before using  
studded tires.  
1. Secure the chains on the front tires as  
tightly as possible. Always follow the  
chain manufacturer's instructions.  
NOTE  
2. Retighten the chains after driving 1/2  
If your vehicle is equipped with the tire  
pressure monitoring system, the system may  
not function correctly when using tires with  
steel wire reinforcement in the sidewalls (page  
1 km (1/41/2 mile).  
qTire Chains  
Check local regulations before using tire  
chains.  
CAUTION  
Ø Chains may affect handling.  
Ø Do not go faster than 50 km/h (30  
mph) or the chain manufacturer's  
recommended limit, whichever is  
lower.  
Ø Drive carefully and avoid bumps,  
holes, and sharp turns.  
Ø Avoid locked-wheel braking.  
Ø Do not use chains on a temporary  
spare tire; it may result in damage  
to the vehicle and to the tire.  
Ø Do not use chains on roads that  
are free of snow or ice. The tires  
and chains could be damaged.  
Ø Chains may scratch or chip  
aluminum wheels.  
NOTE  
If your vehicle is equipped with the tire  
pressure monitoring system, the system may  
not function correctly when using tire chains.  
Install the chains on the front tires.  
Do not use chains on the rear tires.  
Please consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page144  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (144,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Driving In Flooded Area  
Overloading  
WARNING  
WARNING  
Dry wet brakes by driving very slowly  
and applying the brakes lightly until  
brake performance returns to normal:  
Driving with wet brakes is  
Be careful not to overload your vehicle:  
The gross axle weight rating (GAWR)  
and the gross vehicle weight rating  
(GVWR) of your vehicle are on the  
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label  
on the driver's door frame. Exceeding  
these ratings can cause an accident  
or vehicle damage. You can estimate  
the weight of your load by weighing  
the items (or people) before putting  
them in the vehicle.  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
CAUTION  
Do not drive the vehicle on flooded  
roads as it could cause short  
circuiting of electrical/electronic  
parts, or engine damage or stalling  
from water absorption. If the vehicle  
has been immersed in water, consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page145  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (145,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Driving Tips  
Turbocharger Information  
The turbocharger greatly enhances engine power. Its advanced design provides improved  
operation and requires minimum additional maintenance. To get maximum performance  
from your turbocharged engine, take note of the following tips:  
l
The turbocharged engine is designed for optimal operation with premium unleaded  
gasoline (page 4-2). Do not use fuel with a lower octane rating. Extra fuel additives are  
NOT recommended.  
Change the engine oil and filter using the turbo engine interval outlined in the  
l
maintenance schedule (for your driving condition).  
Use only the recommended engine oil (page 8-19). Extra oil additives are NOT  
l
recommended.  
l
After driving at freeway speeds or up a long hill, idle the engine at least 30 seconds to  
cool the turbo before turning off the engine. Avoid simply shutting the engine off  
abruptly after a hard or long drive. Damage to the turbocharger may result.  
Don't race or over-rev the engine when starting. This should not be done with ANY  
l
engine, especially not with one that's turbocharged.  
Do not add any aftermarket devices to alter the engine's ignition timing, fuel delivery, or  
l
turbo boost pressure. This may lead to serious engine damage and may void your  
warranty.  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page146  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (146,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
Trailer Towing  
Your Mazda was designed and built primarily to carry passengers and cargo.  
If you tow a trailer, follow these instructions because driver and passenger safety depends  
on proper equipment and safe driving habits. Towing a trailer will affect handling, braking,  
durability, performance, and economy.  
Never overload vehicle or trailer. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer if you need further  
details.  
CAUTION  
Don't tow a trailer during the first 1,000 km (600 miles) of your new Mazda. If you  
do, you may damage the engine, transaxle, differential, wheel bearings, and other  
power train components.  
qWeight Limits  
TTW and GCWR  
The total trailer weight (TTW), gross combination weight rating (GCWR), gross axle  
weight rating (GAWR), trailer load, and trailer tongue load must be within the  
prescribed limits.  
l
The total trailer weight (TTW) is the sum of the weights of the trailer load (trailer  
weight plus cargo), trailer hitch, vehicle passengers, and vehicle load. Never allow  
the total trailer weight (TTW) to exceed specifications in the Trailer Towing-Load  
Table.  
l
The maximum GCWR is the combination weight of the trailer and load plus the  
towing vehicle (including trailer hitch, vehicle passengers, and load). It must not  
exceed specifications in the load table.  
GAWR and GVWR  
Don't exceed front and rear GAWR (gross axle weight rating) and GVWR (gross vehicle  
weight rating). If you do, vehicle handling, braking, and performance will be affected.  
These values are also on the Motor Vehicle Safety Certification Label posted on the driver's  
door frame.  
High-altitude operation  
In a high-altitude operating environment, a gasoline engine loses power at a rate of 3% to  
4% per 304 m (1,000 ft) of elevation. In these conditions, a reduction in gross vehicle  
weight and gross combination weight is recommended.  
4-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page147  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (147,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
TRAILER TOWING-LOAD TABLE  
Because vehicle weights vary, adjustments must be made to meet the requirements in this  
table.  
Model  
Item  
2WD  
AWD  
MAX. FRONTAL  
AREA  
2.97 m2(32 ft2)  
Add trailer's weight, load and hitch; vehicle  
passengers and vehicle load*  
* i.e. baggage, food, camp gear  
MAX. TTW  
907 kg (2,000 lb)  
MAX. GCWR  
MAX. GAWR  
2,815 kg (6,206 lb) 2,914 kg (6,424 lb)  
1,150 kg (2,535 lb) 1,189 kg (2,621 lb)  
1,022 kg (2,253 lb) 1,083 kg (2,388 lb)  
Front  
Rear  
MAX. GVWR  
2,168 kg (4,780 lb) 2,267 kg (4,998 lb)  
Tongue load  
Trailer load  
Tongue load/Trailer load × 100 = 10% to  
15%  
TRAILER-TON-  
GUE LOAD  
Front  
Rear  
60%  
40%  
DISTRIBUTION  
OF TRAILER  
LOAD  
GCWR: Gross Combination Weight Rating (sum of TTW, vehicle weights and 2  
passengers)  
GAWR: Gross Axle Weight Rating  
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page148  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (148,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
WARNING  
Always keep tow loads within specified limits as indicated in the Trailer Towing-Load  
Table:  
Attempting to tow loads greater than those specified is dangerous as it may cause  
serious handling and performance problems that could result in personal injury or  
vehicle damage, or both.  
Load your trailer with the weight about 60% toward the front and 40% toward the  
rear:  
Loading the trailer with more weight in the rear than in the front is dangerous.  
Doing so could cause you to lose control. The trailer tongue load must be 10%15%  
of the total trailer load (sum of the weights of the trailer and cargo).  
Always have the total trailer weight and tongue load determined prior to departure:  
Attempting to tow loads without determining the total trailer weight and tongue  
load is dangerous. Trailer sway from crosswinds, rough roads or other causes could  
result in loss of control and a serious accident.  
CAUTION  
The total trailer weight and tongue load can be determined by weighing the trailer  
on platform scales at a highway weight station or a trucking company.  
qTrailer Hitch  
Use only a hitch ball recommended by the trailer manufacturer that conforms to the gross  
trailer weight requirement.  
When not towing a trailer, remove the trailer hitch (if detachable) to reduce the possibility  
of damage as a result of the vehicle being rear-ended.  
4-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page149  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:17 PM  
Black plate (149,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
WARNING  
Always make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached before departure:  
An unsecured trailer hitch is dangerous as it causes greater trailer sway from  
crosswinds, rough roads or other causes, resulting in loss of control and a serious  
accident.  
Examine all trailer-hitch mounting bolts regularly and tighten any that are loose. If  
the hitch is removed, seal any open mounting holes to prevent exhaust, dust, water,  
dirt and other foreign elements from filtering in, possibly endangering personal  
safety and damaging your vehicle.  
Do not install a hitch that stiffens the bumper as it will reduce the bumper's  
performance.  
Make sure there are no exhaust gas leaks into the passenger compartment if any  
mounting bolts are connected to the body:  
Modifying your vehicle exhaust system is dangerous. Exhaust gas entering the  
vehicle could cause loss of consciousness or even death.  
When mounting the trailer hitch, make no modifications to the vehicle exhaust  
system.  
CAUTION  
Ø Make all hitch adjustments with actual loads. Don't load and unload vehicle while  
adjusting hitch. This action will change the vehicle height.  
Ø Don't use an axle-mounted hitch. This may damage the axle and related parts.  
qTires  
When towing a trailer, make sure all tires are inflated to the recommended cold-tire  
pressure, as indicated on the tire pressure chart on the driver's door frame. Trailer tire size,  
load rating, and inflation pressures should conform to tire manufacturer specifications.  
WARNING  
Never use the temporary spare tire when towing:  
Using the temporary spare tire on your vehicle when towing a trailer is dangerous as  
it could result in tire failure, loss of control, and injury to vehicle occupants.  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page150  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (150,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
qSafety Chains  
Safety chains must be used as a precautionary measure should the trailer become  
unintentionally unhitched. They should cross under the trailer tongue and attach to the  
hitch. Leave enough slack to allow full turns. Consult literature published by your trailer or  
hitch manufacturer for more details.  
WARNING  
Make sure the safety chain is securely attached to both the trailer and the vehicle  
prior to departure:  
Towing a trailer without using a safety chain securely attached to both the trailer  
and the vehicle is dangerous. If damage occurs to the coupling unit or hitch ball, the  
trailer could wander into another lane and cause a collision.  
qTrailer Lights  
Trailer lights must comply with all federal, state, and local regulations. Equip your trailer  
as required before towing it day or night.  
CAUTION  
Don't connect a trailer lighting system directly to the lighting system of your Mazda.  
This may damage your vehicle's electrical system and lighting systems. Have a  
recreational vehicle dealer or trailer rental agency connect the system, and inspect  
the brake lights and turn signals yourself before each trip.  
qTrailer Brakes  
If the total trailer weight exceeds 450 kg (1,000 lb), trailer brakes are required. If your  
trailer has brakes, make sure they comply with all federal, state, and local regulations.  
WARNING  
Do not connect a hydraulic trailer-brake system to your vehicle's brake system:  
Connecting a hydraulic trailer-brake system directly to the vehicle brake system is  
dangerous and will result in inadequate braking and possible injury.  
qTrailer Towing Tips  
l
Verify that your Mazda maintains a near-normal attitude when a loaded or unloaded  
trailer is connected. Don't drive if it has an abnormal front-up or front-down position.  
Inspect for incorrect tongue load, worn suspension parts, and trailer overloading.  
Make sure the trailer is properly loaded and the cargo is secure to prevent it from  
l
shifting.  
l
Make sure the mirrors conform to all government regulations. If they do not, install  
required rear view mirrors appropriate for towing purposes.  
4-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page151  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (151,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
The three main causes of vehicle-trailer accidents are driver error, excessive speed, and  
improper trailer loading.  
Before driving  
l
Have your cooling and braking system checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Before starting out, inspect the operation of all vehicle and trailer lights and all vehicle-  
l
to-trailer connections. Stop and re-inspect all lights and connections after driving a short  
distance.  
Driving  
l
Your Mazda will handle differently with a trailer in tow, so practice turning, backing,  
and stopping in a traffic-free area.  
Take time to get accustomed to the extra weight and length.  
Allow more room between your vehicle and the one in front because braking distance  
l
l
increases with a trailer. For each 16 km/h (10 mph) of speed, allow at least one vehicle  
and trailer length between your Mazda and the vehicle ahead.  
Avoid jerky starts or sudden acceleration.  
l
l
Avoid sudden braking. It may cause loss of control and result in jackknifing, especially  
so on wet or slippery roads.  
Shift the shift lever to the D position when towing a trailer in hilly terrain or when  
l
heavily loaded.  
These positions will allow operating the vehicle without frequent shifting.  
Lane changes and turning  
Avoid quick lane changes, sudden turns, and tight turns. Slow down before turning to  
avoid the need of sudden braking.  
A turning trailer will make a tighter arc than the tow vehicle. Compensate with turns that  
are larger than normal.  
Passing  
Plan well ahead to pass other vehicles, and provide plenty of room before changing lanes.  
Crosswinds from passing vehicles, especially larger ones, and the effects of rough roads  
will affect handling.  
If swaying occurs, firmly grip the steering wheel and reduce speed immediately, but  
gradually.  
Steer straight ahead. If no extreme correction of steering or braking is made, the  
combination of less speed and firm steering will result in stability.  
Backing up  
Backing a vehicle with a trailer requires practice and patience. Back slowly, and have a  
helper outside at the rear of the trailer to reduce the risk of an accident.  
To turn the trailer, place your hand at the bottom of the steering wheel and turn it in the  
direction you want the trailer to go. Make only slight movements to prevent sharp or  
prolonged turning.  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page152  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (152,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
Ascending a hill  
Shift into a lower gear to reduce the possibility of overloading or overheating the engine, or  
both.  
Descending a hill  
Shift into a lower gear and use engine compression as a braking effect.  
WARNING  
Always use lower gears to reduce speed:  
Holding the brake pedal down too long or too frequently is dangerous as it could  
cause the brakes to overheat and lose power, resulting in loss of control and a  
serious accident. Use lower gears to help reduce speed. Pull off the road and allow  
brakes to cool down whenever braking performance feels reduced.  
Overheated engine  
The extra weight of the trailer may strain the engine on hot days and on long or steep  
upgrades.  
If the temperature gauge indicates overheating, turn off the air conditioner, drive safely to  
the side of the road, park off the right-of-way and wait for engine to cool. Refer to  
Overheating (page 7-11).  
Parking  
Always make sure the tires of the trailer and the tow vehicle are blocked while parked.  
Apply the parking brake firmly and put the transaxle in P.  
Avoid parking on an incline, but if you must, follow these instructions:  
1. Depress and hold down the brake pedal.  
2. Have a helper put wheel blocks against the downhill side of all vehicle and trailer tires.  
3. Then release the brake pedal slowly until the blocks bear the load.  
l
If the grade is downhill, turn the steering wheel so that the front of the front tires face  
the curb.  
l
If it is uphill, face the rear of the front tires against the curb.  
4. Firmly apply the parking brake.  
5. Shift the transaxle into P, and stop the engine.  
To restart after parking on an incline:  
1. With the transaxle in P, start the engine. (Be sure to depress and hold the brake pedal.)  
2. Shift into gear.  
4-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page153  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (153,1)  
Before Driving Your Mazda  
Towing  
3. Release the parking brake (also the foot brake) and pull away from the wheel blocks.  
Stop; apply the parking brake and shift into P.  
4. Have a helper retrieve the wheel blocks.  
Fuel consumption  
Trailer towing causes higher fuel consumption.  
Maintenance  
If you tow a trailer frequently, have your vehicle serviced as shown in Scheduled  
Maintenance (page 8-3).  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page154  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (154,1)  
4-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page155  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (155,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
5
Explanation of instruments and controls.  
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) Operationí ..................................... 5-16  
Tire Pressure Monitoring Systemí ......................................... 5-27  
Fog Lightsí ............................................................................ 5-56  
íSome models.  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page156  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (156,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qIgnition Switch Positions  
Ignition Switch  
With advanced  
key  
Auxiliary key (with advanced key)  
NOTE  
When starting the engine using the advanced  
key, refer to Starting the Engine (page 3-9).  
When starting the engine with the  
auxiliary key, perform the following  
procedure.  
Without advanced  
key  
1. Remove the auxiliary key from the  
advanced key (page 3-15).  
LOCK  
2. Make sure the start knob is in LOCK  
position.  
The steering wheel locks to protect  
against theft. Only in this position can the  
key be removed.  
3. Remove the start knob by pulling it  
outward while pressing the buttons on  
both the left and right sides.  
4. Insert the auxiliary key in the ignition  
switch.  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page157  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (157,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
ON  
WARNING  
This is the normal running position after  
the engine is started. The warning lights  
(except brakes) should be inspected  
before the engine is started (page 5-38).  
Remove the key only when the vehicle  
is parked:  
Removing the key from the ignition  
switch while the vehicle is moving is  
dangerous. Removing the key allows  
the steering wheel to lock. You will  
lose steering control and a serious  
accident could occur. (For vehicles  
equipped with the advanced key, the  
steering wheel locks when the starter  
knob is turned to the LOCK position.)  
NOTE  
When the ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position, the sound of the fuel pump motor  
operating near the fuel tank can be heard. This  
does not indicate an abnormality.  
START  
The engine is started in this position. It  
will crank until you release the key; then  
it returns to the ON position. The brake  
warning light can be checked after the  
engine is started (page 5-38).  
Before leaving the driver's seat, always  
put the key or start knob to LOCK  
position, set the parking brake and  
make sure the shift lever is in P:  
Intentionally placing the key or start  
knob into LOCK position is much  
more important where you will not  
be removing the key to leave the  
vehicle and because leaving it in  
other positions will disable some of  
the vehicle security systems and run  
the battery down.  
qIgnition Key Reminder  
If the ignition switch is in the LOCK or  
ACC position with the key inserted, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard  
when the driver's door is opened.  
Leaving the driver's seat without  
putting the ignition switch in LOCK  
position, setting the parking brake  
and the shift lever is in P is  
dangerous. Unexpected vehicle  
movement could occur. This could  
cause an accident.  
NOTE  
If turning the key is difficult, jiggle the steering  
wheel from side to side.  
Leaving the key or start knob in any position  
but LOCK position also disables some of the  
security features and may run the battery  
down.  
ACC (Accessory)  
The steering wheel unlocks and some  
electrical accessories will operate.  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page158  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (158,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
l
Starting the Engine  
In extremely cold weather or after the  
vehicle has not been driven in several days,  
let the engine warm up without operating  
the accelerator.  
Whether the engine is cold or warm, it  
should be started without use of the  
accelerator.  
NOTE  
Engine-starting is controlled by the spark  
ignition system.  
This system meets all Canadian Interference-  
Causing Equipment Standard requirements  
regulating the impulse electrical field strength  
of radio noise.  
l
1. Occupants should fasten their seat  
belts.  
2. Make sure the parking brake is on.  
3. Depress the brake pedal.  
4. Put the vehicle in park (P). If you must  
restart the engine while the vehicle is  
moving, shift into neutral (N).  
NOTE  
The starter will not operate if the shift lever is  
not in P or N.  
5. Turn the ignition switch to the START  
position and hold (up to 10 seconds at  
a time) until the engine starts.  
CAUTION  
Don't try the starter for more than 10  
seconds at a time. If the engine stalls  
or fails to start, wait 10 seconds  
before trying again. Otherwise, you  
may damage the starter and drain  
the battery.  
6. After starting the engine, let it idle for  
about 10 seconds.  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page159  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (159,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Brake System  
WARNING  
Dry brakes that have become wet by  
driving very slowly and applying the  
brakes lightly until brake performance  
is normal:  
qFoot Brake  
Your Mazda has power-assisted brakes  
that adjust automatically through normal  
use.  
Driving with wet brakes is  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
Should power-assist fail, you can stop by  
applying greater force than normal to the  
brake pedal. But the distance required to  
stop will be greater than usual.  
WARNING  
qParking Brake  
Do not coast with the engine stalled or  
turned off, find a safe place to stop:  
Coasting with the engine stalled or  
turned off is dangerous. Braking will  
require more effort, and the brake's  
power-assist could be depleted if you  
pump the brake. This will cause  
longer stopping distances or even an  
accident.  
WARNING  
Before leaving the driver's seat, always  
put the key or start knob to LOCK  
position, set the parking brake and  
make sure the shift lever is in P:  
Intentionally placing the key or start  
knob into LOCK position is much  
more important where you will not  
be removing the key to leave the  
vehicle and because leaving it in  
other positions will disable some of  
the vehicle security systems and run  
the battery down.  
Shift to a lower gear when going down  
steep hills:  
Driving with your foot continuously  
on the brake pedal or steadily  
applying the brakes for long  
distances is dangerous. This causes  
overheated brakes, resulting in  
longer stopping distances or even  
total brake failure. This could cause  
loss of vehicle control and a serious  
accident. Avoid continuous  
Leaving the driver's seat without  
putting the ignition switch in LOCK  
position, setting the parking brake  
and the shift lever is in P is  
dangerous. Unexpected vehicle  
movement could occur. This could  
cause an accident.  
application of the brakes.  
CAUTION  
Driving with the parking brake on  
will cause excessive wear of the brake  
linings or pads.  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page160  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (160,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
qBrake System Warning Light  
For parking in snow, refer to Winter Driving  
(page 4-8) regarding parking brake use.  
Setting the parking brake  
Depress the brake pedal, then depress the  
parking brake pedal fully.  
This warning has the following functions:  
Parking brake warning  
The light comes on when the parking  
brake is applied with the ignition switch  
in the START or ON position. It goes off  
when the parking brake is fully released.  
Low brake fluid level warning  
If the light stays on after the parking brake  
is fully released, you may have a brake  
problem.  
Releasing the parking brake  
Depress the brake pedal, then depress the  
parking brake pedal until it releases.  
Gradually let up on the parking brake  
pedal.  
Drive to the side of the road and park off  
the right-of-way.  
You may notice that the pedal is harder to  
push or that it may go closer to the floor.  
In either case, it will take longer to stop  
the vehicle.  
1. With the engine stopped, check the  
brake fluid level immediately and add  
fluid as required (page 8-23).  
2. After adding fluid, check the light  
again.  
If the warning light remains on, or if the  
brakes do not operate properly, do not  
drive the vehicle. Have it towed to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
Release the parking brake pedal once before  
trying to reapply it.  
Even if the light goes out have your brake  
system inspected as soon as possible by  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page161  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (161,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
WARNING  
Do not rely on ABS as a substitute for  
safe driving:  
Having to add brake fluid is sometimes an  
indicator of leakage. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible even if the  
brake light is no longer illuminated.  
The ABS cannot compensate for  
unsafe and reckless driving, excessive  
speed, tailgating (following another  
vehicle too closely), driving on ice and  
snow, and hydroplaning (reduced tire  
friction and road contact because of  
water on the road surface). You can  
still have an accident.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the brake system  
warning light illuminated. Contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the  
brakes inspected as soon as possible:  
Driving with the brake system  
warning light illuminated is  
NOTE  
dangerous. It indicates that your  
brakes may not work at all or that  
they could completely fail at any  
time. If this light remains  
l
Braking distances may be longer on loose  
surfaces (snow or gravel, for example)  
which usually have a hard foundation. A  
vehicle with a normal braking system may  
require less distance to stop under these  
conditions because the tires will build up a  
wedge of surface layer when the wheels  
skid.  
illuminated, after checking that the  
parking brake is fully released, have  
the brakes inspected immediately.  
l
qParking Brake Reminder  
The sound of the ABS operating may be  
heard when starting the engine or  
immediately after starting the vehicle.  
However, it does not indicate a malfunction.  
If the parking brake has not been  
completely released and the vehicle is  
driven at about 5 km/h (3 mph) or faster, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard to  
notify the driver that the parking brake  
has not been released.  
qABS Warning Light  
qAnti-Lock Brake System (ABS)  
The ABS control unit continuously  
monitors the speed of each wheel. If one  
is about to lock up, the ABS responds by  
automatically releasing and reapplying  
that wheel's brake.  
The warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
The driver will feel a slight vibration in  
the brake pedal and may hear a chattering  
noise from the brake system. This is  
normal when the ABS operates. Don't  
pump the brakes, continue to press down  
on the brake pedal.  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page162  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (162,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
If the ABS warning light stays on while  
you're driving, the ABS control unit has  
detected a system malfunction. If this  
occurs, your brakes will function normally  
as if the vehicle had no ABS.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with both the ABS warning  
light and brake warning light  
illuminated. Have the vehicle towed to  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have  
the brakes inspected as soon as  
possible:  
Should this happen, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
NOTE  
Driving when the brake system  
warning light and ABS warning light  
are illuminated at the same time is  
dangerous.  
When both lights are illuminated, the  
rear wheels could lock more quickly  
in an emergency stop than under  
normal circumstances.  
When the engine is jump-started to charge the  
battery, uneven rpm occurs and the ABS  
warning light comes on. This is due to a weak  
battery, not a malfunction.  
Recharge the battery.  
qElectronic Brake Force  
Distribution System Warning  
qBrake Assist  
During emergency braking situations  
when it is necessary to depress the brake  
pedal with greater force, the brake assist  
system provides braking assistance, thus  
enhancing braking performance.  
If the electronic brake force distribution  
control unit determines that some  
components are operating incorrectly, the  
control unit may turn the brake system  
warning light and the ABS warning light  
on at the same time. The problem is likely  
to be the electronic brake force  
When the brake pedal is depressed hard or  
depressed more quickly, the brakes apply  
more firmly.  
NOTE  
l
When the brake pedal is depressed hard or  
depressed more quickly, the pedal will feel  
softer but the brakes will apply more firmly.  
This is a normal effect of the brake assist  
operation and does not indicate an  
abnormality.  
distribution system.  
l
When the brake pedal is depressed hard or  
depressed more quickly, a clicking noise  
from the brake booster may be heard. This  
is a normal effect of the brake assist and  
does not indicate an abnormality.  
l
The brake assist equipment does not  
supersede the functionality of the vehicle's  
main braking system.  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page163  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (163,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qBrake Pad Wear Indicator  
When the disc brake pads become worn,  
the built-in wear indicators contact the  
disc plates. This causes a screeching noise  
to warn that the pads should be replaced.  
When you hear this noise, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with worn disc pads:  
Driving with worn disc pads is  
dangerous. The brakes could fail and  
cause a serious accident. As soon as  
you hear a screeching noise consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page164  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (164,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Automatic Transaxle Controls  
Various Lockouts:  
Indicates that you must depress the brake pedal to shift (The ignition  
switch must be in the ACC or ON position).  
Indicates the shift lever can be shifted freely into any position.  
NOTE  
This Sport AT has an option that is not included in traditional automatic transaxle - giving the driver  
the option of selecting each gear instead of leaving it to the transaxle to shift gears. Even if you  
intend to use the automatic transaxle functions as a traditional automatic, you should also be aware  
that you can inadvertently shift into manual shift mode and an inappropriate gear may be retained as  
you change speeds. If you notice the engine speed going higher or hear the engine racing, confirm  
you have not accidentally slipped into manual shift mode (page 5-12).  
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page165  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (165,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qTransaxle Ranges  
WARNING  
If the engine is running faster than idle,  
do not shift from N or P into a driving  
gear:  
The shift lever must be in P or N to  
operate the starter.  
P (Park)  
It's dangerous to shift from N or P  
into a driving gear when the engine  
is running faster than idle. If this is  
done, the vehicle could move  
suddenly, causing an accident or  
serious injury.  
P locks the transaxle and prevents the  
front wheels from rotating.  
WARNING  
Always set the shift lever to P and set  
the parking brake:  
Do not shift into N when driving the  
vehicle:  
Only setting the shift lever to the P  
position without using the parking  
brake to hold the vehicle is  
dangerous. If P fails to hold, the  
vehicle could move and cause an  
accident.  
Shifting into N while driving is  
dangerous. Engine braking cannot be  
applied when decelerating which  
could lead to an accident or serious  
injury.  
CAUTION  
Ø Shifting into P, N or R while the  
vehicle is moving can damage  
your transaxle.  
Ø Shifting into a driving gear or  
reverse when the engine is running  
faster than idle can damage the  
transaxle.  
CAUTION  
Do not shift into N when driving the  
vehicle. Doing so can cause transaxle  
damage.  
NOTE  
Apply the parking brake or depress the brake  
pedal before moving the shift lever from N to  
prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly.  
R (Reverse)  
In position R, the vehicle moves only  
backward. You must be at a complete stop  
before shifting to or from R, except under  
rare circumstances as explained in  
Rocking the Vehicle (page 4-8).  
D (Drive)  
D is the normal driving position. From a  
stop, the transaxle will automatically shift  
through a 6-gear sequence.  
M (Manual)  
N (Neutral)  
M is the manual shift mode position.  
Gears can be shifted up or down by  
operating the shift lever.  
In N, the wheels and transaxle are not  
locked. The vehicle will roll freely even  
on the slightest incline unless the parking  
brake or brakes are on.  
Refer to Manual Shift Mode (page 5-12).  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page166  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (166,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
l
qActive Adaptive Shift (AAS)  
When the ignition switch is in the LOCK  
position, the shift lever cannot be shifted  
from P.  
To be sure the vehicle is in park, the  
ignition key cannot be removed unless the  
shift lever is in P.  
Active Adaptive Shift (AAS)  
automatically controls the transaxle shift  
points to best suit the road conditions and  
driver input. This optimizes engine  
performance and improves driving  
comfort. When cornering the vehicle,  
AAS mode will hold the transaxle in the  
gear the vehicle was in before entering the  
curve, allowing the vehicle to be  
accelerated from the same gear after  
exiting the curve.  
If the driver accelerates rapidly, or  
accelerates and decelerates rapidly by  
operating the accelerator and brake pedal  
for a certain period of time while the  
selector lever is in the D position, AAS  
mode could activate. When this occurs,  
AAS mode will maintain the transaxle in  
the optimum gear and the driver may  
sense that the transaxle is not shifting,  
however this does not indicate an  
abnormality.  
l
l
(With Advanced Key)  
The ignition switch cannot be turned from  
the ACC position to the LOCK position  
when the shift lever is not in P.  
qManual Shift Mode  
This mode gives you the feel of driving a  
manual transaxle vehicle by operating the  
shift lever and allows you to control  
engine rpm and torque to the front wheels  
much like a manual transaxle when more  
control is desired.  
To change to manual shift mode, shift the  
lever from D to M.  
qShift-Lock System  
The shift-lock system prevents shifting  
out of P unless the brake pedal is  
depressed.  
To shift from P:  
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.  
2. Start the engine.  
3. Move the shift lever.  
To return to automatic shift mode, shift  
the lever from M to D.  
NOTE  
If you change to manual shift mode when the  
vehicle is stopped, the gear will shift to M1.  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page167  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (167,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Indicators  
Shifting  
Shift position indicator  
Manually Shifting up  
In manual shift mode, the Mof the shift  
position indicator in the instrument panel  
illuminates.  
(M1M2M3M4M5M6)  
To shift up to a higher gear, tap the shift  
lever back ( ) once.  
Gear position indicator  
The numeral for the selected gear  
illuminates.  
Shift position  
indicator  
NOTE  
l
When driving slowly, the gears may not  
shift up depending on vehicle speed.  
In manual shift mode, gears do not shift up  
Gear position indicator  
l
automatically. Don't run the engine with the  
tachometer needle in the RED ZONE. If the  
tachometer needle enters the RED ZONE,  
you may feel engine-braking because the  
fuel delivery will be stopped to protect the  
engine. However, this does not indicate an  
abnormality.  
NOTE  
If the gears cannot be shifted down when  
driving at higher speeds, the gear position  
indicator will flash twice to signal that the  
gears cannot be shifted down.  
l
When depressing the accelerator fully, the  
transaxle will shift to a lower gear,  
depending on vehicle speed.  
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page168  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (168,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Manually Shifting down  
Second gear fixed mode  
When the shift lever is tapped back (  
(M6M5M4M3M2M1)  
To shift down to a lower gear, tap the shift  
lever forward ( ) once.  
)
while the vehicle is stopped, the transaxle  
is set in the second gear fixed mode. The  
gear is fixed in second while in this mode  
for easier starting and driving on slippery  
roads. If the shift lever is tapped back (  
or forward ( ) while in the second gear  
fixed mode, the mode will be canceled.  
)
Shifting specification  
Shifting up  
If the vehicle speed is lower than the  
speed specified for each gear, the gear  
cannot be shifted up to a higher gear.  
Gear  
Vehicle speed  
You can shift up to M2 whether the  
vehicle is stopped or moving.  
WARNING  
M1M2  
Do not use engine braking on slippery  
road surfaces or at high speeds:  
Shifting down while driving on wet,  
snowy, or frozen roads, or while  
driving at high speeds causes sudden  
engine braking, which is dangerous.  
The sudden change in tire speed  
could cause the tires to skid. This  
could lead to loss of vehicle control  
and an accident.  
M2M3  
M3M4  
M4M5  
M5M6  
9 km/h (6 mph)  
26 km/h (16 mph)  
36 km/h (22 mph)  
53 km/h (33 mph)  
Shifting down  
If the vehicle speed is higher than the  
speed specified for each gear, the gear  
cannot be shifted down to a lower gear.  
Gear  
M6M5  
Vehicle speed  
230 km/h (143 mph)  
182 km/h (113 mph)  
135 km/h (83 mph)  
86 km/h (53 mph)  
NOTE  
l
When driving at high speeds, the gear may  
not shift down depending on vehicle speed.  
M5M4  
M4M3  
M3M2  
M2M1  
l
During deceleration, the gear may  
automatically shift down depending on  
vehicle speed.  
44 km/h (27 mph)  
l
During deceleration, the gears shift down  
automatically when speed is reduced to  
the following:  
When depressing the accelerator fully, the  
transaxle will shift to a lower gear,  
depending on vehicle speed.  
Gear  
M6M5  
Vehicle speed  
52 km/h (32 mph)  
M5M4  
34 km/h (21 mph)  
25 km/h (15 mph)  
8 km/h (5 mph)  
M4M3  
M3 or M2M1  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page169  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (169,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
qDriving Tips  
The gear does not shift down to M1  
automatically while in the second gear fixed  
mode.  
Passing  
For extra power when passing another  
vehicle or climbing steep grades, depress  
the accelerator fully. The transaxle will  
shift to a lower gear, depending on vehicle  
speed.  
If the vehicle is kicked down at the  
following speeds or lower, the gears shift  
down automatically:  
Gear  
M6M5  
Vehicle speed  
220 km/h (136 mph)  
50 km/h (31 mph)  
30 km/h (18 mph)  
8 km/h (5 mph)  
Climbing steep grades from a stop  
To climb a steep grade from a stopped  
position:  
M5M4  
M4M3  
M3 or M2M1  
1. Depress the brake pedal.  
Recommendations for shifting  
Upshifting  
2. Shift to D or M1, depending on the  
load weight and grade steepness.  
3. Release the brake pedal while  
gradually accelerating.  
For normal acceleration and cruising, we  
recommend these shift points.  
Descending steep grades  
Gear  
M1 to M2  
Vehicle speed  
24 km/h (15 mph)  
When descending a steep grade, shift to  
lower gears, depending on load weight  
and grade steepness. Descend slowly,  
using the brakes only occasionally to  
prevent them from overheating.  
M2 to M3  
M3 to M4  
M4 to M5  
M5 to M6  
40 km/h (25 mph)  
65 km/h (40 mph)  
73 km/h (45 mph)  
80 km/h (50 mph)  
Downshifting  
When you must slow down in heavy  
traffic or on a steep upgrade, downshift  
before the engine starts to overwork. This  
gives better acceleration when you need  
more speed.  
On a steep downgrade, downshifting  
helps maintain safe speed and prolongs  
brake life.  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page170  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (170,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Power Steering  
All-Wheel Drive (AWD)  
Operationí  
Power steering is only operable when the  
engine is running. If the engine is off or if  
the power steering system is inoperable,  
you can still steer, but it requires more  
physical effort.  
AWD provides excellent driveability on  
snow-covered and ice-packed roads, sand  
and mud, as well as on steep slopes and  
other slippery surfaces.  
If the steering feels stiffer than usual  
during normal driving, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
CAUTION  
Never hold the steering wheel to the  
extreme left or right for more than 5  
seconds with the engine running.  
This could damage the power  
steering system.  
5-16  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page171  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (171,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qAWD Driving  
qAWD Warning Light  
WARNING  
Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvers when driving this  
vehicle:  
Sharp turns, excessive speed and  
abrupt maneuvering of this vehicle is  
dangerous as it could result in the  
increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle roll-over, personal  
injury or death.  
This vehicle has a higher center of  
gravity. Vehicles with a higher center  
of gravity such as utility and AWD  
vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of  
gravity.  
Utility and AWD vehicles are not  
designed for cornering at speeds as  
any more than low profile sports cars  
are designed to perform satisfactorily  
under off-road conditions. In  
addition, utility vehicles have a  
significantly higher rollover rate than  
other types of vehicles.  
This warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
Thereafter, the warning light will  
illuminate or flash under the following  
conditions:  
l
Illuminates when there is an  
abnormality with the AWD system.  
Flashes when the differential oil  
l
temperature is abnormally high.  
Flashes when there are continually  
l
large differences between front and rear  
wheel rotation, such as when trying to  
pull away from an icy surface.  
If the AWD warning light illuminates:  
If the AWD warning light illuminates,  
contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
RSC might help if you get into  
trouble, but then it might not be able  
to allow you to fully recover, always  
drive carefully with the vehicle's  
height in mind.  
If the AWD warning light flashes:  
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a  
few moments; if the warning light stops  
flashing, you can resume driving. If the  
light does not stop flashing, contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Drive carefully when the vehicle is  
loaded by lowering vehicle speed and  
applying the brakes earlier:  
Abrupt maneuvering and sudden  
braking when driving a loaded  
vehicle is dangerous as the driving  
behavior of a vehicle with a high  
center of gravity is different when it is  
loaded compared to when it is not,  
and could result in the loss of vehicle  
control and an accident.  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page172  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (172,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Tire chains  
WARNING  
Never spin a wheel that is off the  
ground:  
l
Install tire chains to the front tires.  
Do not use tire chains on the rear  
wheels.  
Do not drive the vehicle faster than 30  
km/h (19 mph) with the tire chains  
installed.  
Do not drive the vehicle with tire  
chains on road conditions other than  
snow or ice.  
l
Spinning a wheel that is off the  
ground as a result of the vehicle  
being stuck or in a ditch is  
dangerous. The drive assembly could  
be seriously damaged which could  
lead to an accident or could even  
lead to overheating, oil leakage, and  
a fire.  
l
l
qTowing  
qTires and Tire Chains  
If the vehicle requires towing, have it  
towed with all four wheels completely off  
the ground(page 7-18).  
The condition of the tires plays a large  
role in the performance of the vehicle.  
Moreover, to prevent adverse effects to  
the drive assembly, please note the  
following:  
Tires  
l
When replacing tires, always replace  
all front and rear tires at the same time.  
All tires must be of the same size,  
l
manufacture, brand and tread pattern.  
Pay particular attention when  
equipping snow or other types of  
winter tires.  
l
Do not mix tread-worn tires with  
normal tires.  
Inspect tire inflation pressures at the  
l
specified periods and adjust to the  
specified pressures.  
NOTE  
Check the tire inflation pressure label attached  
to driver's door frame for the correct tire  
inflation pressure.  
l
Make sure to equip the vehicle with  
genuine wheels of the specified size,  
on all wheels. With AWD, the system  
is calibrated for all four wheels being  
of the same dimensions.  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page173  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (173,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qActivation/Deactivation  
Cruise Control  
To activate the system, press the ON/OFF  
switch.  
The cruise main indicator light  
illuminates.  
With cruise control, you can set and  
automatically maintain any speed of more  
than about 30 km/h (19 mph).  
WARNING  
Do not use the cruise control under the  
following conditions:  
To deactivate the system, press the switch  
again.  
The cruise main indicator light turns off.  
Using the cruise control under the  
following conditions is dangerous  
and could result in loss of vehicle  
control.  
Ø Hilly terrain  
Ø Steep inclines  
Ø Heavy or unsteady traffic  
Ø Slippery or winding roads  
Ø Similar restrictions that require  
inconsistent speed  
qCruise Main Indicator Light  
(Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator  
Light (Green)  
WARNING  
Keep the ON/OFF switch off when  
cruise control is not in use:  
Leaving the ON/OFF switch on when  
not using the cruise control is  
dangerous as you may hit one of the  
other buttons and put the vehicle in  
cruise control unexpectedly. This  
could result in loss of vehicle control.  
The indicator light has two colors.  
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)  
qTo Set Speed  
The indicator light illuminates amber  
when the ON/OFF switch is pressed and  
the cruise control system is activated.  
1. Activate the cruise control system by  
pressing the ON/OFF switch.  
2. Accelerate to the desired speed, which  
must be more than 30 km/h (19 mph).  
Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green)  
The indicator light illuminates green when  
a cruising speed has been set.  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page174  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (174,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
3. Press down the cruise control switch  
and release it at the speed you want.  
Release the accelerator at the same  
time.  
qTo Increase Cruising Speed  
Follow either of these procedures.  
To increase speed using cruise control  
switch  
Pull up the cruise control switch and hold  
it. Your vehicle will accelerate.  
Release the switch at the speed you want.  
Cruise  
control  
switch  
Cruise  
control  
switch  
Don't continue to hold the switch. Until  
you release it, speed will continue to drop  
(unless you continue to accelerate) and  
you'll miss the desired speed.  
NOTE  
Your vehicle has a tap-up feature that  
allows you to increase your current speed  
in increments of 1.6 km/h (1 mph) by a  
momentary tap of the cruise control  
switch. Multiple taps will increase your  
vehicle speed 1.6 km/h (1 mph) for each  
tap.  
l
The SET function can't be activated until  
about 2 seconds after the ON/OFF switch  
has been engaged.  
l
On a steep grade, the vehicle may  
momentarily slow down going up or speed  
up while going down.  
l
Cruise control will turn off if vehicle speed  
drops below 30 km/h (19 mph) when cruise  
is activated, such as when climbing a steep  
grade.  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page175  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (175,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
To increase speed using accelerator  
pedal  
Your vehicle has a tap-down feature that  
allows you to decrease your current speed  
in decrements of 1.6 km/h (1 mph) by a  
momentary tap of the cruise control  
switch. Multiple taps will decrease your  
vehicle speed 1.6 km/h (1 mph) for each  
tap.  
Depress the accelerator pedal to accelerate  
to the desired speed.  
press down the cruise control switch and  
release it immediately.  
qTo Resume Cruising Speed at  
More Than 30 km/h (19 mph)  
Cruise  
control  
switch  
If some other method besides the ON/  
OFF switch was used to cancel cruising  
speed (such as applying the brake pedal)  
and the system is still activated, the most  
recent set speed will automatically resume  
when the cruise control switch pulled up.  
If vehicle speed is below 30 km/h (19  
mph), increase the vehicle speed up to 30  
km/h (19 mph) and pull up the cruise  
control switch.  
NOTE  
Accelerate if you want to speed up temporarily  
when the cruise control is on. Greater speed  
will not interfere with or change the set speed.  
Take your foot off the accelerator to return to  
the set speed.  
Cruise  
control  
switch  
qTo Decrease Cruising Speed  
Press down the cruise control switch and  
hold it. The vehicle will gradually slow.  
Release the switch at the speed you want.  
qTo Cancel  
Cruise  
control  
switch  
To cancel the system, use one of these  
methods:  
l
Press the ON/OFF switch.  
Slightly depress the brake pedal.  
l
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page176  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (176,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
l
Press the CANCEL button.  
Traction Control System  
(TCS)  
The Traction Control System (TCS)  
enhances traction and safety by  
controlling engine torque. When the TCS  
detects driving wheel slippage, it lowers  
engine torque to prevent loss of traction.  
This means that on a slick surface, the  
engine adjusts automatically to provide  
optimum power to the drive wheels  
without causing them to spin and lose  
traction.  
The system is off when the ignition is off.  
NOTE  
WARNING  
Cruise control will cancel at about 15 km/h (9  
mph) below the preset speed (such as may  
happen when climbing a long, steep grade) or  
below 30 km/h (19 mph).  
Do not rely on the traction control  
system as a substitute for safe driving:  
The traction control system (TCS)  
cannot compensate for unsafe and  
reckless driving, excessive speed,  
tailgating (following another vehicle  
too closely), and hydroplaning  
(reduced tire friction and road  
contact because of water on the road  
surface). You can still have an  
accident.  
Use snow tires or tire chains on the  
front wheels only and drive at reduced  
speeds when roads are covered with ice  
and/or snow:  
Driving without proper traction  
devices on snow and/or ice-covered  
roads is dangerous. The traction  
control system (TCS) alone cannot  
provide adequate traction and you  
could still have an accident.  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page177  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (177,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qTCS/DSC Indicator Light  
qTCS OFF Indicator Light  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position. If the TCS or DSC is  
operating, the indicator light flashes.  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
It also illuminates when the TCS OFF  
switch is pressed and TCS is switched off.  
Refer to TCS OFF Switch on page 5-24.  
If the light remains illuminated and the  
TCS is not switched off, take your vehicle  
to an Authorized Mazda Dealer. The  
dynamic stability control may have a  
malfunction.  
If the light stays on, the TCS or DSC may  
have a malfunction and they may not  
operate correctly. Take your vehicle to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
l
In addition to the indicator light flashing, a  
slight lugging sound will come from the  
engine. This indicates that the TCS is  
operating properly.  
l
On slippery surfaces, such as fresh snow, it  
will be impossible to achieve high rpm  
when the TCS is on.  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page178  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (178,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
qTCS OFF Switch  
If the battery is disconnected or a fuse is  
replaced, the DSC will be inoperable. When  
this happens, the TCS OFF indicator light  
flashes and the TCS/DSC indicator light  
illuminates.  
If the vehicle speed is less than 30 km/h  
(18 mph), press the TCS OFF switch to  
turn off the TCS. The TCS OFF indicator  
light will illuminate.  
To reactivate the DSC, perform the following  
procedure with the battery connected.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.  
2. Turn the steering clockwise fully, then turn  
it counterclockwise fully.  
3. Make sure the TCS OFF indicator turns off.  
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF  
position, then turn it to the ON position  
again.  
5. Make sure the TCS/DSC indicator light  
turns off.  
Press the switch again to turn the TCS  
back on. The TCS OFF indicator light  
will go out. If the vehicle speed is more  
than 30 km/h (18 mph), the TCS OFF  
indicator light will not illuminate even if  
the switch is pressed.  
If the TCS/DSC indicator light and the TCS  
OFF indicator light remain illuminated even  
after turning the ignition switch to the ON  
position, attempt the procedure again. If this  
still does not work, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page179  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (179,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
NOTE  
Dynamic Stability Control  
(DSC)  
l
When TCS is on and you attempt to free the  
vehicle when it is stuck, or drive it out of  
freshly fallen snow, the TCS will activate.  
Depressing the accelerator will not  
increase engine power and freeing the  
vehicle may be difficult. When this happens,  
turn off the TCS.  
The Dynamic Stability Control (DSC)  
automatically controls braking and engine  
torque in conjunction with systems such  
as ABS and TCS to help control side slip  
when driving on slippery surfaces, or  
during sudden or evasive maneuvering,  
enhancing vehicle safety.  
l
If the TCS is off when the engine is turned  
off, it automatically activates when the  
ignition switch is turned on.  
l
Leaving the TCS on will provide the best  
Refer to ABS (page 5-7) and TCS (page  
traction.  
l
If the TCS is OFF when the vehicle speed is  
more than 30 km/h (18 mph), it  
automatically activates and the TCS OFF  
indicator light will turn off.  
DSC operation is possible at speeds  
greater than 20 km/h (12 mph).  
l
If the TCS OFF switch is pressed and held  
WARNING  
for 10 seconds or more, the TCS OFF  
switch malfunction detection function  
operates and the TCS system activates  
automatically. The TCS OFF indicator light  
turns off while the TCS system is operative.  
Do not rely on the dynamic stability  
control as a substitute for safe driving:  
The dynamic stability control (DSC)  
cannot compensate for unsafe and  
reckless driving, excessive speed,  
tailgating (following another vehicle  
too closely), and hydroplaning  
(reduced tire friction and road  
contact because of water on the road  
surface). You can still have an  
accident.  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page180  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (180,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
CAUTION  
Ø The DSC may not operate correctly  
unless the following are observed:  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Use tires of the correct size  
specified for your Mazda on all  
four wheels.  
Use tires of the same  
manufacturer, brand and tread  
pattern on all four wheels.  
Do not mix worn tires.  
Ø The DSC may not operate correctly  
when tire chains are used or a  
temporary spare tire is installed  
because the tire diameter changes.  
qTCS/DSC Indicator Light  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position. If the TCS or DSC is  
operating, the indicator light flashes.  
If the light stays on, the TCS or DSC may  
have a malfunction and they may not  
operate correctly. Take your vehicle to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page181  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (181,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Tire Pressure Monitoring Systemí  
The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) monitors the pressure for each tire.  
If tire pressure is too low in one or more tires, the system will inform the driver via the  
warning light in the instrument panel and by the warning beep sound.  
The tire pressure sensors installed on each wheel send tire pressure data by radio signal to  
the receiver unit in the vehicle.  
Tire pressure sensors  
NOTE  
When the ambient temperature is low due to seasonal changes, tire temperatures are also lower.  
When the tire temperature decreases, the air pressure decreases as well. The TPMS warning light  
may illuminate more frequently. Visually inspect the tires daily before driving, and check tire  
pressures monthly with a tire pressure gauge. When checking tire pressures, use of a digital tire  
pressure gauge is recommended.  
TPMS does not alleviate your need to check the pressure and condition of all four tires  
regularly.  
íSome models.  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page182  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (182,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
CAUTION  
Ø Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold  
and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer  
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a  
different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation  
pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those  
tires.)  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure  
monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one  
or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire  
pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as  
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-  
inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation  
also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's  
handling and stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it  
is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-  
inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire  
pressure telltale.  
Ø Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to  
indicate when the system is not operating properly.  
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.  
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately  
one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will  
continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to  
detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a  
variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or  
wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always  
check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on  
your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow  
the TPMS to continue to function properly.  
Ø To avoid false readings, the system samples for a little while before indicating a  
problem. As a result it will not instantaneously register a rapid tire deflation or  
blow out.  
NOTE  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any  
interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page183  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (183,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
qTire Pressure Monitoring System  
WARNING  
Warning Light  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes, or  
the tire pressure warning beep sound is  
heard, decrease vehicle speed  
immediately and avoid sudden  
maneuvering and braking:  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes,  
or the tire pressure warning beep  
sound is heard, it is dangerous to  
drive the vehicle at high speeds, or  
perform sudden maneuvering or  
braking. Vehicle drivability could  
worsen and result in an accident.  
To determine if you have a slow leak  
or a flat, pull over to a safe position  
where you can check the visual  
condition of the tire and determine if  
you have enough air to proceed to a  
place where air may be added and  
the system monitored again, an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer or a tire  
repair station.  
This warning light illuminates for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
Thereafter, the warning light illuminates  
and a beep is heard when tire pressure is  
too low in one or more tires, and flashes  
when there is a system malfunction.  
Do not ignore the TPMS Warning Light:  
Ignoring the TPMS warning light is  
dangerous, even if you know why it is  
illuminated. Have the problem taken  
care of as soon as possible before it  
develops into a more serious  
situation that could lead to tire  
failure and a dangerous accident.  
Warning light illuminates/Warning  
beep sounds  
When the warning light illuminates, and  
the warning beep sound is heard (about 3  
seconds), tire pressure is too low in one or  
more tires.  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page184  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (184,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
Adjust the tire pressure to the correct tire  
pressure. Refer to the specification charts  
(page 10-6).  
NOTE  
l
Perform tire pressure adjustment when the  
tires are cold. Tire pressure will vary  
according to the tire temperature, therefore  
let the vehicle stand for 1 hour or only drive  
it 1.6 km (1 mile) or less before adjusting  
the tire pressures. When pressure is  
adjusted on hot tires to the cold inflation  
pressure, the TPMS warning light/beep may  
turn on after the tires cool and pressure  
drops below specification.  
CAUTION  
When replacing/repairing the tires or  
wheels or both, have the work done  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer, or  
the tire pressure sensors may be  
damaged.  
Also, an illuminated TPMS warning light,  
resulting from the tire air pressure dropping  
due to cold ambient temperature, may go  
out if the ambient temperature rises. In this  
case, it will also be necessary to adjust the  
tire air pressures. If the TPMS warning  
light illuminates due to a drop in tire air  
pressure, make sure to check and adjust the  
tire air pressures.  
l
After adjusting the tire air pressures, it may  
require some time for the TPMS warning  
light to go out. If the TPMS warning light  
remains illuminated, drive the vehicle at a  
speed of at least 25 km/h (16 mph) for 10  
minutes, and then verify that it goes out.  
Tires can loose a little air quite naturally  
over time and the TPMS cannot tell if the  
tires are getting too soft over time or you  
have a flat. However, when you find one  
low tire in a set of four - that is an  
l
indication of trouble; you should have  
someone drive the vehicle slowly forward  
so you can inspect any low tire for cuts and  
any metal sticking through tread or  
sidewall. Put a few drops of water in the  
valve stem to see if it bubbles indicating a  
bad valve. Leaks need to be addressed by  
more than simply refilling the trouble tire as  
leaks are dangerous - take it to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer which has all the  
equipment to fix tires, TPMS systems and  
order the best replacement tire for your  
vehicle.  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page185  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (185,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
If the warning light illuminates again even  
after the tire pressures are adjusted, there  
may be a tire puncture. Replace the  
punctured tire with the temporary spare  
tire (page 7-6).  
qTires and Wheels  
CAUTION  
When inspecting or adjusting the tire  
air pressures, do not apply excessive  
force to the stem part of the wheel  
unit. The stem part could be  
damaged.  
NOTE  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used.  
Changing tires and wheels  
The following procedure allows the  
TPMS to recognize a tire pressure sensor's  
unique ID signal code whenever tires or  
wheels are changed, such as changing to  
and from winter tires.  
Warning light flashes  
When the warning light flashes, there may  
be a system malfunction. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
qSystem Error Activation  
Each tire pressure sensor has a unique ID  
signal code. The signal code must be  
registered with the TPMS before it can work.  
The easiest way to do it is to have an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer change your tire and  
complete ID signal code registration.  
When the TPMS warning light flashes,  
there may be a system malfunction.  
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
A system error activation may occur in  
the following cases:  
l
When there is equipment or a device  
When having tires changed at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer  
near the vehicle using the same radio  
frequency as that of the tire pressure  
sensors.  
Tire pressure sensor ID signal code  
registration is completed when an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer changes your  
vehicle's tires.  
l
When using the following devices in  
the vehicle that may cause radio  
interference with the receiver unit.  
l
A digital device such as a personal  
When changing tires yourself  
computer.  
A current converter device such as a  
l
If you or someone else changes tires, you  
or someone else can also undertake the  
steps for the TPMS to complete the ID  
signal code registration.  
DC-AC converter.  
When excess snow or ice adheres to  
l
the vehicle, especially around the  
wheels.  
When the tire pressure sensor batteries  
1. After tires have been changed, turn the  
ignition switch to the ON position, then  
turn it back to the ACC or LOCK  
position.  
l
are exhausted.  
When using a wheel with no tire  
l
pressure sensor installed.  
When using tires with steel wire  
l
2. Wait for about 15 minutes.  
reinforcement in the side walls.  
When using tire chains.  
l
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page186  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (186,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Starting and Driving  
l
3. After about 15 minutes, drive the  
vehicle at a speed of at least 25 km/h  
(16 mph) for 10 minutes and the tire  
pressure sensor ID signal code will be  
registered automatically.  
A new tire pressure sensor is installed  
to a new wheel.  
NOTE  
l
The tire pressure sensor ID signal code  
must be registered when a new tire pressure  
sensor is purchased. For purchase of a tire  
pressure sensor and registration of the tire  
pressure sensor ID signal code, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
When reinstalling a previously removed tire  
pressure sensor to a wheel, replace the  
grommet (seal between valve body/sensor  
and wheel) for the tire pressure sensor.  
NOTE  
If the vehicle is driven within about 15 minutes  
of changing tires, the tire pressure monitoring  
system warning light will flash because the  
sensor ID signal code would not have been  
registered. If this happens, park the vehicle for  
about 15 minutes, after which the sensor ID  
signal code will register upon driving the  
vehicle for 10 minutes.  
l
Replacing tires and wheels  
CAUTION  
Ø When replacing/repairing the tires  
or wheels or both, have the work  
done by an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer, or the tire pressure sensors  
may be damaged.  
Ø The wheels equipped on your  
Mazda are specially designed for  
installation of the tire pressure  
sensors. Do not use non-genuine  
wheels, otherwise it may not be  
possible to install the tire pressure  
sensors.  
Be sure to have the tire pressure sensors  
installed whenever tires or wheels are  
replaced.  
When having a tire or wheel or both  
replaced, the following types of tire  
pressure sensor installations are possible.  
l
The tire pressure sensor is removed  
from the old wheel and installed to the  
new one.  
The same tire pressure sensor is used  
l
with the same wheel. Only the tire is  
replaced.  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page188  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (188,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Instrument Cluster and Indicators  
qSpeedometer  
The speedometer indicates the speed of  
the vehicle.  
qOdometer, Trip Meter and Trip  
Trip meter A  
Odometer  
Meter Selector  
The display mode can be changed  
between trip meter A and trip meter B by  
pressing the selector while one of them is  
displayed. The selected mode will be  
displayed.  
Press the selector  
Trip meter B  
Odometer  
Selector  
Press the selector  
Trip meter  
NOTE  
Odometer  
l
(Standard meter)  
The odometer and trip meter can be  
displayed as follows even when the ignition  
switch is in the ACC or LOCK position.  
l
Displays for 10 minutes after the  
ignition switch is turned to the ACC or  
LOCK position from the ON position.  
Displays for 10 minutes after the  
l
driver's door is opened.  
l
(Black-out meter)  
When the ignition switch is in the ACC or  
LOCK position, the odometer or trip meters  
cannot be displayed, however, pressing the  
selector button can inadvertently switch the  
trip meters or reset them during an  
approximate ten-minute period in the  
following cases:  
l
After the ignition switch is turned to the  
ACC or LOCK position from the ON  
position.  
After the driver's door is opened.  
l
5-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page189  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (189,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Instrument Cluster and Indicators  
Odometer  
qTachometer  
The odometer records the total distance  
the vehicle has been driven.  
The tachometer shows engine speed in  
thousands of revolutions per minute  
(rpm).  
Trip meter  
The trip meter can record the total  
distance of two trips. One is recorded in  
trip meter A, and the other is recorded in  
trip meter B.  
Red zone  
For instance, trip meter A can record the  
distance from the point of origin, and trip  
meter B can record the distance from  
where the fuel tank is filled.  
When trip meter A is selected, pressing  
the selector again within one second will  
change to trip meter B mode.  
CAUTION  
Don't run the engine with the  
tachometer needle in the RED ZONE.  
This may cause severe engine  
damage.  
When trip meter A is selected, TRIP A  
will be displayed. When trip meter B is  
selected, TRIP B will be displayed.  
The trip meter records the total distance  
the vehicle is driven until the meter is  
again reset. Return it to 0.0by holding  
the selector depressed for more than 1  
second. Use this meter to measure trip  
distances and to compute fuel  
q
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge  
The engine coolant temperature gauge  
shows the temperature of the engine  
coolant.  
consumption.  
NOTE  
l
Only the trip meters record tenths of  
kilometers (miles).  
l
The trip record will be erased when:  
l
The power supply is interrupted (blown  
fuse or the battery is disconnected).  
The vehicle is driven over 999.9 km  
l
(mile).  
If the needle is near H, it indicates  
overheating.  
5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page190  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (190,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Instrument Cluster and Indicators  
qDashboard Illumination  
CAUTION  
Driving with an overheated engine  
can cause serious engine damage  
(page 7-11).  
Rotate the knob to adjust the brightness of  
the instrument cluster and other  
illuminations in the dashboard.  
NOTE  
l
The brightness of dashboard illuminations  
can be adjusted when the headlight switch  
qFuel Gauge  
The fuel gauge shows approximately how  
much fuel is in the tank. We recommend  
keeping the tank over 1/4 full. When the  
low fuel warning light illuminates or  
when the needle is near E, refuel as soon  
as possible.  
is in the  
or  
position.  
l
l
When the dashboard illumination  
brightness cannot be adjusted any more, a  
beep sound will be heard.  
(Black-out meter)  
The brightness of the instrument cluster  
illumination can be adjusted when the  
headlight switch is in any position.  
Dim  
Low fuel  
warning light  
Bright  
NOTE  
The direction of the arrow (  
) shown next to  
the low fuel warning light indicates that the  
fuel-filler lid is on the left side of the vehicle.  
Canceling the illumination dimmer  
(Black-out meter and dashboard  
illuminations)  
When the headlight switch is in the or  
position, the illumination of the  
instrument cluster and the information  
display dims.  
When driving on snowy or foggy roads,  
or in other situations when the instrument  
cluster or information display's visibility  
is reduced due to glare from surrounding  
brightness, cancel the illumination  
dimmer and increase the illumination  
intensity.  
5-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page191  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (191,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Instrument Cluster and Indicators  
To cancel the illumination dimmer, press  
the dashboard illumination knob.  
NOTE  
If the dashboard illumination knob is kept at  
the illumination dimmer cancel position, the  
instrument cluster and the information display  
will not dim when the headlight switch is  
turned to the  
or  
position again.  
5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page192  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (192,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Warning/Indicator Lights  
Warning/Indicator lights will appear in any of the highlighted areas  
Signal  
Warning/Indicator Lights  
Brake System Warning Light  
Page  
Charging System Warning Light  
Engine Oil Pressure Warning Light  
Check Engine Light  
ABS Warning Light  
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Light  
Low Fuel Warning Light  
5-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page193  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (193,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Signal  
Warning/Indicator Lights  
Seat Belt Warning Light/Beep  
Page  
Door-Ajar Warning Light  
Low Washer Fluid Level Warning Light  
Automatic Transaxle Warning Light  
AWD Warning Light  
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Warning Light  
KEY Warning Light (Red)/KEY Indicator Light (Green)  
Security Indicator Light  
Headlight High-Beam Indicator Light  
Shift Position Indicator Light  
TCS/DSC Indicator Light  
TCS OFF Indicator Light  
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green)  
Light-On Indicator Light  
Turn Signal/Hazard Warning Indicator Lights  
5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page194  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (194,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
NOTE  
qBrake System Warning Light  
Having to add brake fluid is sometimes an  
indicator of leakage. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible even if the  
brake light is no longer illuminated.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with the brake system  
warning light illuminated. Contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the  
brakes inspected as soon as possible:  
Driving with the brake system  
This warning has the following functions:  
Parking brake warning  
The light comes on when the parking  
brake is applied with the ignition switch  
in the START or ON position. It goes off  
when the parking brake is fully released.  
warning light illuminated is  
dangerous. It indicates that your  
brakes may not work at all or that  
they could completely fail at any  
time. If this light remains  
Low brake fluid level warning  
If the light stays on after the parking brake  
is fully released, you may have a brake  
problem.  
illuminated, after checking that the  
parking brake is fully released, have  
the brakes inspected immediately.  
Drive to the side of the road and park off  
the right-of-way.  
qABS Warning Light  
You may notice that the pedal is harder to  
push or that it may go closer to the floor.  
In either case, it will take longer to stop  
the vehicle.  
1. With the engine stopped, check the  
brake fluid level immediately and add  
fluid as required (page 8-23).  
The warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
2. After adding fluid, check the light  
again.  
If the ABS warning light stays on while  
you're driving, the ABS control unit has  
detected a system malfunction. If this  
occurs, your brakes will function normally  
as if the vehicle had no ABS.  
If the warning light remains on, or if the  
brakes do not operate properly, do not  
drive the vehicle. Have it towed to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Should this happen, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
Even if the light goes out have your brake  
system inspected as soon as possible by  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page195  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (195,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
NOTE  
qCharging System Warning Light  
When the engine is jump-started to charge the  
battery, uneven rpm occurs and the ABS  
warning light comes on. This is due to a weak  
battery, not a malfunction.  
Recharge the battery.  
qElectronic Brake Force  
Distribution System Warning  
This warning light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and turns off when the engine is  
started.  
If the warning light illuminates while  
driving, it indicates a malfunction of the  
alternator or of the charging system.  
Drive to the side of the road and park off  
the right-of-way. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If the electronic brake force distribution  
control unit determines that some  
components are operating incorrectly, the  
control unit may turn the brake system  
warning light and the ABS warning light  
on at the same time. The problem is likely  
to be the electronic brake force  
CAUTION  
Don't continue driving when the  
charging system warning light is  
illuminated because the engine could  
stop unexpectedly.  
distribution system.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with both the ABS warning  
light and brake warning light  
illuminated. Have the vehicle towed to  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have  
the brakes inspected as soon as  
possible:  
q
Engine Oil Pressure Warning Light  
Driving when the brake system  
warning light and ABS warning light  
are illuminated at the same time is  
dangerous.  
When both lights are illuminated, the  
rear wheels could lock more quickly  
in an emergency stop than under  
normal circumstances.  
This warning light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and turns off when the engine is  
started.  
This warning light indicates low engine  
oil pressure.  
5-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page196  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (196,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
If the light illuminates while driving:  
The check engine light may come on in  
the following cases:  
1. Drive to the side of the road and park  
off the right-of-way on level ground.  
l
The fuel tank level being very low or  
approaching empty.  
The engine's electrical system has a  
l
2. Turn off the engine and wait 5 minutes  
for the oil to drain back into the oil  
pan.  
problem.  
The emission control system has a  
l
problem.  
The fuel-filler cap is missing or not  
3. Inspect the engine oil level (page 8-20).  
If it's low, add oil.  
l
tightened securely.  
4. Start the engine and check the warning  
light.  
If the check engine light remains on or  
flashes continuously, do not drive at high  
speeds and consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible.  
If the light remains illuminated even after  
you add oil, stop the engine immediately  
and have your vehicle towed to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Light  
CAUTION  
Don't run the engine if oil pressure is  
low. It could result in extensive  
engine damage.  
qCheck Engine Light  
If the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner  
system is working properly, the warning  
light illuminates when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position or after the  
engine is cranked. The warning light turns  
off after a specified period of time.  
This indicator light illuminates when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and goes off when the engine is  
started.  
A system malfunction is indicated if the  
warning light constantly flashes,  
constantly illuminates or does not  
illuminate at all when the ignition switch  
is turned to the ON position. If any of  
these occur, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible. The system  
may not work in an accident.  
If this light comes on while driving, the  
vehicle may have a problem. It is  
important to note the driving conditions  
when the light came on and consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page197  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (197,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Conditions of operation  
WARNING  
Condition  
Result  
Never tamper with the air bag/  
pretensioner systems and always have  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer perform  
all servicing and repairs:  
The driver's seat belt is not The warning light  
fastened when the ignition flashes and a beep  
switch is turned to the ON sound will be heard  
position.  
for about 6 seconds.  
Self-servicing or tampering with the  
systems is dangerous. An air bag/  
pretensioner could accidentally  
activate or become disabled causing  
serious injury or death.  
The driver's seat belt is  
fastened while the warning  
light and the beep sound are  
activated.  
The warning light  
turns off and the beep  
sound stops.  
The driver's seat belt is  
fastened before the ignition not illuminate and the  
switch is turned to the ON beep sound will not be  
The warning light will  
position.  
heard.  
qLow Fuel Warning Light  
Belt minder  
NOTE  
The belt minder can be deactivated. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer to deactivate and  
restore the seat belt minder.  
Low fuel  
warning light  
Driver seated/Front passenger not  
seated  
This warning light in the fuel gauge  
signals that the fuel tank will soon be  
empty.  
The belt minder is a supplemental  
warning to the seat belt warning function.  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened  
when the ignition switch is turned to the  
ON position, the warning light/beep  
operates to give you further reminders  
according to the chart below.  
Refuel as soon as possible.  
qSeat Belt Warning Light/Beep  
Vehicle speed  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Seat belt  
The seat belt warning light illuminates  
and a beep sound will be heard if the  
driver's seat belt is not fastened when the  
ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position.  
Indicator  
Beep  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
5-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page198  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (198,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
Driver seated/Front passenger seated  
The seat belt warning function reminds  
the front passenger to fasten the seat belt  
according to the chart below.  
NOTE  
l
To allow the front passenger seat weight  
sensor to function properly, do not place  
and sit on an additional seat cushion on the  
front passenger seat. The sensor may not  
function properly because the additional  
seat cushion could cause sensor  
interference.  
l
When a small child sits on the front  
passenger seat, it is possible that neither  
the warning light nor the warning beep  
operate.  
Vehicle speed  
Between 0 20  
km/h  
(0 12 mph)  
20 km/h  
(12 mph) or  
more  
Condition  
Seat belt  
(Driver)  
qDoor-Ajar Warning Light  
Seat belt  
(Passenger)  
Indicator  
Beep  
: Fastened  
: Unfastened  
: Illuminated  
: Flashing  
: Beep  
This warning light illuminates when any  
door or liftgate is not securely closed.  
Close the door or liftgate securely before  
driving the vehicle.  
Placing heavy items on the front  
passenger seat may cause the front  
passenger seat belt warning function to  
operate depending on the weight of the  
item.  
qLow Washer Fluid Level  
Warning Lightí  
Once the beep sound is heard, it continues  
sounding even if the vehicle speed lowers  
to 20 km/h (12 mph) or less until the  
seatbelt is fastened or the beep sound  
period has passed.  
This warning light indicates that little  
washer fluid remains. Add fluid (page  
5-44  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page199  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (199,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
l
Flashes when there are continually  
large differences between front and rear  
wheel rotation, such as when trying to  
pull away from an icy surface.  
q
Automatic Transaxle Warning Light  
If the AWD warning light illuminates:  
If the AWD warning light illuminates,  
contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
If the AWD warning light flashes:  
This warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
The light illuminates when the transaxle  
has a problem.  
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a  
few moments; if the warning light stops  
flashing, you can resume driving. If the  
light does not stop flashing, contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
CAUTION  
WARNING  
Never spin a wheel that is off the  
ground:  
If the automatic transaxle warning  
light illuminates, the transaxle has  
an electrical problem. Continuing to  
drive your Mazda in this condition  
could cause damage to your  
transaxle. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
Spinning a wheel that is off the  
ground as a result of the vehicle  
being stuck or in a ditch is  
dangerous. The drive assembly could  
be seriously damaged which could  
lead to an accident or could even  
lead to overheating, oil leakage, and  
a fire.  
qAWD Warning Light (AWD)  
qTire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) Warning Lightí  
This warning light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
Thereafter, the warning light will  
illuminate or flash under the following  
conditions:  
This warning light illuminates for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
l
Illuminates when there is an  
abnormality with the AWD system.  
Flashes when the differential oil  
l
temperature is abnormally high.  
íSome models.  
5-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page200  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (200,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Thereafter, the warning light illuminates  
and a beep is heard when tire pressure is  
too low in one or more tires, and flashes  
when there is a system malfunction.  
Warning light illuminates/Warning  
beep sounds  
When the warning light illuminates, and  
the warning beep sound is heard (about 3  
seconds), tire pressure is too low in one or  
more tires.  
WARNING  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes, or  
the tire pressure warning beep sound is  
heard, decrease vehicle speed  
immediately and avoid sudden  
maneuvering and braking:  
Adjust the tire pressure to the correct tire  
pressure. Refer to the specification charts  
(page 10-6).  
CAUTION  
If the tire pressure monitoring system  
warning light illuminates or flashes,  
or the tire pressure warning beep  
sound is heard, it is dangerous to  
drive the vehicle at high speeds, or  
perform sudden maneuvering or  
braking. Vehicle drivability could  
worsen and result in an accident.  
To determine if you have a slow leak  
or a flat, pull over to a safe position  
where you can check the visual  
condition of the tire and determine if  
you have enough air to proceed to a  
place where air may be added and  
the system monitored again, an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer or a tire  
repair station.  
When replacing/repairing the tires or  
wheels or both, have the work done  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer, or  
the tire pressure sensors may be  
damaged.  
Do not ignore the TPMS Warning Light:  
Ignoring the TPMS warning light is  
dangerous, even if you know why it is  
illuminated. Have the problem taken  
care of as soon as possible before it  
develops into a more serious  
situation that could lead to tire  
failure and a dangerous accident.  
5-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page201  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (201,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
NOTE  
If the warning light illuminates again even  
l
Perform tire pressure adjustment when the  
tires are cold. Tire pressure will vary  
after the tire pressures are adjusted, there  
may be a tire puncture. Replace the  
punctured tire with the temporary spare  
tire (page 7-6).  
according to the tire temperature, therefore  
let the vehicle stand for 1 hour or only drive  
it 1.6 km (1 mile) or less before adjusting  
the tire pressures. When pressure is  
adjusted on hot tires to the cold inflation  
pressure, the TPMS warning light/beep may  
turn on after the tires cool and pressure  
drops below specification.  
NOTE  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used.  
Also, an illuminated TPMS warning light,  
resulting from the tire air pressure dropping  
due to cold ambient temperature, may go  
out if the ambient temperature rises. In this  
case, it will also be necessary to adjust the  
tire air pressures. If the TPMS warning  
light illuminates due to a drop in tire air  
pressure, make sure to check and adjust the  
tire air pressures.  
Warning light flashes  
When the warning light flashes, there may  
be a system malfunction. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qKEY Warning Light (Red)/KEY  
Indicator Light (Green) (with  
Advanced Key)  
l
After adjusting the tire air pressures, it may  
require some time for the TPMS warning  
light to go out. If the TPMS warning light  
remains illuminated, drive the vehicle at a  
speed of at least 25 km/h (16 mph) for 10  
minutes, and then verify that it goes out.  
Tires can loose a little air quite naturally  
over time and the TPMS cannot tell if the  
tires are getting too soft over time or you  
have a flat. However, when you find one  
low tire in a set of four - that is an  
l
This indicator has two colors.  
KEY Warning Light (Red)  
When illuminated  
indication of trouble; you should have  
someone drive the vehicle slowly forward  
so you can inspect any low tire for cuts and  
any metal sticking through tread or  
sidewall. Put a few drops of water in the  
valve stem to see if it bubbles indicating a  
bad valve. Leaks need to be addressed by  
more than simply refilling the trouble tire as  
leaks are dangerous - take it to an  
l
When the ignition switch is turned to  
the ON position, it illuminates  
momentarily and then goes out.  
If any malfunction occurs in the  
l
advanced keyless system, it illuminates  
continuously.  
Authorized Mazda Dealer which has all the  
equipment to fix tires, TPMS systems and  
order the best replacement tire for your  
vehicle.  
5-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page202  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (202,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
l
Under the following conditions, the  
KEY warning light (red) will flash  
continuously when the start knob has  
not been returned to the LOCK  
position to notify the driver that the  
advanced key has been removed from  
the vehicle. It will stop flashing when  
the advanced key is back inside the  
vehicle.  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the KEY  
warning light illuminated:  
If the KEY warning light remains  
illuminated, do not continue to drive  
using the advanced key system. Park  
the vehicle in a safe place and use  
the auxiliary key to continue driving  
the vehicle. Have the vehicle  
l
The start knob has not been returned  
inspected at an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer as soon as possible.  
to the LOCK position, the driver's  
door is open, and the advanced key  
is removed from the vehicle.  
When flashing  
l
The start knob has not been returned  
l
to the LOCK position and all the  
doors are closed after removing the  
advanced key from the vehicle.  
Under the following conditions, the  
KEY warning light (red) flashes to  
inform the driver that the start knob  
will not rotate to the ACC position  
even if it is pushed in from the LOCK  
position.  
NOTE  
The flashing KEY warning light (red) and the  
beep sound operate simultaneously (page  
l
The advanced key battery is dead.  
The advanced key is not within  
l
operational range.  
The advanced key is placed in areas  
where it is difficult for the system to  
detect the signal (page 3-7).  
A key from another manufacturer  
KEY Indicator Light (Green)  
When illuminated  
l
When the start knob is pushed in from the  
LOCK position, the system confirms that  
the correct advanced key is inside the  
vehicle, the KEY indicator light (green)  
illuminates, and the start knob can be  
turned to the ACC position (page 3-9).  
l
similar to the advanced key is in the  
operational range.  
When flashing  
When the advanced key battery power is  
low, the KEY indicator light flashes for 30  
seconds after the start knob is turned from  
the ON position to the ACC or LOCK  
position. Replace with a new battery  
before the advanced key becomes  
unusable (page 3-6).  
5-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page203  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (203,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
NOTE  
qHeadlight High-Beam Indicator  
The advanced key can be set so that the KEY  
indicator light (green) does not flash even if  
the battery power is low.  
Light  
Refer to Setting Change (Function  
Customization)(page 3-18).  
qSecurity Indicator Light  
This light indicates one of two things:  
l
The high-beam headlights are on.  
The turn signal lever is in the flash-to-  
l
pass position.  
qShift Position Indicator Light  
This indicator light starts flashing every 2  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
from the ON to the ACC position and the  
immobilizer system is armed.  
This indicates the selected shift position  
when the ignition switch is in the ON  
position.  
The light stops flashing when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position with  
the correct ignition key.  
At this time, the immobilizer system is  
disarmed and the light illuminates for  
about 3 seconds and then goes out.  
If the engine doesn't start with the correct  
ignition key, and the security indicator  
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the  
system may have a malfunction. Consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Gear position indicator  
5-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page204  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (204,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
Gear position indicator  
qTCS OFF Indicator Light  
When the shift lever is in the D or M  
position, the numeral for the selected gear  
displays.  
qTCS/DSC Indicator Light  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position.  
It also illuminates when the TCS OFF  
switch is pressed and TCS is switched off.  
Refer to TCS OFF Switch on page 5-24.  
If the light remains illuminated and the  
TCS is not switched off, take your vehicle  
to an Authorized Mazda Dealer. The  
dynamic stability control may have a  
malfunction.  
This indicator light stays on for a few  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the ON position. If the TCS or DSC is  
operating, the indicator light flashes.  
If the light stays on, the TCS, DSC or the  
brake assist system may have a  
malfunction and they may not operate  
correctly. Take your vehicle to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page205  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (205,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
NOTE  
Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green)  
If the battery is disconnected or a fuse is  
replaced, the DSC will be inoperable. When  
this happens, the TCS OFF indicator light  
flashes and the TCS/DSC indicator light  
illuminates.  
The indicator light illuminates green when  
a cruising speed has been set.  
qLight-On Indicator Light  
To reactivate the DSC, perform the following  
procedure with the battery connected.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position.  
2. Turn the steering clockwise fully, then turn  
it counterclockwise fully.  
3. Make sure the TCS OFF indicator turns off.  
This indicator light comes on when the  
exterior lights and dashboard illumination  
are on.  
4. Turn the ignition switch to the OFF  
position, then turn it to the ON position  
again.  
qTurn-Signal/Hazard Warning  
5. Make sure the TCS/DSC indicator light  
turns off.  
Indicator Lights  
If the TCS/DSC indicator light and the TCS  
OFF indicator light remain illuminated even  
after turning the ignition switch to the ON  
position, attempt the procedure again. If this  
still does not work, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
When operating the turn signal lights, the  
left or right turn signal indicator light  
flashes to indicate which turn signal light  
is operating (page 5-56).  
qCruise Main Indicator Light  
(Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator  
Light (Green)  
When operating the hazard warning  
lights, both turn signal indicator lights  
flash (page 5-60).  
NOTE  
If an indicator light remains illuminated (does  
not flash) or if it flashes abnormally, one of the  
turn signal bulbs may be burned out.  
The indicator light has two colors.  
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)  
The indicator light illuminates amber  
when the ON/OFF switch is pressed and  
the cruise control system is activated.  
5-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page206  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (206,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Warning/Indicator Lights and Beep Sounds  
qIgnition Key Reminder  
Beep Sounds  
If the ignition switch is in the LOCK or  
ACC position with the key inserted, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard  
when the driver's door is opened.  
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt  
Pretensioner System Warning Beep  
If a malfunction is detected in both the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
and the warning light, a warning beep  
sound will be heard for about 1 minute.  
After that, the one-minute beep will be  
repeated every 30 minutes.  
qLights-On Reminder  
If lights are on and the key is removed  
from the ignition switch, a continuous  
beep sound will be heard when the  
driver's door is opened.  
Have your vehicle inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as  
possible.  
NOTE  
When the advanced keyless function is used  
and the start knob is in the ACC position, the  
Start Knob Not in LOCK Warning Beep”  
(page 3-16) overrides the lights-on reminder.  
WARNING  
Do not drive the vehicle with the air  
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding:  
qParking Brake Reminder  
Driving the vehicle with the air bag/  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
warning beep sounding is dangerous.  
In a collision, the air bags and the  
front seat belt pretensioner system  
will not deploy and this could result  
in death or serious injury.  
If the parking brake has not been  
completely released and the vehicle is  
driven at about 5 km/h (3 mph) or faster, a  
continuous beep sound will be heard to  
notify the driver that the parking brake  
has not been released.  
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
to have the vehicle inspected as soon  
as possible.  
qTire Inflation Pressure Warning  
Beep  
The warning beep sound will be heard for  
about 3 seconds when there is any  
abnormality in tire inflation pressures  
(page 5-27).  
qSeat Belt Warning Beep  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened  
when the ignition switch is turned to the  
ON position, a beep sound will be heard  
for about 6 seconds.  
qAdvanced Keyless Warning  
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened and  
the vehicle is driven at a speed faster than  
about 20 km/h (12 mph), a beep sound  
will be heard again for a specified period  
of time.  
Warning indicators for the advanced key,  
such as the advanced key removed from  
vehicle warning, use a beep sound and  
warning/indicator lights in the instrument  
cluster.  
Refer to Seat Belt Warning Light/Beep on  
Refer to Warning and Beep Sounds on  
5-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page207  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (207,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Type B (With AUTO position)  
Lighting Control  
qHeadlights  
Type A (Without AUTO position)  
Turn the headlight switch to turn the  
headlights, other exterior lights and  
dashboard illumination on or off.  
Switch Position  
Turn the headlight switch to turn the  
headlights, other exterior lights and  
dashboard illumination on or off.  
Headlights  
Off  
Off  
Off  
On  
On  
On  
Taillights  
Parking lights  
License lights  
Side-marker  
lights  
Dashboard  
illumination  
Switch Position  
Auto  
Headlights  
Off  
Off  
Off  
On  
On  
On  
Taillights  
Parking lights  
License lights  
Side-marker lights  
Dashboard illumination  
NOTE  
To prevent discharging the battery, don't leave  
the lights on while the engine is off unless  
safety requires them.  
NOTE  
To prevent discharging the battery, don't leave  
the lights on while the engine is off unless  
safety requires them.  
AUTO (Auto-light control)  
When the headlight switch is in the  
AUTO position and the ignition switch is  
in the ON position, the light sensor senses  
the surrounding lightness or darkness and  
automatically turns on or off the  
headlights, other exterior lights and  
dashboard illumination (see chart above).  
5-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page208  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (208,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
WARNING  
CAUTION  
Do not replace the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself:  
Do not shade the light sensor by  
adhering a sticker or a label on the  
windshield, or putting an object on it.  
Otherwise the light sensor will not  
operate correctly.  
Replacing the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself is dangerous. Because the  
xenon fusion bulbs require high  
voltage, you could receive an electric  
shock if the bulbs are handled  
incorrectly. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer when the replacement  
is necessary.  
Sensor  
NOTE  
If the headlights flicker, or the brightness  
weakens, the bulb-life may be depleted and a  
replacement is necessary. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qLights-On Reminder  
NOTE  
If lights are on and the key is removed  
from the ignition switch, a continuous  
beep sound will be heard when the  
driver's door is opened.  
l
When the headlight switch is in the AUTO  
position and the ignition switch is turned to  
the ACC or LOCK position, the headlights,  
other exterior lights and dashboard  
illumination will turn off.  
NOTE  
l
The timing for turning on the headlights,  
When the advanced keyless function is used  
and the start knob is in the ACC position, the  
Start Knob Not in LOCK Warning Beep”  
(page 3-16) overrides the lights-on reminder.  
other exterior lights and dashboard  
illumination can be delayed by adjusting  
the sensitivity of the light sensor. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer regarding sensor  
adjustment.  
Xenon fusion headlight bulbsí  
The low-beam bulbs of the headlights  
have xenon fusion bulbs that produce a  
bright white beam over a wide area.  
5-54  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page209  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (209,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
qHeadlight High-Low Beam  
qHeadlight Levelingí  
Push the lever forward for high beam.  
Pull back to original position for low  
beam.  
The number of passengers and weight of  
cargo in the luggage compartment change  
the angle of the headlights.  
The headlight leveling switch adjusts this  
angle.  
High beam  
Low beam  
qFlashing the Headlights  
Select the proper setting from the following chart.  
To flash the headlights, pull the lever fully  
toward you. The headlight switch does  
not need to be on, and the lever will return  
to the normal position when released.  
Front seat  
Rear  
seat  
Switch  
Position  
Load  
Driver Passenger  
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
×
0
0
1
2
3
×
×
×
×
×: Yes  
: No  
q
Daytime Running Lights (Canada)  
In Canada, vehicles must be driven with  
the headlights on during daytime  
operation.  
For that reason, the daytime running lights  
automatically turn on when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position.  
NOTE  
The Daytime Running Lights turn off when the  
parking brake is applied.  
íSome models.  
5-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page210  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (210,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Fog Lightsí  
Turn and Lane-Change  
Signals  
Use this switch to turn on the fog lights.  
They help you to see as well as to be seen.  
qTurn Signal  
To turn the front fog lights on, rotate the  
Move the signal lever down (for a left  
turn) or up (for a right turn) to the stop  
position. The signal will self-cancel after  
the turn is completed.  
fog light switch to the  
position.  
The headlight switch must be in the  
position to turn on the front fog lights.  
If the indicator light continues to flash  
after a turn, manually return the lever to  
its original position.  
Right turn  
Right lane  
change  
Fog light switch  
OFF  
Left lane  
change  
To turn them off, rotate the fog light  
switch to the OFF position or turn the  
headlight switch to the or OFF  
position.  
Left turn  
Green indicators on the dashboard show  
which signal is working.  
NOTE  
l
The fog lights will turn off when the  
headlights are set at high beam.  
(With auto-light control)  
Lane-change signals  
l
Move the lever slightly toward the  
direction of the change until the  
indicator flashesand hold it there. It  
will return to the off position when  
released.  
If the fog light switch is in the ON position  
and the headlight switch is in the AUTO  
position, the front fog lights will be turned  
on when the headlights, the exterior lights  
and dashboard illumination are  
automatically turned on.  
NOTE  
If an indicator light stays on without flashing  
or if it flashes abnormally, one of the turn  
signal bulbs may be burned out.  
5-56  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page211  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (211,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
qWindshield Wipers  
Windshield Wipers and  
Washer  
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
WARNING  
Use only windshield washer fluid or  
plain water in the reservoir:  
Using radiator antifreeze as washer  
fluid is dangerous. If sprayed on the  
windshield, it will dirty the  
windshield, affect your visibility, and  
could result in an accident.  
Turn the wipers on by pulling the lever  
down.  
INT Intermittent  
1 Low speed  
2 High speed  
Do not use the washer without first  
warming the windshield and never use  
plain tap water:  
Using windshield washer fluid  
without anti-freeze protection in  
freezing temperatures is dangerous.  
The washer fluid could freeze on the  
windshield and block your vision. You  
could have an accident.  
For a single wiping cycle, push the lever  
up to MIST.  
MIST Mist  
Variable-speed intermittent wipers  
Set the lever to INT and choose the  
interval timing by rotating the ring.  
NOTE  
Because heavy ice and snow can jam the wiper  
blades, the wiper motor is protected from  
motor breakdown, overheating and possible  
fire by a circuit breaker. This mechanism will  
automatically stop operation of the blades, but  
only for about 5 minutes.  
If this happens, turn off the wiper switch and  
park off the right-of-way, and remove the snow  
and ice.  
INT ring  
After 5 minutes, turn on the switch and the  
blades should operate normally. If they don't  
resume functioning, consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible. Drive to  
the side of the road and park off the right-of-  
way. Wait until the weather clears before trying  
to drive with the wipers inoperative.  
5-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page212  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (212,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
qWindshield Washer  
Rear Window Wiper and  
Washer  
Pull the lever toward you and hold it to  
spray washer fluid.  
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
OFF  
qRear Window Wiper  
Washer  
NOTE  
With the wiper lever in the OFF or INT  
position, the wipers will operate continuously  
until the lever is released.  
Turn the wiper on by turning the rear  
wiper/washer switch.  
ON Normal  
If the washer doesn't work, inspect the  
fluid level (page 8-27). If it's OK, consult  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
INT Intermittent  
qRear Window Washer  
To spray washer fluid, turn the rear wiper/  
washer switch to the  
position. After  
the switch is released, the washer will  
stop.  
If the washer doesn't work, inspect the  
fluid level (page 8-27). If it's OK and the  
washer still doesn't work, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
5-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page213  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (213,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Fully Automatic Type Air Conditioning  
Rear Window Defroster  
The rear window defroster clears frost,  
fog, and thin ice from the rear window.  
The ignition switch must be in the ON  
position.  
Indicator light  
Press the switch to turn on the rear  
window defroster. The rear window  
defroster operates for about 15 minutes  
and turns off automatically.  
The indicator light illuminates during  
operation.  
CAUTION  
To turn off the rear window defroster  
before the 15 minutes has elapsed, press  
the switch again.  
Don't use sharp instruments or  
window cleaners with abrasives to  
clean the inside of the rear window  
surface. They may damage the  
defroster grid inside the window.  
Manual Type Air Conditioning  
NOTE  
This defroster is not designed for melting snow.  
If there is an accumulation of snow on the rear  
window, remove it before using the defroster.  
Indicator light  
5-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page214  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (214,1)  
Driving Your Mazda  
Switches and Controls  
Horn  
Hazard Warning Flasher  
To sound the horn, press the  
the steering wheel.  
mark on  
The hazard warning lights should always  
be used when you stop on or near a  
roadway in an emergency.  
The hazard warning lights warn other  
drivers that your vehicle is a traffic hazard  
and that they must take extreme caution  
when near it.  
Depress the hazard warning flasher and all  
the turn signals will flash.  
NOTE  
l
The turn signals do not work when the  
hazard warning lights are on.  
l
Check local regulations about the use of  
hazard warning lights while the vehicle is  
being towed to verify that it is not in  
violation of the law.  
5-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page215  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (215,1)  
Interior Comfort  
6
Use of various features for drive comfort, including air-conditioning and audio  
system.  
Manual Typeí .......................................................................... 6-6  
Fully Automatic Typeí .......................................................... 6-10  
íSome models.  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page216  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (216,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qParking in Direct Sunlight  
Operating Tips  
If the vehicle has been parked in direct  
sunlight during hot weather, open the  
windows to let warm air escape, then run  
the climate control system.  
qOperating the Climate Control  
System  
Operate the climate control system with  
the engine running.  
qNot Using for a Long Period  
NOTE  
Run the air conditioner about 10 minutes  
at least once a month to keep internal  
parts lubricated.  
To prevent the battery from being discharged,  
do not leave the fan control dial on for a long  
period of time with the ignition switch in the  
ACC position when the engine is not running.  
qCheck the Refrigerant before the  
Weather Gets Hot  
qClearing the Air Inlet  
Have the air conditioner checked before  
the weather gets hot. Lack of refrigerant  
may make the air conditioner less  
efficient. Consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer for refrigerant inspection.  
Clear all obstructions like leaves, snow  
and ice from the hood and the air inlet in  
the cowl grille to improve the system  
efficiency.  
qFoggy Windows  
The air conditioner is filled with  
HFC134a (R134a), a refrigerant that will  
not damage the ozone layer.  
If the air conditioner is low on refrigerant  
or has a malfunction, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
The windows may fog up easily in humid  
weather. Use the climate control system to  
defog the windows.  
To help defog the windows, operate the  
air conditioner to dehumidify the air.  
NOTE  
The air conditioner may be used along with the  
heater to dehumidify the air.  
qOutside/Recirculated Air Position  
Use the outside air position in normal  
conditions. The recirculated air position  
should be used only when driving on  
dusty roads or for quick cooling of the  
interior.  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page217  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (217,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Vent Operation  
Push  
qAdjusting the Vents  
Directing airflow  
You can direct air flow by rotating the vent.  
Opening/closing vents  
These vents can be opened and closed with wheel.  
NOTE  
When using the air conditioner, mist may come out from the vents. This is not a sign of trouble but a  
result of humid air being suddenly cooled.  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page218  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (218,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qSelecting the Airflow Mode  
Dashboard Vents  
Defroster and Floor Vents  
Dashboard and Floor Vents  
Defroster Vents  
Floor Vents  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page219  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (219,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Types of the Climate Control System  
Manual type and fully automatic type climate control systems are explained separately.  
Check your vehicle's climate control type and read the appropriate pages.  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page220  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (220,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Manual Typeí  
Temperature control dial  
Fan control dial  
Mode selector dial  
A/C Switch  
Air intake selector  
Fan control dial  
qControl Switches  
Temperature control dial  
Hot  
Cold  
This dial allows variable fan speeds.  
0Fan off  
1Low speed  
2Medium low speed  
3Medium high speed  
4High speed  
This dial controls temperature. Turn it  
clockwise for hot and counterclockwise  
for cold.  
6-6  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page221  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (221,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Mode selector dial  
NOTE  
l
The air conditioner may not function when  
the outside temperature approaches 0 °C  
(32 °F).  
l
(U.S.A., Canada)  
When the mode is set to  
or  
with the  
fan control dial in a position other than 0  
and the temperature control dial in the  
maximum cold position, the air intake  
selector switches to the recirculated air  
mode and the A/C turns on.  
Turn the mode selector dial to select  
airflow mode (page 6-4).  
If A/C is not desired, press the A/C switch  
to turn it off.  
NOTE  
l
If you want to slightly adjust the airflow  
Air intake selector  
amount, set the mode selector dial at  
.
l
For example, when the mode selector dial is  
at the position between the and  
positions, airflow from the floor vent is less  
than that of the  
position.  
í
A/C switch  
This switch controls the source of air  
entering the vehicle.  
Press the  
switch to alternate  
between the outside air and recirculated  
air modes.  
Push the A/C switch to turn the air  
conditioner on. The indicator light on the  
switch will illuminate when the fan  
control dial is set at position 1, 2, 3, or 4.  
It is recommended that under normal  
conditions the switch be kept in the  
outside air mode.  
Outside air mode (indicator light  
turned off)  
Push the switch once again to turn the air  
conditioner off.  
Outside air is taken into the vehicle. Use  
this mode for normal ventilation and  
heating.  
Recirculated air mode (indicator light  
illuminated)  
Outside air is shut off. Air within the  
vehicle is recirculated.  
íSome models.  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page222  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (222,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
qCooling (With Air Conditioner)í  
This mode can be used when driving on a  
dusty road or in similar conditions. It also  
helps to provide quicker cooling of the  
interior.  
1. Set the mode selector dial to the  
position.  
2. Set the temperature control dial to the  
cold position.  
WARNING  
Do not use the recirculated air mode in  
cold or rainy weather:  
3. Set the fan control dial to the desired  
speed.  
Using the recirculated air mode in  
cold or rainy weather is dangerous as  
it will cause the windows to fog up.  
Your vision will be hampered, which  
could lead to a serious accident.  
4. Turn on the air conditioner by pressing  
the A/C switch.  
5. Adjust the fan control dial and  
temperature control dial to maintain  
maximum comfort.  
qHeating  
CAUTION  
When using the air conditioner while  
driving up long hills or in heavy  
traffic, closely monitor the  
temperature gauge (page 5-35).  
The air conditioner may cause engine  
overheating. If the gauge indicates  
overheating, turn the air conditioner  
off (page 7-11).  
1. Set the mode selector dial to the  
position.  
2. Set the temperature control dial to the  
hot position.  
3. Set the fan control dial to the desired  
speed.  
NOTE  
l
If the windshield fogs up easily, set the  
mode selector dial to the  
position.  
If cooler air is desired at face level, set the  
mode selector dial at the position and  
NOTE  
l
l
l
l
When maximum cooling is desired, set the  
temperature control dial to the extreme cold  
position and set the air intake selector to  
the recirculated air mode, then set the fan  
control dial to position 4.  
adjust the temperature control dial to  
maintain maximum comfort.  
The air to the floor is warmer than air to  
the face (except when the temperature  
control dial is set at the extreme hot or cold  
position).  
l
If warmer air is desired at floor level, set  
the mode selector dial at the  
and adjust the temperature control dial to  
maintain maximum comfort.  
position  
In the  
,
, or  
position, the air  
conditioner is automatically turned on  
(however, the indicator light does not  
illuminate) and the outside air mode is  
automatically selected to defrost the  
windshield.  
l
The air to the floor is warmer than air to  
the face (except when the temperature  
control dial is set at the extreme hot or cold  
position).  
In the  
or  
position, the outside air  
mode cannot be changed to the recirculated  
air mode.  
6-8  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page223  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (223,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
NOTE  
l
qVentilation  
For maximum defrosting, set the  
temperature control dial to the extreme hot  
position and the fan control dial to position  
4.  
1. Set the mode selector dial to the  
position.  
2. Set the air intake selector to the outside  
air mode.  
l
l
If warm air is desired at the floor, set the  
mode selector dial to the  
position.  
3. Set the temperature control dial to the  
desired position.  
In the , or position, the air  
,
conditioner is automatically turned on  
(however, the indicator light does not  
illuminate) and the outside air mode is  
automatically selected to defrost the  
windshield.  
4. Set the fan control dial to the desired  
speed.  
q
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging  
In the  
or  
position, the outside air  
1. Set the mode selector dial to the  
position.  
mode cannot be changed to the recirculated  
air mode.  
2. Set the temperature control dial to the  
desired position.  
qDehumidifying (With Air  
Conditioner)í  
3. Set the fan control dial to the desired  
speed.  
Operate the air conditioner in cool or cold  
weather to help defog the windshield and  
side windows.  
WARNING  
Do not defog the windshield using the  
position with the temperature  
1. Set the mode selector dial to the  
desired position.  
control set to the cold position:  
2. Set the air intake selector to the outside  
air mode.  
Using the  
position with the  
temperature control set to the cold  
position is dangerous as it will cause  
the outside of the windshield to fog  
up. Your vision will be hampered,  
which could lead to a serious  
3. Set the temperature control dial to the  
desired position.  
4. Set the fan control dial to the desired  
speed.  
accident. Set the temperature control  
to the hot or warm position when  
5. Turn on the air conditioner by pressing  
the A/C switch.  
using the  
position.  
NOTE  
One of the functions of the air conditioner is  
dehumidifying the air and, to use this function,  
the temperature does not have to be set to cold.  
Therefore, set the temperature control dial to  
the desired position (hot or cold) and turn on  
the air conditioner when you want to  
dehumidify the cabin air.  
íSome models.  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page224  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (224,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Fully Automatic Typeí  
Climate control information is displayed on the information display.  
Mode selector switch  
Temperature control dial  
Fan control dial  
Windshield defroster switch  
OFF Switch  
Auto Switch  
Ambient Temperature switch  
A/C Switch  
Air intake selector  
l
l
Outside/Recirculated air selection  
Air conditioner operation  
qControl Switches  
AUTO switch  
NOTE  
AUTO switch indicator light  
l
When on, it indicates AUTO operation, and  
the system will function automatically.  
l
When off, it indicates the operation of other  
switches such as the mode selector switch,  
fan control dial, A/C switch and windshield  
defroster switch. Other functions will  
continue to operate automatically.  
By pressing the AUTO switch the  
following functions will be automatically  
controlled in accordance with the set  
temperature:  
l
Airflow temperature  
Amount of airflow  
Selection of airflow mode  
l
l
6-10  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page225  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (225,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
OFF switch  
Mode selector switch  
Pressing the OFF switch shuts off the  
climate control system.  
The desired airflow mode can be selected  
(page 6-4).  
NOTE  
Temperature control dial  
l
With the airflow mode set to  
position  
and the temperature control dial set at a  
medium temperature, heated air is directed  
to the feet and a comparably lower air  
temperature will flow through the central,  
left and right vents.  
Cold  
Hot  
l
To set the air vent to  
, press the  
windshield defroster switch.  
A/C switch  
This dial controls temperature.Turn it  
clockwise for hot and counterclockwise  
for cold.  
Fan control dial  
With the AUTO or fan control dial ON,  
press the A/C switch to select the air  
conditioning (cooling/dehumidifying  
functions) on or off.  
Slow  
Fast  
The fan has seven speeds. The selected  
speed will be displayed.  
NOTE  
The air conditioner may not function when the  
outside temperature approaches 0 °C (32 °F).  
(Indicator remains on even when system is off.)  
6-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page226  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (226,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Air intake selector  
Press the AMB switch to display the  
ambient temperature.  
NOTE  
l
The displayed ambient temperature may  
vary from the actual ambient temperature  
depending on the surrounding area and  
vehicle conditions.  
l
Press the AMB switch 3 seconds or more to  
switch the display from Fahrenheit to  
Centigrade or vice versa.  
Press the AMB switch again to switch the  
display from ambient temperature to the  
temperature set for the air conditioner.  
Outside or recirculated air positions can  
be selected. Press the switch to select  
outside/recirculated air positions.  
l
Recirculated air position (indicator  
light illuminated)  
Windshield defroster switch  
Use this position when going through  
tunnels, driving in congested traffic (high  
engine exhaust areas) or when quick  
cooling is desired.  
Outside air position (indicator light  
turned off)  
Use this position for normal conditions  
and defogging.  
Press the switch to defrost the windshield  
and front door windows.  
WARNING  
Do not use the  
rainy weather:  
Using the  
position in cold or  
qOperation of Automatic Air  
Conditioning  
position in cold or  
rainy weather is dangerous as it will  
cause the windows to fog up. Your  
vision will be hampered, which could  
lead to a serious accident.  
1. Press the AUTO switch. Selection of  
the airflow mode, air intake selector  
and amount of airflow will be  
automatically controlled.  
AMB (Ambient Temperature) switch  
6-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page227  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (227,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
2. Use the temperature control dial to  
select a desired temperature.  
WARNING  
Set the temperature control to the hot  
or warm position when defogging (  
position):  
Using the  
position with the  
temperature control set to the cold  
position is dangerous as it will cause  
the outside of the windshield to fog  
up. Your vision will be hampered,  
which could lead to a serious  
accident.  
Cold  
Hot  
To turn off the system, press the OFF  
switch.  
NOTE  
Use the temperature control dial to increase  
the air flow temperature and defog the  
windshield more quickly.  
NOTE  
l
Setting the temperature to maximum high  
or low will not provide the desired  
temperature at a faster rate.  
l
When selecting heat, the system will restrict  
airflow until it has warmed to prevent cold  
air from blowing out of the vents.  
qSunlight/Temperature Sensor  
The fully automatic air conditioner  
function measures inside and outside  
temperatures, and sunlight. It then sets  
temperatures inside the passenger  
compartment accordingly.  
q
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging  
CAUTION  
Do not obstruct either sensor,  
otherwise the automatic air  
conditioner will not operate properly.  
Sunlight sensor  
Press the windshield defroster switch.  
In this position, the position is  
automatically selected, and the air  
conditioner automatically turns on. The  
air conditioner will directly dehumidify  
the air to the front windshield and side  
windows (page 6-4). Airflow amount will  
be increased.  
6-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page228  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (228,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Climate Control System  
Interior temperature sensor  
6-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page229  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (229,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Antenna  
Operating Tips for Audio  
System  
qDetachable Type  
To remove the antenna, turn it  
counterclockwise.  
To install the antenna, turn it clockwise.  
Make sure the antenna is securely  
installed.  
WARNING  
Do not adjust the audio control  
switches while driving the vehicle:  
Adjusting the audio while driving the  
vehicle is dangerous as it could  
distract your attention from the  
vehicle operation which could lead to  
a serious accident. Always adjust the  
audio while the vehicle is stopped.  
Even if the audio control switches are  
equipped on the steering wheel, learn  
to use the switches without looking  
down at them so that you can keep  
your maximum attention on the road  
while driving the vehicle.  
Install  
Remove  
CAUTION  
CAUTION  
For the purposes of safe driving,  
adjust the audio volume to a level  
that allows you to hear sounds  
outside of the vehicle.  
Ø To prevent damage to the  
antenna, remove it before entering  
a car wash facility or passing  
beneath a low overhead clearance.  
Ø Be careful around the antenna  
when removing snow from the  
roof. Otherwise the antenna could  
be damaged.  
NOTE  
l
Do not use the audio for long periods of  
time while the engine is off. Otherwise the  
battery could go dead.  
l
If a cellular phone or CB radio is used in  
or near the vehicle, it could cause noise to  
occur from the audio system, however, this  
does not indicate that the system has been  
damaged.  
NOTE  
When leaving your vehicle unattended, we  
recommend that you remove the antenna and  
store it inside the vehicle.  
6-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page230  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (230,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Signals from an FM transmitter are similar  
to beams of light because they do not  
bend around corners, but they do reflect.  
Unlike AM signals, FM signals cannot  
travel beyond the horizon. Therefore, FM  
stations cannot be received at the great  
distances possible with AM reception.  
qRadio Reception  
AM characteristics  
AM signals bend around such things as  
buildings or mountains and bounce off the  
ionosphere. Therefore, they can reach  
longer distances than FM signals. Because  
of this, two stations may sometimes be  
picked up on the same frequency at the  
same time.  
Ionosphere  
FM wave  
AM wave  
Ionosphere  
FM wave  
100—200 km (60—120 miles)  
Atmospheric conditions can also affect  
FM reception. High humidity will cause  
poor reception. However, cloudy days  
may provide better reception than clear  
days.  
Station 1  
Station 2  
FM characteristics  
An FM broadcast range is usually about  
4050 km (2530 miles) from the  
source. Because of extra coding needed to  
break the sound into two channels, stereo  
FM has even less range than monaural  
(non-stereo) FM.  
Multipath noise  
Since FM signals can be reflected by  
obstructions, it is possible to receive both  
the direct signal and the reflected signal at  
the same time. This causes a slight delay  
in reception and may be heard as a broken  
sound or a distortion. This problem may  
also be encountered when in close  
FM Station  
proximity to the transmitter.  
40—50km  
(25—30 miles)  
Reflected wave  
Direct  
6-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page231  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (231,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Flutter/Skip noise  
Strong signal noise  
Signals from an FM transmitter move in  
straight lines and become weak in valleys  
between tall buildings, mountains, and  
other obstacles. When a vehicle passes  
through such an area, the reception  
conditions may change suddenly, resulting  
in annoying noise.  
This occurs very close to a transmitter  
tower. The broadcast signals are  
extremely strong, so the result is noise and  
sound breakup at the radio receiver.  
Station drift noise  
When a vehicle reaches the area of two  
strong stations broadcasting at similar  
frequencies, the original station may be  
temporarily lost and the second station  
picked up. At this time there will be some  
noise from this disturbance.  
Weak signal noise  
In suburban areas, broadcast signals  
become weak because of distance from  
the transmitter. Reception in such fringe  
areas is characterized by sound breakup.  
Station 2  
Station 1  
88.1 MHz  
88.3 MHz  
6-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page232  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (232,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
The CD revolves at high speed within  
the unit. Defective (cracked or badly  
bent) CDs should never be used.  
qOperating Tips for CD Player/In-  
Dash CD Changer  
Condensation phenomenon  
Immediately after turning on the heater  
when the vehicle is cold, the CD or  
optical components (prism and lens) in the  
CD player/In-dash CD changer may  
become clouded with condensation. At  
this time, the CD will eject immediately  
when placed in the unit. A clouded CD  
can be corrected simply by wiping it with  
a soft cloth. Clouded optical components  
will clear naturally in about an hour. Wait  
for normal operation to return before  
attempting to use the unit.  
l
Do not use non-conventional discs  
such as heart-shaped, octagonal discs,  
etc. The disc may not eject resulting in  
a malfunction.  
Handling the CD player/In-dash CD  
changer  
The following precautions should be  
observed.  
l
Do not spill any liquid on the audio  
system.  
l
If the memory portion of the CD is  
transparent or translucent, do not use  
the disc.  
l
Do not insert any objects, other than  
CDs, into the slot.  
Transparent  
6-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page233  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (233,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
A new CD may have rough edges on  
CD Player  
its inner and outer perimeters. If a disc  
with rough edges is used, proper  
setting will not be possible and the CD  
player/In-dash CD changer will not  
play the CD. In addition, the disc may  
not eject resulting in a malfunction.  
Remove the rough edges in advance by  
using a ball-point pen or pencil as  
shown below. To remove the rough  
edges, rub the side of the pen or pencil  
against the inner and outer perimeter of  
the CD.  
In-dash CD changer  
l
Be sure never to touch the signal  
surface when handling the CDs. Pick  
up a CD by grasping the outer edge or  
the edge of the hole and the outer edge.  
l
When driving over uneven surfaces,  
the sound may jump.  
l
l
Do not stick paper or tape on the CD.  
Avoid scratching the reverse side (the  
side without a label). The disc may not  
eject resulting in a malfunction.  
Dust, finger smudges, and dirt can  
decrease the amount of light reflected  
from the signal surface, thus affecting  
sound quality. If the CD should  
become soiled, gently wipe it with a  
soft cloth from the center of the CD to  
the edge.  
l
The CD player/In-dash CD changer has  
been designed to play CDs bearing the  
identification logo as shown. No other  
discs can be played.  
l
Use discs that have been legitimately  
produced. If illegally-copied discs such  
as pirated discs are used, the system  
may not operate properly.  
6-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page234  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (234,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
Do not use record sprays, antistatic  
Handling the In-dash CD changer  
agents, or household spray cleaners.  
Volatile chemicals such as benzine and  
thinner can also damage the surface of  
the CD and must not be used. Anything  
that can damage, warp, or fog plastic  
should never be used to clean CDs.  
Insert discs one by one. If two discs are  
inserted at the same time, the system  
may not operate properly.  
l
This unit may not be able to play  
certain CD-R/CD-RWs made using a  
computer or music CD recorder due to  
disc characteristics, scratches,  
smudges, dirt, etc., or due to dust or  
condensation on the lens inside the  
unit.  
l
l
Storing CDs in the vehicle exposed to  
direct sunlight or high temperature may  
damage the CD-R/CD-RWs, and make  
them unplayable.  
CD-R/CD-RW exceeding 700 MB  
cannot be played.  
l
CD TEXT textual information cannot  
be displayed by audio units other than  
the In-dash CD changer (MP3  
compatible type only). (Only playback  
is possible.)  
The following player can play MP3  
files recorded in CD-ROM, CD-R, and  
CD-RW.  
· In-dash CD changer (MP3  
compatible type only)  
The CD player/In-dash CD changer  
ejects the CD if the CD is inserted  
upside down. Also dirty and/or  
defective CDs may be ejected.  
l
l
This unit may not be able to play  
l
certain discs made using a computer  
due to the application (writing  
software) setting used. (For details,  
consult the store where the application  
was purchased.)  
l
l
It is possible that certain text data, such  
as titles, recorded on a CD-R/CD-RW  
may not be displayed when musical  
data (CD-DA) is playing.  
The period from when a CD-RW is  
inserted to when it begins playing is  
longer than a normal CD or CD-R.  
Completely read the instruction manual  
and cautions for CD-R/CD-RWs.  
Do not use discs with cellophane tape  
adhering, partially peeled off labels, or  
adhesive material exuding from the  
edges of the CD label. Also, do not use  
discs with a commercially-available  
CD-R label affixed. The disc may not  
eject resulting in a malfunction.  
l
An 8 cm (3 in) CD can be played in the  
CD player.  
l
The In-dash CD changer is specially  
made for 12 cm (5 in) CDs.  
An 8 cm (3 in) CD can be played in the  
In-dash CD changer (MP3 compatible  
type only) if an 8 cm (3 in) CD adapter  
is used.  
If an 8 cm (3 in) CD adapter is not  
used, the In-dash CD changer (MP3  
compatible type only) may be  
damaged. Always use a CD adapter.  
An 8 cm (3 in) CD cannot be played in  
the In-dash CD changer (MP3 non-  
compatible type only) even if an 8 cm  
(3 in) CD adapter is used.  
l
l
l
Do not insert cleaning discs in the CD  
player/In-dash CD changer.  
Do not insert any disc with a peel-off  
l
seal affixed to it.  
6-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page235  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (235,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
If a disc has both music data (CD-DA)  
and MP3 files, playback of the two file  
types differs depending on how the  
disc was recorded.  
Packet written discs cannot be played  
on this unit.  
This unit does not play CDs recorded  
using MP3i (MP3 interactive), MP3  
PRO and RIFF MP3 formats.  
qOperating tips for MP3  
NOTE  
Supply of this product only conveys a license  
for private, non-commercial use and does not  
convey a license nor imply any right to use this  
product in any commercial (i.e. revenue-  
generating) real time broadcasting (terrestrial,  
satellite, cable and/or any other media),  
broadcasting/streaming via the Internet,  
intranets and/or other networks or in other  
electronic content distribution systems, such as  
pay-audio or audio-on-demand applications.  
An independent license for such use is  
required. For details, please visit http://  
www.mp3licensing.com.  
l
l
l
This audio system handles MP3 files  
that have been recorded on CD-R/CD-  
RW/CD-ROMs. Discs that have been  
recorded using the following formats  
can be played:  
l
ISO 9660 level 1  
ISO 9660 level 2  
Joliet extended format  
Romeo extended format  
l
l
l
l
This unit handles MP3 files  
conforming to the MP3 format  
containing both header frames and data  
frames.  
l
This unit can play multi-session  
recorded discs that have up to 40  
sessions.  
This unit can play MP3s with sampling  
l
frequencies of 16/22.05/24/32/44.1/48  
kHz.  
This unit can play MP3 files that have  
l
been recorded in bit rates of 8 kbps to  
320 kbps. Nonetheless, to insure  
enjoyment of music with consistent  
sound quality, it is recommended to use  
discs that have been recorded at a bit  
rate of 128 kbps or more.  
6-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page236  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (236,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
l
l
About folders and files  
MP3 files not conforming to the MP3  
format containing both header frames  
and data frames will be skipped and  
not played.  
This unit will play MP3 files that have  
up to eight levels. However, the more  
levels a disc has, the longer it will take  
to initially start playing. It is  
recommended to record discs with two  
levels or less.  
A single disc with up to 512 files can  
be played and a single folder with up to  
255 files can be played.  
When naming an MP3 file, be sure to  
add an MP3 file extension (.mp3) after  
the file name.  
The maximum number of characters  
that can be used for file names is as  
follows. However, this unit will only  
display up to 30 characters, including  
the file extension (.mp3).  
l
The order of hierarchy for MP3 files  
and folders during playback or other  
functions is from shallow to deep. The  
arrangement and playing order of a  
recorded disc containing MP3 files is  
as follows:  
l
File number  
A numerical file number is assigned  
to each file in a folder in the order of  
hierarchy from shallow to deep.  
l
l
l
l
Folder number  
A numerical folder number is  
assigned to each folder in the order  
of hierarchy from shallow to deep.  
Folder  
No.  
01  
02  
04  
3
Maximum number of  
characters in a file name  
(including a separator .”  
and the three letters of the  
file extension)  
03  
2
ISO9660 level 1  
12*  
31*  
05  
ISO9660 level 2  
4
Joliet extended  
format  
64  
06  
Romeo extended  
format  
128  
5
1
* English one-byte characters (capitalized only) and  
underbar _are available.  
CAUTION  
Level1 Level2 Level3 Level4  
This unit can only play MP3 files that  
have an MP3 file extension (.mp3)  
attached. Do not attach an MP3 file  
extension to any other type file as it  
could cause noise to be emitted or a  
malfunction in the unit.  
l
The folder order is automatically  
assigned and this order cannot be  
optionally set.  
Any folder without an MP3 file will be  
ignored. (It will be skipped and the  
folder number will not be displayed.)  
l
6-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page237  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (237,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
About ID3 Tag display  
Sampling  
l
This unit can only display ID3 Tag  
Refers to the process of encoding analog  
audio data at regular intervals and  
converting it to digital data. The sampling  
rate refers to the number of times a  
sample is taken in one second and is  
expressed in Hz units. Increasing the  
sampling rate improves the sound quality  
but also increases the data size.  
album, track and artist names that have  
been input using Ver.1.0/1.1/2.2/2.3  
formats. Any other data that may have  
been input cannot be displayed.  
l
This unit can only display English  
(including numerals) one-byte  
characters. Use only English (including  
numerals) one-byte characters when  
inputting ID3 tags. Two-byte characters  
and some special symbols cannot be  
displayed.  
Bit rate  
Refers to the volume of data per second,  
expressed in bps (bits per second).  
Generally, the larger the number of the  
transfer bit rate when compressing an  
MP3 file, the more information regarding  
musical reproduction it carries, and  
therefore the better the sound quality.  
Specialized glossary  
MP3  
Abbreviation for MPEG Audio Layer 3.  
A technical standard for audio  
compression as decided by an ISO  
(International Organization for  
Standardization) MPEG working group.  
Use of MP3 allows for audio data to be  
compressed to approximately a tenth of  
the source data size.  
Packet writing  
A general term for the method, similar to  
that used for floppy discs or hard drives,  
of recording the required file in a single  
increment on a CD-R and similar.  
ID3 Tag  
ISO 9660  
ID3 tag is a method for storing  
An international standard for logical  
formatting of CD-ROM files and folders.  
It is divided into three separate levels  
based on differences in file naming  
procedures, data configuration and other  
characteristics.  
information related to the music in an  
MP3 file. Information such as track, artist  
and album name can be stored. This  
content can be freely edited using ID3  
editing function software.  
VBR  
Multi-session  
Abbreviation for Variable Bit Rate. While  
CBR (Constant Bit Rate) is generally  
used, VBR varies the bit rate for audio  
compression according to compression  
conditions and this allows for  
A session is the complete amount of data  
recorded from the beginning to the end of  
a single period of CD-ROM, CD-R/CD-  
RW data recording. Multi-session refers to  
the existence of data from two or more  
sessions on a single disc.  
compression with preference given to  
sound quality.  
6-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page238  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (238,1)  
MEMO  
6-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page239  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (239,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Audio Set  
l
Audio information is displayed on the information display.  
There are two types of In-dash CD changers. Check which In-dash CD changer your  
vehicle is equipped with.  
l
CD Player  
In-dash CD Changer (MP3 compatible)  
In-Dash CD Changer (non-MP3 compatible)  
6-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page240  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (240,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qPower/Volume/Sound Controls  
Power/Volume dial  
Audio control dial  
Power ON/OFF  
Audio sound adjustment  
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or  
ON position.  
1. Press the audio control dial to select the  
function. The selected function will be  
indicated.  
Press the power/volume dial to turn the  
audio system on.  
Press the power/volume dial again to turn  
the audio system off.  
Standard audio-  
equipped model  
NOTE  
To prevent the battery from being discharged,  
do not leave the audio system on for a long  
period of time when the engine is not running.  
Volume adjustment  
Depending on the mode selected, the  
indication changes.  
To adjust the volume, turn the power/  
volume dial.  
Turn the power/volume dial to the right to  
increase volume, to the left to decrease it.  
6-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page241  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (241,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Bose® Sound System-equipped model  
Bose Sound  
System-  
Indication  
Turn Left Turn Right  
equipped model  
OFF  
OFF  
ON  
ON  
Decrease  
bass  
Increase  
bass  
Decrease  
treble  
Increase  
treble  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
Shift the  
Depending on the mode selected, the  
indication changes.  
front  
rear  
2. Turn the audio control dial to adjust the  
selected functions as follows:  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
Shift the  
left  
right  
Standard audio-equipped model  
OFF  
ON  
Indication  
Turn Left Turn Right  
NOTE  
Select mode  
About 5 seconds after selecting any mode, the  
volume function will be automatically selected.  
To reset bass, treble, fade, and balance, press  
the audio control dial for 2 seconds. The unit  
will beep and CLEARwill be displayed.  
Decrease  
bass  
Increase  
bass  
Decrease  
treble  
Increase  
treble  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
Automatic Level Control (ALC)  
(Standard audio-equipped model)  
front  
rear  
Shift the  
Shift the  
sound to the sound to the  
The automatic level control is a feature  
that automatically adjusts audio volume  
and sound quality according to the vehicle  
speed.  
left  
right  
OFF  
ON  
The volume increases in accordance with  
the increase in vehicle speed, and  
decreases as vehicle speed decreases.  
6-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page242  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (242,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
The following four modes are available.  
Select the desired mode.  
*Centerpoint® (Bose® Sound System-  
equipped model)  
Mode  
Volume change  
Centerpoint offers you the experience of  
5.1-channel surround sound in your  
vehicle even with your conventional 2-  
channel stereo CDs.  
The true surround sound effect of  
Centerpoint can be adjusted to any one of  
five level between minimum and  
maximum enhancement.  
No change  
Minimum  
Medium  
Maximum  
Indication  
Enhance level  
Turn the audio control dial to select ALC  
OFF or ALC LEVEL13 modes. The  
selected mode will be indicated.  
Minimum  
Low  
Medium  
High  
Maximum  
1. Turn the audio control dial and select  
CENTERPT ON.  
2. Press the audio control dial and select  
the surround effect mode.  
*AudioPilot® (Bose® Sound System-  
equipped model)  
3. Turn the audio control dial to select  
CENTERPT MINMAX mode. The  
selected mode will be indicated.  
AudioPilot automatically adjusts audio  
volume and sound quality in accordance  
with the level of noise entering the vehicle  
interior while driving. When AudioPilot is  
turned ON, the system automatically  
calculates the conditions for optimum  
hearing of sound which may be difficult  
to hear depending on exterior noise.  
* AudioPilot® is a registered trademark  
of Bose Corporation.  
6-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page243  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (243,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
NOTE  
Centerpoint® operates optimally with a 2-  
l
channel stereo CD. MP3 audio files can be  
played, however, MP3 audio files encoded  
with high compression may result in poor  
sound quality.  
Centerpoint® is available for 2-channel  
l
stereo audio except for AM radio/FM radio/  
SIRIUS digital satellite radio.  
* Centerpoint® is a registered trademark  
of Bose Corporation.  
BEEP setting  
The beep-sound when operating the audio  
system can be set on or off.  
6-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page244  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:18 PM  
Black plate (244,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qOperating the Radio  
Scan button Band selector button  
Satellite button  
Seek tuning  
buttons  
Channel  
preset  
buttons  
Manual tuning dial/Auto memory button/Electric serial number  
Radio ON  
Tuning  
Press a band selector button (  
turn the radio on.  
) to  
The radio has the following tuning  
methods: Manual, Seek, Scan, Preset  
channel, and Auto memory tuning. The  
easiest way to tune stations is to set them  
on preset channels.  
Band selection  
Successively pressing the band selector  
button ( ) switches the bands as  
follows: FM1FM2AM.  
NOTE  
If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows  
or the battery is disconnected), the preset  
channels will be canceled.  
The selected mode will be indicated. If  
FM stereo is being received, STwill be  
displayed.  
Manual tuning  
NOTE  
Turning the manual tuning dial will  
change the frequency higher or lower.  
If the FM broadcast signal becomes weak,  
reception automatically changes from  
STEREO to MONO for reduced noise, and the  
STindicator will go out.  
Seek tuning  
Pressing the seek tuning button (  
,
)
will cause the tuner to seek a higher or  
lower frequency automatically.  
6-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page245  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (245,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
NOTE  
Press and hold the auto memory button  
If you continue to press and hold the button,  
the frequency will continue changing without  
stopping.  
(
) for about 2 seconds until a beep  
sound is heard; the system will  
automatically scan and temporarily store  
up to 6 stations with the strongest  
frequencies in each selected band in that  
area.  
Scan tuning  
Press the scan button (  
) to  
automatically sample strong stations.  
Scanning stops at each station for about 5  
seconds. To hold a station, press the scan  
After scanning is completed, the station  
with the strongest frequency will be tuned  
and its frequency displayed.  
button (  
) again during this interval.  
Press and release the auto memory button  
Preset channel tuning  
(
) to recall stations from the auto-  
stored stations. One stored station will be  
selected each time; its frequency and  
channel number will be displayed.  
The 6 preset channels can be used to store  
6 AM and 12 FM stations.  
1. To set a channel first select AM, FM1,  
or FM2. Tune to the desired station.  
NOTE  
If no stations can be tuned after scanning  
operations, Awill be displayed.  
2. Depress a channel preset button for  
about 2 seconds until a beep sound is  
heard. The preset channel number and  
station frequency will be displayed.  
The station is now held in the memory.  
SATELLITE RADIO (SAT)  
Vehicles equipped with the separately  
purchased SIRIUS digital satellite radio  
unit have the ability to receive channels of  
digital quality programming coast to coast  
via satellite. For information on use, read  
the Satellite Radio Kit manual  
accompanying the SIRIUS digital satellite  
radio unit. A subscription to SIRIUS  
digital satellite radio service is required  
(available in the U.S. - Except Alaska and  
Hawaii) to enable this feature once the  
separately purchased SIRIUS digital  
satellite radio unit has been installed. For  
subscription and channel information, or  
for digital satellite radio technical issues,  
contact SIRIUS directly at:  
3. Repeat this operation for the other  
stations and bands you want to store.  
To tune one in the memory, select AM,  
FM1, or FM2 and then press its  
channel preset button. The station  
frequency and the channel number will  
be displayed.  
NOTE  
If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows  
or the battery is disconnected), the preset  
channels will be canceled.  
Auto memory tuning  
This is especially useful when driving in  
an area where the local stations are not  
known. Additional AM/FM stations can  
be stored without disturbing the  
- Web: www.siriusradio.com  
- Phone (24 hrs/day, 7 days/week): 888-  
539-SIRI (7474)  
- E-mail: [email protected]  
- Mailing Address: Sirius Satellite Radio  
previously set channels.  
6-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page246  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (246,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
1221 Avenue Of The Americas  
New York, NY 10020  
Attention: Customer Care  
Include your Sirius Radio ESN  
(Electronic Serial Number) when  
subscribing or requesting technical  
assistance. See the Satellite Radio Kit  
manual accompanying the SIRIUS unit  
for complete satellite radio activation  
procedures and information on how to  
display the ESN#.  
6-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page247  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (247,1)  
MEMO  
6-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page248  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (248,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qOperating the Compact Disc (CD) Playerí  
Track up button  
Repeat button  
CD play button  
Load button  
CD slot  
CD eject button  
Scan button  
Random button  
Reverse button  
Track down button  
Fast-forward button  
Type  
Playable data  
· Music data (CD-DA)  
NOTE  
When the load button (  
CD will load and play even if the CD eject  
button ( ) had been previously pressed.  
) is pressed, the  
Music CD player  
(non-MP3 compatible)  
Inserting the CD  
Fast-forward/Reverse  
Insert the CD into the slot, label-side up.  
The auto-loading mechanism will set the  
CD and begin play. There will be a short  
lapse before play begins while the player  
reads the digital signals on the CD.  
Press and hold the fast-forward button  
(
) to advance through a track at high  
speed.  
Press and hold the reverse button (  
)
to reverse through a track at high speed.  
Ejecting the CD  
Track search  
Press the CD eject button ( ) to eject the  
CD.  
Press the track up button ( ) once to skip  
forward to the beginning of the next track.  
Press the track down button ( ) once to  
skip back to the beginning of the current  
track.  
Playback  
Press the CD play button ( ) to start  
play when a CD is in the unit.  
If a CD is not in the unit when the CD  
play button ( ) is pressed, NO DISC”  
will flash on and off.  
6-34  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page249  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (249,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Music scan  
This feature helps to find a program by  
playing about the first 10 seconds of each  
track.  
Press the scan button (  
) during  
playback to start the scan play operation  
(the track number will flash).  
Press the scan button (  
cancel scan playback.  
) again to  
NOTE  
If the unit is left in scan, normal playback will  
resume where scan was selected.  
Repeat playback  
This feature makes it possible to listen to  
a selection repeatedly.  
Press the repeat button (  
) during  
playback. The current selection will be  
repeated (RPTwill be displayed).  
Press the repeat button (  
to cancel repeat playback.  
) once again  
Random playback  
This feature allows the CD player to  
randomly select the order of the songs.  
Press the random button (  
) during  
playback. The next selection will be  
randomly selected (RDMwill be  
displayed).  
Press the random button (  
) once  
again to cancel random playback.  
Message display  
If CHECK CDis displayed, it means  
that there is some CD malfunction. Check  
the CD for damage, dirt, or smudges, and  
then properly reinsert. If the message  
appears again, take the unit to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer for service.  
6-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page250  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (250,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qOperating the In-Dash CD Changerí  
Music CD player (non-MP3 compatible)  
Music CD/MP3 CD player (MP3 compatible)  
CD slot Repeat button  
CD eject button  
Disc  
Load button  
CD play button  
up/Folder  
up button  
Track up  
Channel  
preset  
buttons  
button  
Track down  
button  
Disc  
down/Folder  
down button  
Reverse button  
Fast-forward button  
Random button  
Scan button  
Display feed dial  
There are two types of In-dash CD  
changers. Check which In-dash CD  
changer your vehicle is equipped with.  
Inserting the CD  
The CD must be label-side up when  
inserting. The auto-loading mechanism  
will set the CD and begin play. There will  
be a short lapse before play begins while  
the player reads the digital signals on the  
CD.  
Type  
Playable data  
Music CD player  
(non-MP3 compatible)  
· Music data (CD-DA)  
Music CD/MP3 CD  
player  
(MP3 compatible)  
· Music data (CD-DA)  
· MP3 file  
The disc number and the track number  
will be displayed.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
If a disc has both music data (CD-DA) and  
MP3 files, playback of the two file types differs  
depending on how the disc was recorded.  
The CD will begin playback automatically  
after insertion.  
A CD cannot be inserted while the display  
reads WAIT. A beeping sound can be heard  
during this waiting time. Simultaneously  
pressing the power/volume dial and the load  
button (  
) for about 2 seconds will turn  
this beeping sound ON or OFF.  
6-36  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page251  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (251,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Normal insertion  
Ejecting the CD  
Normal ejection  
1. Press the load button (  
).  
2. When INis displayed, insert the CD.  
1. Press the CD eject button ( ). The  
disc number and DISC OUTwill be  
displayed.  
Inserting CDs into desired tray number  
1. Press and hold the load button (  
)
2. Pull out the CD.  
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
NOTE  
When the CD is ejected during play, the next  
CD will be played automatically.  
2. Press the channel preset button for the  
desired tray number while WAITis  
displayed.  
Ejecting CDs from desired tray number  
3. When INis displayed, insert the CD.  
1. Press and hold the CD eject button (  
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
)
NOTE  
The CD cannot be inserted to the desired tray  
number if the number is already occupied.  
The DISC OUTdisplay flashes.  
2. Press the channel preset button for the  
desired CD number for less than 5  
seconds after the beep sound is heard.  
Multiple insertion  
1. Press and hold the load button (  
)
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
3. Pull out the CD.  
Multiple ejection  
2. When INis displayed, insert the CD.  
1. Press and hold the CD eject button (  
for about 2 seconds until a beep sound  
is heard.  
)
3. When INis displayed again, insert  
the next CD.  
The DISC OUTdisplay flashes.  
NOTE  
The first-inserted CD will be played  
automatically when:  
2. Press the CD eject button ( ) again  
for less than 5 seconds after the beep  
sound is heard.  
l
No other CD is inserted within 15 seconds  
after INis displayed.  
l
The CD trays are full.  
NOTE  
If the button is not pressed and about 5  
seconds have elapsed while DISC OUTis  
flashing, CDs are automatically ejected.  
Displaying the CD-inserted tray  
number  
When you want to know the number for a  
CD-inserted tray, press the display button  
3. Pull out the CD, then the next CD will  
be ejected.  
(
). The tray number will be displayed  
for 5 seconds.  
6-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page252  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (252,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
NOTE  
Folder search (during MP3 CD  
playback)  
l
CDs will be ejected starting with the one  
with the lowest number.  
All CDs in the tray will be ejected  
continuously.  
CDs can be ejected when the ignition  
switch is off. Press and hold the CD eject  
button ( ) for about 2 seconds and all  
CDs will eject.  
To change to the previous folder, press the  
l
folder down button (  
1.5 seconds, or press the folder up button  
) for less than 1.5 seconds to  
) for less than  
l
(
advance to the next folder.  
Music scan  
This feature helps to find a program by  
playing about the first 10 seconds of each  
track.  
Playback  
Press the CD play button ( ) to start  
play when a CD is in the unit.  
If a CD is not in the unit when the CD  
play button ( ) is pressed, NO DISC”  
will flash on and off.  
Press the scan button (  
playback to start the scan play operation  
(the track number will flash).  
) during  
Press the scan button (  
cancel scan playback.  
) again to  
Fast-forward/Reverse  
Press and hold the fast-forward button  
NOTE  
(
) to advance through a track at high  
If the unit is left in scan, normal playback will  
resume where scan was selected.  
speed.  
Press and hold the reverse button (  
)
to reverse through a track at high speed.  
Repeat playback  
Track search  
During music CD playback  
Press the track up button ( ) once to skip  
forward to the beginning of the next track.  
Press the track down button ( ) once to  
skip back to the beginning of the current  
track.  
1. Press the repeat button (  
) during  
playback to play the current track  
repeatedly. RPTis displayed.  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
repeat playback.  
Disc search  
During MP3 CD playback  
(Track repeat)  
During music CD playback  
To change the disc, press the DISC button  
(
or  
) during playback.  
1. Press the repeat button (  
) during  
playback to play the current track  
repeatedly. RPTis displayed.  
During MP3 CD playback  
To change the disc, press the DISC button  
(
or  
) for 1.5 seconds or  
2. To cancel the repeat playback, press the  
button again after 3 seconds.  
more during playback.  
6-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page253  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (253,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
(Folder repeat)  
Music CD  
1. Press the repeat button (  
) during  
Track number/Elapsed  
time display  
playback, and then press the button  
again within 3 seconds to play the  
tracks in the current folder repeatedly.  
RPTis displayed.  
Disc tray number  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
repeat playback.  
File name display  
Album name display  
Random playback  
Tracks are randomly selected and played.  
Artist name display  
During music CD playback  
MP3 CD  
1. Press the random button (  
) during  
playback to play the tracks in the CD  
randomly. RDMis displayed.  
Disc number/File  
number/Elapsed  
time display  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
random playback.  
Disc tray number  
During MP3 CD playback  
(Folder random)  
Folder number/Track  
number  
1. Press the random button (  
) during  
playback to play the tracks in the folder  
randomly. RDMis displayed.  
File name  
2. To cancel the random playback, press  
the button again after 3 seconds.  
Folder name  
Album name (ID3 Tag)  
Song name (ID3 Tag)  
Artist name (ID3 Tag)  
(CD random)  
1. Press the random button (  
) during  
playback, and then press the button  
again within 3 seconds to play the  
tracks on the CD randomly. RDMis  
displayed.  
NOTE  
(MP3 CD)  
2. Press the button again to cancel the  
random playback.  
This unit can only read English (including  
numerals) one-byte characters. Depending on  
the CD writing software used, proper display  
may not be possible.  
Switching the display (MP3 compatible  
type)  
Each time the display button (  
) is  
pressed during playback, the display will  
switch in the following order.  
6-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page254  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (254,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Display scroll (MP3 compatible type)  
Only 12 characters can be displayed at  
one time. To display the rest of the  
characters of a long title, turn the display  
feed dial (  
) to the right. Hidden  
titles can be scrolled into the display one  
character at a time.  
NOTE  
The displayable number of characters is  
limited. If the number of characters, including  
the file extension (.mp3), exceeds 32  
characters, it may not be fully displayed.  
Message display  
If CHECK CDis displayed, it means  
that there is some CD malfunction. Check  
the CD for damage, dirt, or smudges, and  
then properly reinsert. If the message  
appears again, take the unit to an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer for service.  
6-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page255  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (255,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qError Indications  
If you see an error indication on the display, find the cause in the chart. If you cannot clear  
the error indication, take the vehicle to an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Indication  
Cause  
Solution  
Insert the CD properly. If the error indication  
does not disappear, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer  
CD is inserted upside down  
CHECK CD  
Insert another CD properly. If the error indication  
does not disappear, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer  
CD is defective  
6-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page256  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (256,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
With navigation system  
Use the VOICE switch for navigation  
system sound operation.  
For details, refer to the separate manual  
NAVIGATION SYSTEM.  
Audio Control Switch  
Operation (Steering Wheel)í  
When the audio unit is turned on,  
operation of the audio unit from the  
steering wheel is possible.  
NOTE  
VOICE switch  
Because the audio unit will be turned off under  
the following conditions, the switches will be  
inoperable.  
l
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
LOCK position.  
l
When the power button on the audio unit is  
pressed and the audio unit is turned off.  
l
When CD being played is ejected. (For the  
In-dash CD changer, when all CDs are  
ejected.)  
NOTE  
l
The VOICE switch is operable with the  
audio unit turned off.  
Without navigation system  
l
Mazda has installed this system to prevent  
distraction while driving the vehicle and  
using audio controls on the dashboard.  
Always make safe driving your first priority.  
qAdjusting the Volume  
To increase the volume, pull up the  
volume switch.  
To decrease the volume, press down the  
volume switch.  
6-42  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page257  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (257,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
qChanging the Source  
qSeek Switch  
Press the mode switch (  
) to change  
the audio source (FM1 radio> FM2 radio>  
AM radio> CD player or CD changer>  
SIRIUS1> SIRIUS2> SIRIUS3>  
cyclical).  
When listening to the radio  
Pull up or press down the seek switch, the  
radio switches to the next/previous stored  
station in the order that it was stored  
(16).  
NOTE  
Pull up or press down the seek switch for  
about 2 seconds until a beep sound is  
heard to seek all usable stations at a  
higher or lower frequency whether  
programmed or not.  
CD, CD changer, and SIRIUS digital satellite  
radio modes cannot be selected in the  
following cases:  
l
CD, CD changer, or SIRIUS digital satellite  
radio unit is not equipped on the audio  
system.  
When playing a CD  
l
CD has not been inserted.  
Pull up the seek switch to skip to the next  
track.  
Press down the seek switch to repeat the  
current track.  
qMute Switch  
Press the mute switch ( ) once to mute  
audio, press it again to resume audio  
output.  
NOTE  
If the ignition switch is turned to the LOCK  
position with the audio muted, the mute will be  
canceled.  
Therefore, when the engine is restarted, the  
audio is not muted. To mute the audio again,  
press the mute switch ( ).  
6-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page258  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (258,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
6-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page259  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (259,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Audio System  
Safety Certification  
This CD player is made and tested to meet exacting safety standards. It meets FCC  
requirements and complies with safety performance standards of the U.S. Department of  
Health and Human Services.  
CAUTION  
Ø This CD player should not be adjusted or repaired by anyone except qualified  
service personnel.  
If servicing is required, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Ø Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than those  
specified herein may result in hazardous laser exposure. Never operate the CD  
player with the top case of the unit removed.  
Ø Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for  
compliance could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
NOTE  
For CD player section:  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any  
interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
NOTE  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,  
pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection  
against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can  
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions,  
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that  
interference will not occur in a particular installation.  
6-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page260  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (260,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qVanity Mirrors  
Sunvisors  
To use the vanity mirror, lower the  
sunvisor.  
When you need a sunvisor, lower it for  
use in front or swing it to the side.  
Sunvisor  
qSide Extention Sunvisors  
The visor extender extends the sunvisor's  
range of sun shading.  
To use, pull it out.  
CAUTION  
When moving the sunvisor, reinsert  
the visor extender, otherwise the  
visor extender could hit the rearview  
mirror.  
6-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page261  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (261,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qOverhead Lights  
Front  
Interior Lights  
qIlluminated Entry System  
When the illuminated entry system  
operates, the overhead light (switch is in  
the DOOR position) turn on for:  
l
About 30 seconds after the driver's  
door is unlocked and the ignition  
switch is in the LOCK position (with  
the ignition key removed).  
l
About 15 seconds after all doors are  
closed (If your vehicle is equipped with  
the advanced key, the overhead light  
turns on for about 5 seconds when the  
advanced key is outside of the vehicle).  
Switch  
Position  
Front Overhead Lights  
Light off  
l
About 15 seconds after the ignition  
switch is in the LOCK position (with  
the ignition key removed) with all  
doors closed.  
l
Light is on when any door is  
open  
l
Light is on or off when the  
illuminated entry system is on  
The light also turns off when:  
l
The ignition switch is turned to the ON  
position and all doors are closed.  
The driver's door is locked.  
Rear  
l
NOTE  
Battery saver  
If any door is left opened, the light goes out  
after about 30 minutes to save the battery.  
The light turns on again when the ignition  
switch is turned to the ON position, or when  
any door is opened after all doors have been  
closed.  
Switch  
Position  
Rear Overhead Lights  
Light off  
Light is on when any door is open  
Light is on or off when the  
illuminated entry system is on  
Light on  
6-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page262  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (262,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qMap Lights  
The map lights are switched on or off by  
pressing the switches.  
Switches  
qLuggage Compartment Light  
Switch  
Luggage Compartment Light  
Position  
Light off  
Light on when the liftgate is open  
6-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page263  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (263,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Information Display  
Climate control display/ Ambient  
temperature display  
Audio display  
Clock  
Without  
navigation system  
qInformation Display Functions  
The information display has the following functions:  
l
Clock  
l
Ambient Temperature Display (Outside Temperature Display, Fully Automatic Type)  
Climate Control Display (Fully Automatic Type)  
Audio Display  
l
l
6-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page264  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (264,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Time resetting  
qClock  
While the clock is displayed, press the  
SET switch 1.5 seconds or more. When  
the switch is released, a beep will sound  
and the clock will be reset as follows:  
(Example)  
When the ignition switch is in the ACC or  
ON position, the time is displayed.  
12:0112:2912:00  
12:3012:591:00  
NOTE  
When the SET switch is released, the seconds  
are reset to 00.  
With navigation system  
Refer to NAVIGATION SYSTEM.  
NOTE  
Without navigation system  
Time setting  
Minutes and seconds are adjusted by the GPS,  
however, it is necessary to adjust hours under  
the following conditions:  
1. Press the CLOCK switch until a beep  
sounds, and 12Hrand 24Hrwill be  
displayed.  
l
Driving across different time zones  
l
Daylight saving time start and end  
qAmbient Temperature Display  
2. Press the SET switch to switch between  
12Hrand 24Hrdisplays. The  
selected display will flash.  
(Fully Automatic Type)  
When the ignition switch is in the ON  
position, press the AMB switch to display  
the ambient temperature.  
To select the desired clock setting,  
press the CLOCK switch again while  
the preferred setting is flashing.  
3. Hr. ADJUSTwill be displayed next,  
and the hour portion of the display will  
flash. Press the SET switch to set the  
hour, then press the CLOCK switch.  
4. Min. ADJUSTwill be displayed  
next, and the minutes portion of the  
display will flash. Press the SET switch  
to set the minutes, then press the  
CLOCK switch.  
6-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page265  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (265,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
NOTE  
Cup Holder  
l
Under the following conditions, the ambient  
temperature display may differ from the  
actual ambient temperature depending on  
the surroundings and vehicle conditions:  
WARNING  
Never use a cup holder to hold hot  
liquids while the vehicle is moving:  
Using a cup holder to hold hot liquids  
while the vehicle is moving is  
l
Significantly cold or hot temperatures.  
Sudden changes in ambient temperature.  
The vehicle is parked.  
The vehicle is driven at low speeds.  
l
l
l
dangerous. If the contents spill, you  
could be scalded.  
l
Press the AMB switch a few seconds or  
more to switch the display from Fahrenheit  
to Centigrade or vice versa.  
(With fully automatic climate control  
Do not put anything other than cups or  
drink cans in cup holders:  
l
Putting objects other than cups or  
drink cans in a cup holder is  
dangerous.  
During sudden braking or  
maneuvering, occupants could be hit  
and injured, or objects could be  
thrown around the vehicle, causing  
interference with the driver and the  
possibility of an accident. Only use a  
cup holder for cups or drink cans.  
system)  
Press the AMB switch again to switch the  
display from ambient temperature to the  
temperature set for the air conditioner.  
qClimate Control Display  
The climate control system status is  
displayed. To operate the climate control  
system, refer to Climate Control System”  
(page 6-2).  
qFront  
qAudio Display  
The front cup holder is in the center  
console.  
The audio system status is displayed. To  
operate the audio system, refer to  
Audio System(page 6-15).  
6-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page266  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (266,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qRear  
Bottle Holder  
The rear cup holder is on the rear center  
armrest.  
Bottle holders are on the inside of the  
front doors.  
Bottle holder  
CAUTION  
Do not use the bottle holders for  
containers without caps. The  
contents may spill when the door is  
opened or closed.  
6-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page267  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (267,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
qCenter Console  
Storage Compartments  
To open, push the button.  
WARNING  
Keep storage boxes closed when  
driving:  
Driving with the storage boxes open  
is dangerous. To reduce the  
possibility of injury in an accident or  
a sudden stop, keep the storage  
boxes closed when driving.  
CAUTION  
Do not leave lighters or eyeglasses in  
the storage boxes while parked under  
the sun. A lighter could explode or  
the plastic material in eyeglasses  
could deform and crack from high  
temperature.  
The center console has a lockable lid,  
insert the key into the slot; then turn the  
key clockwise to lock, counterclockwise  
to unlock.  
qGlove Box  
To open the glove box, pull the latch  
toward you.  
Lock  
Unlock  
qCargo Securing Loops  
WARNING  
Make sure luggage and cargo is  
secured before driving:  
Not securing cargo while driving is  
dangerous as it could move or be  
crushed during sudden braking or a  
collision and cause injury.  
6-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page268  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (268,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
Use the loops in the luggage compartment  
to secure cargo with a rope or net. The  
tensile strength of the loops is 196 N (20  
kgf, 44 lbf). Do not apply excessive force  
to the loops as it will damage them.  
Accessory Sockets  
The ignition switch must be in the ACC  
or ON position.  
Only use genuine Mazda accessories or  
the equivalent requiring no greater than  
120 W (DC 12 V, 10 A).  
The accessory socket is in the center  
console.  
Type A  
Type B  
6-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page269  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (269,1)  
Interior Comfort  
Interior Equipment  
CAUTION  
To prevent accessory socket damage  
or electrical failure, pay attention to  
the following:  
Ø Do not use accessories that require  
more than 120 W (DC 12 V, 10 A).  
Ø Do not use accessories that are not  
genuine Mazda accessories or the  
equivalent.  
Ø Close the cover when the accessory  
socket is not in use to prevent  
foreign objects and liquids from  
getting into the accessory socket.  
Ø Correctly insert the plug into the  
accessory socket.  
NOTE  
To prevent discharging of the battery, do not  
use the socket for long periods with the engine  
off or idling.  
6-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page270  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (270,1)  
6-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page271  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (271,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
7
Helpful information on what to do in an emergency.  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page272  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (272,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Parking in an Emergency  
Parking in an Emergency  
The hazard warning lights should always  
be used when you stop on or near a  
roadway in an emergency.  
The hazard warning lights warn other  
drivers that your vehicle is a traffic hazard  
and that they must take extreme caution  
when near it.  
Depress the hazard warning flasher and all  
the turn signals will flash.  
NOTE  
l
The turn signals do not work when the  
hazard warning lights are on.  
l
Check local regulations about the use of  
hazard warning lights while the vehicle is  
being towed to verify that it is not in  
violation of the law.  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page273  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (273,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
Spare Tire and Tool Storage  
Spare tire and tools are stored in the locations illustrated in the diagram.  
Wing bolt  
Spare tire  
(Except Mexico)  
Lug wrench  
Jack  
Jack lever  
Tiedown eyelet  
Spare tire  
Tiedown eyelet  
Tiedown eyelet  
Jack  
(Mexico)  
Lug wrench  
Jack lever  
Wing bolt  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page274  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (274,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
3. Turn the wing bolt and tighten it  
completely.  
qJack  
To remove the jack  
1. Remove the trunk board.  
qSpare Tire  
Your Mazda has a temporary spare tire.  
The temporary spare tire is lighter and  
smaller than a conventional tire, and is  
designed only for emergency use and  
should be used only for VERY short  
periods. Temporary spare tires should  
NEVER be used for long drives or  
extended periods.  
Trunk board  
WARNING  
Do not install the temporary spare tire  
on the front wheels (driving wheels)  
when driving on ice or snow:  
2. Turn the wing bolt and jack screw  
counterclockwise.  
Driving with a spare tire on the front  
(driving) wheels on ice or snow is  
dangerous. Handling will be affected.  
You could lose control of the vehicle  
and have an accident. Put the spare  
tire on the rear axle and move a  
regular tire to the front.  
Wing bolt  
Jack screw  
NOTE  
The jack can be removed from the rear door if  
the rear seatback is folded forward.  
Refer to Rear Seat on page 2-10.  
To secure the jack  
1. Turn the wing bolt clockwise and  
temporarily tighten it.  
2. Turn the jack screw clockwise and  
extend the jack to secure it to the  
vehicle.  
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page275  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (275,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
To remove the spare tire  
CAUTION  
1. Remove the trunk board, and if a spare  
tire cover is equipped remove it.  
Ø When using the temporary spare  
tire, driving stability may decrease  
compared to when using only the  
conventional tire.  
Trunk board  
Drive carefully.  
Ø To avoid damage to the temporary  
spare tire or to the vehicle, observe  
the following precautions:  
Ø
Do not exceed 80 km/h (50  
mph).  
Ø
Avoid driving over obstacles.  
Also, do not drive through an  
automatic car wash. This tire's  
diameter is smaller than a  
conventional tire's, so the  
ground clearance is reduced  
about 25 mm (1 in).  
Spare tire cover  
2. Turn the tire hold-down bolt  
counterclockwise with the lug wrench.  
Ø
Ø
Do not use a tire chain on this  
tire because it won't fit  
properly.  
Do not use your temporary  
spare tire on any other vehicle;  
it has been designed only for  
your Mazda.  
Use only one temporary spare  
tire on your vehicle at the same  
time.  
Ø
Ø (With limited slip differential)  
When using the temporary spare  
tire on the front axle, replace it  
with a standard tire as soon as  
possible. The size difference  
between the spare and the  
standard tire will cause the limited  
slip differential to malfunction.  
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used (page 5-29).  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page276  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (276,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
NOTE  
Changing a Flat Tire  
l
Make sure the jack is well lubricated before  
using it.  
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
If the following occurs while driving, it could  
indicate a flat tire.  
l
Be sure to register the tire pressure sensor  
ID signal code whenever tires or wheels are  
changed (page 5-31).  
l
Steering becomes difficult.  
The vehicle begins to vibrate excessively.  
l
l
The vehicle pulls in one direction.  
1. Park on a level surface off the right-of-  
way and firmly set the parking brake.  
If you have a flat tire, drive slowly to a  
level spot that is well off the road and out  
of the way of traffic to change the tire.  
Stopping in traffic or on the shoulder of a  
busy road is dangerous.  
2. Shift into Park (P) and turn off the  
engine.  
3. Turn on the hazard warning flasher.  
4. Have everyone get out of the vehicle  
and away from the vehicle and traffic.  
WARNING  
Be sure to follow the directions for  
changing a tire, and never get under a  
vehicle that is supported only by a jack:  
Changing a tire is dangerous if not  
done properly. The vehicle can slip off  
the jack and seriously injure  
5. Remove the jack, tool, and spare tire  
(page 7-3).  
6. Block the wheel diagonally opposite  
the flat tire. When blocking a wheel,  
place a tire block both in front and  
behind the tire.  
someone.  
Never allow anyone inside a vehicle  
supported by a jack:  
Allowing someone to remain in a  
vehicle supported by a jack is  
dangerous. The occupant could cause  
the vehicle to fall resulting in serious  
injury.  
CAUTION  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System)  
The wheels equipped on your Mazda  
are specially designed for installation  
of the tire pressure sensors. Do not  
use non-genuine wheels, otherwise it  
may not be possible to install the tire  
pressure sensors.  
NOTE  
When blocking a tire, use rocks or wood blocks  
of sufficient size if possible to hold the tire in  
place.  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page277  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (277,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
qRemoving a Flat Tire  
WARNING  
1. Loosen the lug nuts by turning them  
counterclockwise one turn each, but  
don't remove any lug nuts until the tire  
has been raised off the ground.  
Use only the front and rear jacking  
positions recommended in this manual:  
Attempting to jack the vehicle in  
positions other than those  
recommended in this manual is  
dangerous. The vehicle could slip off  
the jack and seriously injure or even  
kill someone. Use only the front and  
rear jacking positions recommended  
in this manual.  
Use only the jack provided with your  
Mazda:  
Using a jack that is not designed for  
your Mazda is dangerous. The vehicle  
could slip off the jack and seriously  
injure someone.  
2. Place the jack under the jacking  
position closest to the tire being  
changed.  
Never place objects under the jack:  
Jacking the vehicle with an object  
under the jack is dangerous. The jack  
could slip and someone could be  
seriously injured by the jack or the  
falling vehicle.  
3. Insert the jack lever and attach the lug  
wrench to tire jack.  
Jacking position  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page278  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (278,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
qLocking Lug Nutsí  
4. Turn the lug wrench clockwise and  
raise the vehicle high enough so that  
the spare tire can be installed. Before  
removing the lug nuts, make sure your  
Mazda is firmly in position and that it  
cannot slip or move.  
If your vehicle has optional antitheft  
wheel lug nuts, one on each wheel will  
lock the tires and you must use a special  
key to unlock them. This key is attached  
to the lug wrench and is stored with the  
spare tire. Register them with the lock  
manufacturer by filling out the card  
provided in the glove box and mailing it  
in the accompanying envelope. If you lose  
this key, consult an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer or use the lock manufacturer's  
order form, which is with the registration  
card.  
Antitheft lug nut  
Special key  
5. Remove the lug nuts by turning them  
counterclockwise; then remove the  
wheel and center cap.  
To remove an antitheft lug nut  
1. Obtain the key for the antitheft lug nut.  
2. Place the key on top of the nut, and be  
sure to hold the key square to it. If you  
hold the key at an angle, you may  
damage both key and nut. Don't use a  
power impact wrench.  
3. Place the lug wrench on top of the key  
and apply pressure. Turn the wrench  
counterclockwise.  
7-8  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page279  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (279,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
To install the nut  
3. Install the lug nuts with the beveled  
edge inward; tighten them by hand.  
1. Place the key on top of the nut, and be  
sure to hold the key square to it. If you  
hold the key at an angle, you may  
damage both key and nut. Don't use a  
power impact wrench.  
2. Place the lug wrench on top of the key,  
apply pressure, and turn it clockwise.  
qMounting the Spare Tire  
1. Remove dirt and grime from the  
mounting surfaces of the wheel and  
hub, including the hub bolts, with a  
cloth.  
WARNING  
Do not apply oil or grease to lug nuts  
and bolts and do not tighten the lug  
nuts beyond the recommended  
tightening torque:  
Applying oil or grease to lug nuts and  
bolts is dangerous. The lug nuts  
could loosen while driving and cause  
the tire to come off, resulting in an  
accident. In addition, lug nuts and  
bolts could be damaged if tightened  
more than necessary.  
4. Turn the jack handle counterclockwise  
and lower the vehicle. Use the lug  
wrench to tighten the nuts in the order  
shown.  
WARNING  
Make sure the mounting surfaces of  
the wheel, hub and lug nuts are clean  
before changing or replacing tires:  
When changing or replacing a tire,  
not removing dirt and grime from the  
mounting surfaces of the wheel, hub  
and hub bolts is dangerous. The lug  
nuts could loosen while driving and  
cause the tire to come off, resulting in  
an accident.  
2. Mount the spare tire.  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page280  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (280,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Flat Tire  
If you're unsure of how tight the nuts  
should be, have them inspected at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
NOTE  
Always use the wing bolt to secure the  
damaged tire. Store the tire hold-down bolt  
used to tighten down the spare tire in the same  
place as where the wing bolt had been stored.  
Nut tightening torque  
N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf)  
89117 (911, 6686)  
7. Check the inflation pressure. Refer to  
the specification charts on page 10-6.  
WARNING  
Always securely and correctly tighten  
the lug nuts:  
8. Have the flat tire repaired or replaced  
as soon as possible.  
Improperly or loosely tightened lug  
nuts are dangerous. The wheel could  
wobble or come off. This could result  
in loss of vehicle control and cause a  
serious accident.  
WARNING  
Do not drive with any tires that have  
incorrect air pressure:  
Driving on tires with incorrect air  
pressure is dangerous. Tires with  
incorrect pressure could affect  
handling and result in an accident.  
When you check the regular tires' air  
pressure, check the spare tire, too.  
Be sure to reinstall the same nuts you  
removed or replace them with metric  
nuts of the same configuration:  
Because the wheel studs and lug nuts  
on your Mazda have metric threads,  
using a non-metric nut is dangerous.  
On a metric stud, it would not secure  
the wheel and would damage the  
stud, which could cause the wheel to  
slip off and cause an accident.  
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
A tire pressure sensor is not installed to the  
temporary spare tire. The warning light will  
flash continuously while the temporary spare  
tire is being used (page 5-29).  
5. Remove the center cap by tapping it  
with the jack lever.  
NOTE  
6. Store the damaged tire, using the wing  
bolt to hold it in place.  
To prevent the jack and tool from rattling, store  
them properly.  
Wing bolt  
Tire clamp  
7-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page281  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (281,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Overheating  
3. Apply the parking brake.  
Overheating  
4. Turn off the air conditioner.  
If the temperature gauge indicates  
overheating, the vehicle loses power, or  
you hear a loud knocking or pinging  
noise, the engine is probably too hot.  
5. Check whether coolant or steam is  
escaping from under the hood or from  
the engine compartment.  
If steam is coming from the engine  
compartment:  
WARNING  
Don't go near the front of the vehicle.  
Stop the engine.  
Wait until the steam dissipates, then  
open the hood and start the engine.  
Turn off the ignition switch and  
make sure the fan is not running before  
attempting to work near the cooling  
fan:  
If neither coolant nor steam is  
escaping:  
Open the hood and idle the engine until  
it cools.  
Working near the cooling fan when it  
is running is dangerous. The fan  
could continue running indefinitely  
even if the engine has stopped and  
the engine compartment temperature  
is high. You could be hit by the fan  
and seriously injured.  
CAUTION  
If the cooling fan does not operate  
while the engine is running, the  
engine temperature will increase.  
Stop the engine and call an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Do not remove either cooling  
system caps when the engine and  
radiator are hot:  
6. Make sure the cooling fan is operating,  
then turn off the engine after the  
temperature has decreased.  
When the engine and radiator are  
hot, scalding coolant and steam may  
shoot out under pressure and cause  
serious injury.  
7. When cool, check the coolant level.  
If it's low, look for coolant leaks from  
the radiator and hoses.  
Open the hood ONLY after steam is no  
longer escaping from the engine:  
Steam from an overheated engine is  
dangerous. The escaping steam could  
seriously burn you.  
If the temperature gauge indicates  
overheating:  
1. Drive safely to the side of the road and  
park off the right-of-way.  
2. Shift into park (P).  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page282  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (282,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Overheating  
If you find a leak or other damage, or if  
coolant is still leaking:  
Stop the engine and call an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
If you find no problems, the engine is  
cool, and no leaks are obvious:  
Carefully add coolant as required (page  
CAUTION  
If the engine continues to overheat or  
frequently overheats, have the  
cooling system inspected. The engine  
could be seriously damaged unless  
repairs are made. Consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page283  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (283,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
Starting a Flooded Engine  
If the engine fails to start, it may be  
flooded (excessive fuel in the engine).  
Follow this procedure:  
1. If the engine does not start within 5  
seconds on the first try, turn the key to  
the LOCK position, wait 10 seconds  
and try again.  
2. Depress the accelerator all the way and  
hold it there.  
3. Turn the ignition switch to the START  
position and hold it therefor up to 10  
seconds. If the engine starts, release the  
key and accelerator immediately  
because the engine will suddenly rev  
up.  
4. If the engine fails to start, crank it  
without depressing the acceleratorfor  
up to 10 seconds.  
If the engine still does not start using the  
above procedure, have your vehicle  
inspected by an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page284  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (284,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
Jump-Starting  
Jump-starting is dangerous if done incorrectly. So follow the procedure carefully. If you  
feel unsure about jump-starting, we strongly recommend that you have a competent service  
technician do the work.  
WARNING  
Follow These Precautions Carefully:  
To ensure safe and correct handling of the battery, read the following precautions  
carefully before using the battery or inspecting it.  
Always wear eye protection when working near the battery:  
Working without eye protection is dangerous. Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID  
which could cause blindness if splashed into your eyes. Also, hydrogen gas produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode.  
Wear eye protection and protective gloves to prevent contact with battery  
fluid:  
Spilled battery fluid is dangerous.  
Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID which could cause serious injuries if it gets in  
eyes, skin or clothing. If this happens, immediately flush your eyes with water for 15  
minutes or wash your skin thoroughly and get medical attention.  
Always keep batteries out of the reach of children:  
Allowing children to play near batteries is dangerous. Battery fluid could cause  
serious injuries if it gets in the eyes or on the skin.  
Do not allow the positive ( ) terminal to contact any other metal object that  
could cause sparks:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries. When working near a  
battery, do not allow metal tools to contact the positive ( ) or negative (  
terminal of the battery.  
)
7-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page285  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (285,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
Keep all flames, including cigarettes, and sparks away from open battery cells:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries.  
Do not jump-start a frozen battery or one with a low fluid level:  
Jump-starting a frozen battery or one with a low fluid level is dangerous. It may  
rupture or explode, causing serious injury.  
Connect the negative cable to a good ground point away from the battery:  
Connecting the end of the second jumper cable to the negative ( ) terminal of the  
discharged battery is dangerous.  
A spark could cause the gas around the battery to explode and injure someone.  
Route the jumper cables away from parts that will be moving:  
Connecting a jumper cable near or to moving parts (cooling fans, belts) is dangerous.  
The cable could get caught when the engine starts and cause serious injury.  
CAUTION  
Use only a 12 V booster system. You can damage a 12 V starter, ignition system, and  
other electrical parts beyond repair with a 24 V power supply (two 12 V batteries in  
series or a 24 V motor generator set).  
Connect cables in numerical order and disconnect in reverse order  
Discharged battery  
Jumper  
cables  
Booster battery  
7-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page286  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (286,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
1. Remove the battery cover.  
6. When finished, carefully disconnect the  
cables in the reverse order described in  
the illustration.  
7. If the battery cover has been removed,  
install it in the reverse order of  
removal.  
NOTE  
Verify that the covers are securely installed.  
2. Make sure the booster battery is 12 V  
and that its negative terminal is  
grounded.  
3. If the booster battery is in another  
vehicle, don't allow both vehicles to  
touch. Turn off the engine of the  
vehicle with the booster battery and all  
unnecessary electrical loads in both  
vehicles.  
4. Connect the jumper cables in the exact  
sequence as in the illustration.  
l
Connect one end of a cable to the  
positive terminal on the discharged  
battery (1).  
Attach the other end to the positive  
l
terminal on the booster battery (2).  
Connect one end of the other cable  
l
to the negative terminal of the  
booster battery (3).  
Connect the other end to the ground  
l
point indicated in the illustration  
away from the discharged battery  
(4).  
5. Start the engine of the booster vehicle  
and run it a few minutes. Then start the  
engine of the other vehicle.  
7-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page287  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (287,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Starting  
Push-Starting  
Do not push-start your Mazda.  
NOTE  
You can't start a vehicle with an automatic  
transaxle by pushing it.  
7-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page288  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (288,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
Towing Description  
CAUTION  
Don't tow the vehicle pointed  
backward with driving wheels on the  
ground. This may cause internal  
damage to the transaxle.  
We recommend that towing be done only  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer or a  
commercial tow-truck service.  
Proper lifting and towing are necessary to  
prevent damage to the vehicle.  
Particularly when towing a AWD vehicle,  
where all the wheels are connected to the  
drive train, proper transporting of the  
vehicle is absolutely essential to avoid  
damaging the drive system. Government  
and local laws must be followed.  
Wheel dollies  
CAUTION  
Don't tow with sling-type equipment.  
This could damage your vehicle. Use  
wheel-lift or flatbed equipment.  
A towed 2WD vehicle should have its  
drive wheels (front wheels) off the  
ground. If excessive damage or other  
conditions prevent this, use wheel dollies.  
When towing a 2WD vehicle with the rear  
wheels on the ground, release the parking  
brake.  
A towed AWD vehicle must have all its  
wheels off the ground.  
7-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page289  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (289,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
Tiedown Hooks  
WARNING  
Always tow a AWD vehicle with all four  
wheels off the ground:  
CAUTION  
Towing a AWD vehicle with either the  
front or rear wheels on the ground is  
dangerous as the drive train could be  
damaged, or the vehicle could trail  
away from the tow truck and cause  
an accident. If the drive train has  
been damaged, transport the vehicle  
on a flat bed truck.  
Don't use the tiedown hooks under  
the front and rear for towing.  
They are designed ONLY for tying  
down the vehicle when it's being  
transported. Using them for towing  
will damage the bumper.  
qTiedown Hooks  
1. Remove the tiedown eyelet, lug  
wrench, and jack lever from the trunk  
(page 7-3).  
2. Wrap the jack lever with a soft cloth to  
prevent damage to the bumper and  
open the cap located on the front and  
rear bumper.  
7-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page290  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (290,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
4. Hook the tying rope to the tiedown  
eyelet.  
CAUTION  
The cap cannot be completely  
removed. Do not use excessive force  
as it may damage the cap or scratch  
the painted bumper surface.  
3. Securely install the tiedown eyelet  
using the lug wrench.  
Lug wrench  
Lug wrench  
CAUTION  
If the tiedown eyelet is not securely  
tightened, it may loosen or disengage  
from the bumper when tying down  
the vehicle. Make sure that the  
tiedown eyelet is securely tightened  
to the bumper.  
7-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page291  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (291,1)  
In Case of an Emergency  
Emergency Towing  
Recreational Towing  
An example of recreational towingis  
towing your vehicle behind a motorhome.  
The transaxle is not designed for towing  
this vehicle on all 4 wheels.  
When doing recreational towing refer to  
Towing Description(page 7-18) and  
Tiedown Hooks(page 7-19) and  
carefully follow the instructions.  
7-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page292  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (292,1)  
7-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page293  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (293,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
8
How to keep your Mazda in top condition.  
8-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page294  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (294,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Introduction  
Introduction  
Be extremely careful and prevent injury to yourself and others or damage to your vehicle  
when using this manual for inspection and maintenance.  
If you're unsure about any procedure it describes, we strongly urge you to have a reliable  
and qualified service shop perform the work, preferably an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Factory-trained Mazda technicians and genuine Mazda parts are best for your vehicle.  
Without this expertise and the parts that have been designed and made especially for your  
Mazda, inadequate, incomplete, and insufficient servicing may result in problems. This  
could lead to vehicle damage or an accident and injuries.  
For expert advice and quality service, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
The owner should retain evidence that proper maintenance has been performed as  
prescribed.  
Claims against the warranty resulting from lack of maintenance, as opposed to defective  
materials or authorized Mazda workmanship, will not be honored.  
Any auto repair shop using parts equivalent to your Mazda's original equipment may  
perform maintenance. But we recommend that it always be done by an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer using genuine Mazda parts.  
8-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page295  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (295,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Scheduled Maintenance (USA, Canada, and Puerto Rico)  
Follow Schedule 1 if the vehicle is operated mainly where none of the following conditions  
apply.  
l
Repeated short-distance driving  
Driving in dusty conditions  
Driving with extended use of brakes  
Driving in areas where salt or other corrosive materials are being used  
Driving on rough or muddy roads  
Extended periods of idling or low-speed operation  
Driving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates  
Driving in extremely hot conditions  
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Driving in mountainous conditions continually  
If any do apply, follow Schedule 2 (Canada and Puerto Rico residents follow Schedule 2).  
NOTE  
After the prescribed period, continue to follow the described maintenance at the recommended  
intervals.  
8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page296  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (296,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 1  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
6
12  
24  
15  
18  
36  
24  
48  
30  
30  
60  
36  
72  
45  
42  
84  
48  
96  
60  
Maintenance Interval  
12  
7.5  
22.5  
37.5  
52.5  
ENGINE  
Audible inspect every 120,000 km (75,000 miles), if noisy,  
adjust  
Engine valve clearance  
Drive belts (tension)  
Engine oil  
I
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Replace at first 192,000 km (120,000 miles) or 10 years ;after  
that, every 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 5 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
Replace at first 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 4 years; after that,  
every 2 years  
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
R
Fuel lines and hoses*2  
Hoses and tubes for emission*2  
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
I
I
I
Replace every 120,000 km (75,000 miles)  
I
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Disc brakes  
I
I
I
I
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 12,000 km (7,500 miles)  
I
Steering operation and linkages  
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
*3*4  
*4  
Rear differential oil (AWD)  
Transfer oil (AWD)  
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
T
T
Inspect every 72,000 km (45,000 miles) or 5 years  
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
8-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page297  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (297,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
6
12  
24  
15  
18  
36  
24  
48  
30  
30  
60  
36  
72  
45  
42  
84  
48  
96  
60  
Maintenance Interval  
12  
7.5  
22.5  
37.5  
52.5  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
Replace every 40,000 km (25,000 miles) or 2 years  
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
L: Lubricate  
T: Tighten  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or mileage/kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at  
every 45,000 km (28,100 miles).  
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier  
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet condition  
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation  
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km (10 miles)  
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.  
8-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page298  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (298,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 2  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
4
8
5
8
12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48  
Maintenance Interval  
16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
ENGINE  
Audible inspect every 120,000 km (75,000 miles), if noisy,  
adjust  
Engine valve clearance  
Drive belts (tension)  
I
Puerto Rico  
Others  
Replace every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) or 3 months  
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Replace at first 192,000 km (120,000 miles) or 10 years ;after  
that, every 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 5 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
Replace at first 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 4 years; after that,  
every 2 years  
Engine coolant level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
FUEL SYSTEM  
Puerto Rico  
Others  
R
R
Air filter  
R
Fuel lines and hoses*2  
Hoses and tubes for emission*2  
I
I
I
IGNITION SYSTEM  
USA  
Others*3  
Replace every 96,000 km (60,000 miles)  
Replace every 120,000 km (75,000 miles)  
Spark plugs  
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM  
Function of all lights  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page299  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (299,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
4
8
5
8
12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48  
Maintenance Interval  
16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Disc brakes  
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 8,000 km (5,000 miles)  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
*4*5  
*5  
Rear differential oil (AWD)  
Transfer oil (AWD)  
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
T
T
Inspect every 72,000 km (45,000 miles) or 5 years  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
8-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page300  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (300,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first  
Months  
×1000 km  
×1000 miles  
4
8
5
8
12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48  
Maintenance Interval  
16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
Replace every 40,000 km (25,000 miles) or 2 years  
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
L: Lubricate  
T: Tighten  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or mileage/kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the spark plugs at every  
96,000 km (60,000 miles) or shorter.  
a) Repeated short-distance driving  
b) Extended periods of idling or low-speed operation  
c) Driving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates  
*4 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at  
every 45,000 km (28,100 miles).  
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier  
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet condition  
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation  
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km (10 miles)  
*5 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.  
8-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page301  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (301,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Scheduled Maintenance (Mexico)  
Follow Schedule 1 if the vehicle is operated mainly where none of the following conditions  
apply.  
l
Repeated short-distance driving  
Driving in dusty conditions  
Driving with extended use of brakes  
Driving in areas where salt or other corrosive materials are being used  
Driving on rough or muddy roads  
Extended periods of idling or low-speed operation  
Driving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates  
Driving in extremely hot conditions  
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
Driving in mountainous conditions continually  
If any do apply, follow Schedule 2.  
NOTE  
After the prescribed period, continue to follow the described maintenance at the recommended  
intervals.  
8-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page302  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (302,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 1  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
6
12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72  
×1000 km  
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120  
ENGINE  
Engine valve clearance  
Drive belts  
Audible inspect every 120,000 km, if noisy, adjust  
I
I
I
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Cooling system  
I
I
I
Replace at first 190,000 km or 10 years; after that, every  
60,000 km or 3 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
R
R
R
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
R
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
R
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
R
R
I
Fuel lines and hoses  
Hoses and tubes for emission  
Fuel filter  
I
R
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
Replace every 60,000 km  
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake fluid  
R
I
R
I
R
I
Disc brakes  
I
I
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 10,000 km  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
I
I
I
I
*3*4  
*4  
Rear differential oil (AWD)  
Transfer oil (AWD)  
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
8-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page303  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (303,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
6
12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72  
×1000 km  
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
R
R
R
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
L: Lubricate  
T: Tighten  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at  
every 40,000 km.  
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier  
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet condition  
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation  
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km  
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.  
8-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page304  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (304,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
qSchedule 2  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
3
5
6
9
12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36  
×1000 km  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
ENGINE  
Engine valve clearance  
Drive belts  
Audible inspect every 120,000 km, if noisy, adjust  
I
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Cooling system  
I
Replace at first 190,000 km or 10 years; after that, every  
60,000 km or 3 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
R
Engine coolant level  
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
C
R
C
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
C
R
Fuel lines and hoses  
Hoses and tubes for emission  
Fuel filter  
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
Replace every 60,000 km  
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM  
Function of all lights  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page305  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (305,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
3
5
6
9
12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36  
×1000 km  
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60  
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake fluid  
R
I
Disc brakes  
I
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 10,000 km  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
I
*3*4  
*4  
Rear differential oil (AWD)  
Transfer oil (AWD)  
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
R
R
R
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
L: Lubricate  
C: Clean  
T: Tighten  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at  
every 40,000 km.  
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier  
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet condition  
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation  
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km  
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.  
8-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page306  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (306,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
(Cont.)  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
ENGINE  
Months  
39 42 45 48 51 54 57 60 63 66 69 72  
65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120  
×1000 km  
Engine valve clearance  
Drive belts  
Audible inspect every 120,000 km, if noisy, adjust  
I
I
Engine oil  
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Engine oil filter  
COOLING SYSTEM  
Cooling system  
I
I
Replace at first 190,000 km or 10 years; after that, every  
60,000 km or 3 years  
FL22 type*1  
Others  
Engine coolant  
R
R
I
Engine coolant level  
FUEL SYSTEM  
Air filter  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
C
R
I*2  
I*2  
R
C
R
C
R
I
Fuel lines and hoses  
Hoses and tubes for emission  
Fuel filter  
I
R
IGNITION SYSTEM  
Spark plugs  
Replace every 60,000 km  
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM  
Function of all lights  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page307  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (307,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first  
Maintenance Interval  
Months  
×1000 km  
39 42 45 48 51 54 57 60 63 66 69 72  
65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120  
CHASSIS and BODY  
Brake lines, hoses and connections  
Brake fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Brake fluid  
R
I
R
I
Disc brakes  
I
Tire (Rotation)  
Rotate every 10,000 km  
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear  
Steering operation and linkages  
Power steering fluid level  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel  
bearing axial play  
I
I
I
*3*4  
*4  
Rear differential oil (AWD)  
Transfer oil (AWD)  
Driveshaft dust boots  
I
T
I
I
T
I
I
T
I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body  
Exhaust system and heat shields  
All locks and hinges  
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
L
I
Washer fluid level  
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM  
Cabin air filter  
R
R
R
Chart symbols:  
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, or replace if necessary.  
R: Replace  
L: Lubricate  
C: Clean  
T: Tighten  
Remarks:  
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding  
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.  
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not  
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at  
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.  
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at  
every 40,000 km.  
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier  
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet condition  
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation  
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km  
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.  
8-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page308  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (308,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Owner Maintenance Schedule  
The owner or a qualified service technician should make these vehicle inspections at the  
indicated intervals to ensure safe and dependable operation.  
Bring any problem to the attention of an Authorized Mazda Dealer or qualified service  
technician as soon as possible.  
qWhen Refueling  
l
Brake fluid level (page 8-23)  
Engine coolant level (page 8-21)  
Engine oil level (page 8-20)  
Washer fluid level (page 8-27)  
l
l
l
qAt Least Monthly  
Tire inflation pressures (page 8-34)  
qAt Least Twice a Year (For Example, Every Spring and Fall)  
l
Automatic transaxle fluid level (page 8-25)  
Power steering fluid level (page 8-24)  
l
You can do the following scheduled maintenance items if you have some mechanical  
ability and a few basic tools and if you closely follow the directions in this manual.  
l
Engine coolant (page 8-21)  
Engine oil (page 8-19)  
l
8-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page309  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (309,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Owner Maintenance Precautions  
Improper or incomplete service may result in problems. This section gives instructions only  
for items that are easy to perform.  
As explained in the Introduction (page 8-2), several procedures can be done only by a  
qualified service technician with special tools.  
Improper owner maintenance during the warranty period may affect warranty coverage.  
For details, read the separate Mazda Warranty statement provided with the vehicle. If  
you're unsure about any servicing or maintenance procedure, have it done by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
There are strict environmental laws regarding the disposal of waste oil and fluids. Please  
dispose of your waste properly and with due regard to the environment.  
We recommend that you entrust the oil and fluid changes of your vehicle to an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
WARNING  
Do not perform maintenance work if you lack sufficient knowledge and experience or  
the proper tools and equipment to do the work. Have maintenance work done by a  
qualified technician:  
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle is dangerous if not done properly. You  
can be seriously injured while performing some maintenance procedures.  
If you must run the engine while working under the hood, make certain that you  
remove all jewelry (especially rings, bracelets, watches, and necklaces) and all  
neckties, scarves, and similar loose clothing before getting near the engine or cooling  
fan which may turn on unexpectedly:  
Working under the hood with the engine running is dangerous. It becomes even  
more dangerous when you wear jewelry or loose clothing.  
Either can become entangled in moving parts and result in injury.  
Turn off the ignition switch and make sure the fan is not running before attempting  
to work near the cooling fan:  
Working near the cooling fan when it is running is dangerous. The fan could  
continue running indefinitely even if the engine has stopped and the engine  
compartment temperature is high. You could be hit by the fan and seriously injured.  
8-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page310  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (310,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Engine Compartment Overview  
Automatic transaxle fluid-level dipstick  
Engine oil-filler cap  
Windshield washer  
fluid reservoir  
Brake fluid reservoir  
Power steering  
fluid reservoir  
Fuse block  
Battery  
Cooling system cap  
Engine oil dipstick  
Engine coolant reservoir  
8-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page311  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (311,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Only use oils Certified For Gasoline  
Enginesby the American Petroleum  
Institute (API). An oil with this trademark  
symbol conforms to the current engine  
and emission system protection standards  
and fuel economy requirements of the  
International Lubricant Standardization  
and Approval Committee (ILSAC),  
comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
Engine Oil  
NOTE  
Changing the engine oil should be done by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qRecommended Oil  
Use SAE 5W-30 engine oil.  
Oil container labels provide important  
information.  
automobile manufacturers.  
A chief contribution this type of oil makes  
to fuel economy is reducing the amount of  
fuel necessary to overcome engine  
friction.  
–30 –20 –10  
0
10 20 30 40 50  
U.S.A. and CANADA  
–20  
0
20 40 60 80 100 120  
5W-30  
Except U.S.A. and CANADA  
(ILSAC)  
(ILSAC)  
8-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page312  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (312,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
The quality designation SM, or ILSAC  
must be on the label.  
5. Pull out the dipstick, wipe it clean, and  
reinsert it fully.  
–30 –20 –10  
0
10 20 30 40 50  
–20  
0
20 40 60 80 100 120  
Max  
OK  
5W-30  
Min  
6. Pull it out again and examine the level.  
It's OK between MIN and MAX.  
qInspecting Engine Oil Level  
But if it's near or below MIN, add  
enough oil to bring the level to MAX.  
1. Be sure the vehicle is on a level  
surface.  
2. Warm up the engine to normal  
operating temperature.  
CAUTION  
Don't add engine oil over MAX. This  
may cause engine damage.  
3. Turn it off and wait at least 5 minutes  
for the oil to return to the oil pan.  
7. Make sure the O-ring on the dipstick is  
positioned properly before reinserting  
the dipstick.  
4. Open the cap.  
8. Close the cap.  
8-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page313  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (313,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
Engine Coolant  
When closing the engine oil cap, place the cap  
with the ( ) mark aligned at the OPEN (  
position and then turn the cap to the CLOSE  
)
qInspecting Coolant Level  
(
) position.  
WARNING  
Do not use a match or live flame in the  
engine compartment. DO NOT ADD  
COOLANT WHEN THE ENGINE IS HOT:  
A hot engine is dangerous. If the  
engine has been running, parts of the  
engine compartment can become  
very hot. You could be burned.  
Carefully inspect the engine coolant  
in the coolant reservoir, but do not  
open it.  
Turn off the ignition switch and  
make sure the fan is not running before  
attempting to work near the cooling  
fan:  
Working near the cooling fan when it  
is running is dangerous. The fan  
could continue running indefinitely  
even if the engine has stopped and  
the engine compartment temperature  
is high. You could be hit by the fan  
and seriously injured.  
Do not remove either cooling  
system cap when the engine and  
radiator are hot:  
When the engine and radiator are  
hot, scalding coolant and steam may  
shoot out under pressure and cause  
serious injury.  
NOTE  
Changing the coolant should be done by an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
8-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page314  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (314,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Inspect the antifreeze protection and  
coolant level in the coolant reservoir at  
least once a yearat the beginning of the  
winter seasonand before traveling  
where temperatures may drop below  
freezing.  
CAUTION  
Ø Radiator coolant will damage  
paint.  
Rinse it off quickly if spilled.  
Ø Use only soft (demineralized)  
water in the coolant mixture.  
Water that contains minerals will  
cut down on the coolant's  
effectiveness.  
Ø Don't add only water. Always add  
a proper coolant mixture.  
Ø The engine has aluminum parts  
and must be protected by an  
ethylene-glycol-based coolant to  
prevent corrosion and freezing.  
Ø DO NOT USE coolants Containing  
Alcohol, methanol, Borate or  
Silicate.  
Inspect the condition and connections of  
all cooling system and heater hoses.  
Replace any that are swollen or  
deteriorated.  
The coolant should be at full in the  
radiator and between the FULL and LOW  
marks on the coolant reservoir when the  
engine is cool.  
These coolants could damage the  
cooling system.  
Ø DO NOT MIX alcohol or methanol  
with the coolant. This could  
damage the cooling system.  
Ø Don't use a solution that contains  
more than 60% antifreeze.  
This would reduce effectiveness.  
If it's at or near LOW, add enough coolant  
to the coolant reservoir to provide  
freezing and corrosion protection and to  
bring the level to FULL.  
8-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page315  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (315,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
Brake Fluid  
If the FL22mark is shown on or near the  
cooling system cap, use FL22 type engine  
coolant. If engine coolant other than FL22  
type is used, the engine coolant must be  
replaced earlier than the specified replacement  
interval indicated in the scheduled  
maintenance (page 8-3).  
qInspecting Brake Fluid Level  
Inspect the fluid level in the reservoir  
regularly. It should be kept at MAX.  
The level normally drops with  
accumulated distance, a condition  
associated with wear of brake linings. If it  
is excessively low, have the brake system  
inspected by an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
If the coolant reservoir is empty or new  
coolant is required frequently, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
8-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page316  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (316,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
qAdding Brake Fluid  
Power Steering Fluid  
WARNING  
Be careful not to spill brake fluid on  
yourself or on the engine:  
qInspecting Power Steering Fluid  
Level  
Spilled brake fluid is dangerous. If it  
gets in your eyes, they could be  
seriously injured. If this happens,  
immediately flush your eyes with  
water and get medical attention.  
Brake fluid spilled on a hot engine  
could cause a fire.  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to the power  
steering pump, don't operate the  
vehicle for long periods when the  
power steering fluid level is low.  
NOTE  
Use specified power steering fluid (page 10-4).  
If the brake/clutch fluid level is low,  
have the brakes and clutch inspected:  
Low brake fluid levels are dangerous.  
Low levels could signal brake lining  
wear or a brake system leak. Your  
brakes could fail and cause an  
accident.  
Inspect the fluid level at each engine oil  
change. Add fluid if necessary; it does not  
require periodic changing.  
If the fluid level is low, add fluid until it  
reaches MAX.  
Before adding fluid, thoroughly clean the  
area around the cap.  
CAUTION  
Ø Brake fluid will damage painted  
surfaces. If brake fluid does get on  
a painted surface, wash it off with  
water immediately.  
Ø Using nonspecified brake fluids  
(page 10-4) will damage the  
system. Mixing different fluids will  
also damage it.  
The level must be kept between the MAX  
and MIN marks.  
Visually examine the lines and hoses for  
leaks and damage.  
1. Park on a level surface, well off the  
right-of-way, and set the parking brake  
firmly.  
If the brake system frequently  
requires new fluid, consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
2. Turn off the engine and allow it to  
cool.  
3. Remove the filler cap and attached  
dipstick.  
4. Wipe them clean and put them back.  
8-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page317  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (317,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
5. Remove again and inspect the level.  
Automatic Transaxle Fluid  
(ATF)  
6. It must be between MAX and MIN.  
Add fluid if necessary.  
qInspecting Automatic Transaxle  
Don't overfill.  
If new fluid is required frequently, consult  
Fluid Level  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
The automatic transaxle fluid level should  
be inspected regularly. Measure it as  
described below.  
The volume of fluid changes with  
temperature. Fluid must be checked while  
idling the engine without driving at  
normal operating temperature.  
CAUTION  
Ø Low fluid level causes transaxle  
slippage. Overfilling can cause  
foaming, loss of fluid, and  
transaxle malfunction.  
Ø Use specified fluid (page 10-4). A  
nonspecified fluid could result in  
transaxle malfunction and failure.  
1. Park on a level surface and set the  
parking brake firmly.  
2. Start the engine and depress the brake  
pedal.  
3. Move the shift lever through all ranges,  
then set it at P.  
WARNING  
Make sure the brake pedal is applied  
before shifting the shift lever:  
Shifting the shift lever without first  
depressing the brake pedal is  
dangerous. The vehicle could move  
suddenly and cause an accident.  
4. With the engine still idling, pull out the  
dipstick, wipe it clean, and put it back.  
8-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page318  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (318,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
5. Pull it out again.  
Fully insert the dipstick. When adding  
fluid, inspect with the dipstick to make  
sure it doesn't pass full.  
The proper fluid level is marked on the  
dipstick as follows.  
NOTE  
Inspect the fluid on both sides of the dipstick in  
a well lit area for an accurate reading.  
Full  
A
Low  
Full  
B
Low  
Fluid hot scale A  
When the vehicle has been driven and the  
fluid is at normal operating temperature,  
about 65°C (150°F), the level must be  
between Full and Low.  
Fluid cold scale B  
When the engine has not been running  
and the outside temperature is about 20°C  
(70°F), the fluid level should be close to,  
but not above, the bottom notch on the  
dipstick.  
CAUTION  
Ø Use the cold scale only as a  
reference.  
Ø If outside temperature is lower  
than about 20°C (70°F), start the  
engine and inspect the fluid level  
after the engine reaches operating  
temperature.  
Ø If the vehicle has been driven for  
an extended period at high speeds  
or in city traffic in hot weather,  
inspect the level only after  
stopping the engine and allowing  
the fluid to cool for 30 minutes.  
8-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page319  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (319,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Inspect fluid level in the washer fluid  
reservoir; add fluid if necessary.  
Washer Fluid  
qInspecting Washer Fluid Level  
WARNING  
Use only windshield washer fluid or  
plain water in the reservoir:  
Using radiator antifreeze as washer  
fluid is dangerous. If sprayed on the  
windshield, it will dirty the  
windshield, affect your visibility, and  
could result in an accident.  
Using Washer Fluid Without Anti-freeze  
Protection in Cold Weather:  
Use plain water if washer fluid is  
unavailable.  
Operating your vehicle in  
temperatures below 4 degrees C (40  
degrees F) using washer fluid without  
anti-freeze protection is dangerous  
as it could cause impaired windshield  
vision and result in an accident. In  
cold weather, always use washer  
fluid with anti-freeze protection.  
But use only washer fluid in cold weather  
to prevent it from freezing.  
NOTE  
Front and rear washer fluid is supplied from  
the same reservoir.  
NOTE  
State or local regulations may restrict the use  
of volatile organic compounds (VOCs), which  
are commonly used as anti-freeze agents in  
washer fluid. A washer fluid with limited VOC  
content should be used only if it provides  
adequate freeze resistance for all regions and  
climates in which the vehicle will be operated.  
8-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page320  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (320,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Body Lubrication  
Wiper Blades  
CAUTION  
Ø Hot waxes applied by automatic  
car washers have been known to  
affect the wiper's ability to clean  
windows.  
All moving points of the body, such as  
door and hood hinges and locks, should  
be lubricated each time the engine oil is  
changed. Use a nonfreezing lubricant on  
locks during cold weather.  
Ø To prevent damage to the wiper  
blades, don't use gasoline,  
kerosene, paint thinner, or other  
solvents on or near them.  
Make sure the hood's secondary latch  
keeps the hood from opening when the  
primary latch is released.  
Contamination of either the windshield or  
the blades with foreign matter can reduce  
wiper effectiveness. Common sources are  
insects, tree sap, and hot wax treatments  
used by some commercial car washes.  
If the blades are not wiping properly,  
clean the window and blades with a good  
cleaner or mild detergent; then rinse  
thoroughly with clean water. Repeat if  
necessary.  
q
Replacing Windshield Wiper Blades  
When the wipers no longer clean well, the  
blades are probably worn or cracked.  
Replace them.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the wiper arms  
and other components, don't try to  
sweep the wiper arm by hand.  
NOTE  
To prevent damage to the wiper arm blades  
when raising both the driver and passenger  
side wiper arms, raise the driver side wiper  
arm first. Conversely, when setting down the  
wiper arms, set the passenger side wiper arm  
down first.  
1. Raise the wiper arm.  
8-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page321  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (321,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
2. Open the clip and slide the blade  
assembly in the direction of the arrow.  
4. Pull down the blade rubber and slide it  
out of blade holder.  
3. Tilt the blade assembly and remove it  
from the arm.  
5. Remove the metal stiffeners from each  
blade rubber and install them in the  
new blade.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the windshield  
let the wiper arm down easily, don't  
let it slap down on the windshield.  
8-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page322  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (322,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
1. Remove the cover and raise the wiper  
arm.  
CAUTION  
Ø Don't bend or discard the  
stiffeners. You need to use them  
again.  
Ø If the metal stiffeners are  
switched, the blade's wiping  
efficiency could be reduced.  
So don't use the driver's side metal  
stiffeners on the passenger's side,  
or vice versa.  
Ø Be sure to reinstall the metal  
stiffeners in the new blade rubber  
so that the curve is the same as it  
was in the old blade rubber.  
2. Firmly rotate the wiper blade to the  
right until it unlocks, then remove the  
blade.  
6. Carefully insert the new blade rubber.  
Then install the blade assembly in the  
reverse order of removal.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the rear  
window let the wiper arm down  
easily, don't let it slap down on the  
rear window.  
qReplacing Rear Window Wiper  
Blade  
When the wiper no longer cleans well, the  
blade is probably worn or cracked.  
Replace it.  
CAUTION  
To prevent damage to the wiper arm  
and other components, don't try to  
sweep the wiper arm by hand.  
8-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page323  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (323,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
3. Pull down the blade rubber and slide it  
out of the blade holder.  
5. Carefully insert the new blade rubber.  
Then install the blade assembly in the  
reverse order of removal.  
4. Remove the metal stiffeners from each  
blade rubber and install them in the  
new blade.  
CAUTION  
Don't bend or discard the stiffeners.  
You need to use them again.  
8-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page324  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (324,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Battery  
WARNING  
Wash hands after handling the battery and related accessories:  
Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds,  
chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and reproductive harm.  
Read the following precautions carefully before using the battery or inspecting  
to ensure safe and correct handling:  
Always wear eye protection when working near the battery:  
Working without eye protection is dangerous. Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID  
which could cause blindness if splashed into your eyes. Also, hydrogen gas produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode.  
Wear eye protection and protective gloves to prevent contact with battery  
fluid:  
Spilled battery fluid is dangerous.  
Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID which could cause serious injuries if it gets in  
eyes, or on the skin or clothing. If this happens, immediately flush your eyes with  
water for 15 minutes or wash your skin thoroughly and get medical attention.  
Always keep batteries out of the reach of children:  
Allowing children to play near batteries is dangerous. Battery fluid could cause  
serious injuries if it gets in the eyes or on the skin.  
Keep flames and sparks away from open battery cells and do not allow metal  
tools to contact the positive ( ) or negative ( ) terminal of the battery when  
working near a battery. Do not allow the positive ( ) terminal to contact the vehicle  
body:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries. Keep all flames including  
cigarettes and sparks away from open battery cells.  
8-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page325  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (325,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Keep all flames, including cigarettes, and sparks away from open battery cells:  
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced  
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An  
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries.  
8-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page326  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (326,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
Tires  
Remove the battery cover before performing  
battery maintenance.  
For reasons of proper performance, safety,  
and better fuel economy, always maintain  
recommended tire inflation pressures and  
stay within the recommended load limits  
and weight distribution.  
WARNING  
Using Different Tire Types:  
Driving your vehicle with different  
types of tires is dangerous. It could  
cause poor handling and poor  
braking; leading to loss of control.  
Except for the limited use of the  
temporary spare tire, use only the  
same type tires (radial, bias-belted,  
bias-type) on all four wheels.  
qBattery Maintenance  
Using Wrong-Sized Tires:  
Using any other tire size than what is  
specified for your Mazda (page 10-6)  
is dangerous. It could seriously affect  
ride, handling, ground clearance, tire  
clearance, and speedometer  
calibration. This could cause you to  
have an accident. Use only tires that  
are the correct size specified for your  
Mazda.  
To get the best service from a battery:  
qTire Inflation Pressure  
l
Keep it securely mounted.  
Keep the top clean and dry.  
l
WARNING  
l
Keep terminals and connections clean,  
Always inflate the tires to the correct  
pressure:  
tight, and coated with petroleum jelly  
or terminal grease.  
Rinse off spilled electrolyte  
immediately with a solution of water  
and baking soda.  
If the vehicle will not be used for an  
l
Overinflation or underinflation of  
tires is dangerous. Adverse handling  
or unexpected tire failure could result  
in a serious accident.  
l
Refer to specification charts on page  
extended time, disconnect the battery  
cables.  
8-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page327  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (327,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring Systemí  
does not alleviate the need to check the  
tire condition every day, including  
whether the tires all look inflated properly.  
Inspect all tire pressure monthly  
(including the spare) when the tires are  
cold. Maintain recommended pressures  
for the best ride, handling, and minimum  
tire wear.  
NOTE  
l
Always check tire pressure when tires are  
cold.  
l
l
Warm tires normally exceed recommended  
pressures. Don't release air from warm tires  
to adjust the pressure.  
Underinflation can cause reduced fuel  
economy, uneven and accelerated tire wear,  
and poor sealing of the tire bead, which  
will deform the wheel and cause separation  
of tire from rim.  
When checking the tire pressures, use of a  
digital tire pressure gauge is  
recommended.  
l
Overinflation can produce a harsh ride,  
uneven and accelerated tire wear, and a  
greater possibility of damage from road  
hazards.  
Except Canada (Tire pressure label)  
Keep your tire pressure at the correct  
levels. If one frequently needs inflating,  
have it inspected.  
qTire Rotation  
To equalize tread wear, rotate the tires if  
irregular wear develops. According to the  
scheduled maintenance charts.Refer to  
Scheduled Maintenance on page 8-3.  
During rotation, inspect them for correct  
balance.  
Canada (Motor vehicle safety standard  
label)  
Forward  
Do not include (TEMPORARY USE ONLY)  
spare tire in rotation.  
Refer to the specification charts (page  
Also, inspect them for uneven wear and  
damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused  
by one or a combination of the following:  
l
Incorrect tire pressure  
íSome models.  
8-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page328  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (328,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
l
Improper wheel alignment  
Out-of-balance wheel  
Severe braking  
CAUTION  
l
l
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System)  
When replacing/repairing the tires or  
wheels or both, have the work done  
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer, or  
the tire pressure sensors may be  
damaged.  
After rotation, inflate all tire pressures to  
specification (page 10-6) and inspect the  
lug nuts for tightness.  
CAUTION  
Rotate unidirectional tires and radial  
tires that have an asymmetrical tread  
pattern or studs only from front to  
rear, not from side to side. Tire  
performance will be weakened if  
rotated from side to side.  
NOTE  
(With Tire Pressure Monitoring System)  
l
When tires with steel wire reinforcement in  
the sidewalls are used, the system may not  
function correctly even with a genuine  
wheel.  
Refer to System Error Activation on page  
Be sure to install the tire pressure sensors  
whenever tires or wheels are replaced.  
Refer to Tires and Wheels on page 5-31.  
CAUTION  
Limited-Slip Differential system;  
don't use the following:  
Ø Tires not of the designated size  
Ø Tires of different sizes or types at  
the same time  
l
If a tire wears evenly, a wear indicator  
will appear as a solid band across the  
tread.  
Ø Tires not sufficiently inflated  
If these instructions aren't followed,  
the rotation of the left and right  
wheels will be different and will thus  
apply a constant load on the limited-  
slip differential.  
Replace the tire when this happens.  
Tread wear indicator  
This will cause a malfunction.  
qReplacing a Tire  
WARNING  
Always use tires that are in good  
condition:  
New tread  
Worn tread  
Driving with worn tires is dangerous.  
Reduced braking, steering, and  
traction could result in an accident.  
You should replace it before the band is  
across the entire tread.  
8-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page329  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (329,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
CAUTION  
Tires degrade over time, even when they are  
not being used on the road. It is recommended  
that tires generally be replaced when they are  
6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates  
or frequent high loading conditions can  
accelerate the aging process. You should  
replace the spare tire when you replace the  
other road tires due to the aging of the spare  
tire. Regarding the manufacturing week and  
year is indicated with 4 digit.  
Ø Do not use your temporary spare  
tire rim with a snow tire or a  
conventional tire. Neither will  
properly fit and could damage  
both tire and rim.  
Ø The temporary spare tire has a  
tread life of less than 5,000 km  
(3,000 miles). The tread life may  
be shorter depending on driving  
conditions.  
Refer to The tire labeling on page 9-23.  
Ø The temporary spare tire is for  
limited use, however, if the tread  
wear solid-band indicator  
appears, replace the tire with the  
same type of temporary spare  
(page 8-36).  
qTemporary Spare Tire  
Inspect the temporary spare tire at least  
monthly to make sure it's properly inflated  
and stored.  
NOTE  
NOTE  
The temporary spare tire condition gradually  
Tires degrade over time, even when they are  
not being used on the road. It is recommended  
that tires generally be replaced when they are  
6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates  
or frequent high loading conditions can  
accelerate the aging process. You should  
replace the spare tire when you replace the  
other road tires due to the aging of the spare  
tire. Regarding the manufacturing week and  
year is indicated with 4 digit.  
deteriorates even if it has not been used.  
The temporary spare tire is easier to  
handle because of its construction which  
is lighter and smaller than a conventional  
tire. This tire should be used only for an  
emergency and only for a short distance.  
Use the temporary spare tire only until the  
conventional tire is repaired, which should  
be as soon as possible.  
Refer to The tire labeling on page 9-23.  
qReplacing a Wheel  
(Except Mexico)  
Maintain its pressure at 420 kPa (4.2 bar,  
WARNING  
Always use wheels of the correct size  
on your vehicle:  
60 psi).  
(Mexico)  
Maintain its pressure at 250 kPa (2.5 bar,  
36 psi).  
Using a wrong-sized wheel is  
dangerous. Braking and handling  
could be affected, leading to loss of  
control and an accident.  
8-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page330  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (330,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
CAUTION  
Ø A wrong-sized wheel may  
adversely affect:  
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Ø
Tire fit  
Wheel and bearing life  
Ground clearance  
Snow-chain clearance  
Speedometer calibration  
Headlight aim  
Bumper height  
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System  
Ø
Limited-Slip Differential System  
Ø (With Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System)  
Ø
When replacing/repairing the  
tires or wheels or both, have the  
work done by an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer, or the tire  
pressure sensors may be  
damaged.  
Ø
The wheels equipped on your  
Mazda are specially designed  
for installation of the tire  
pressure sensors. Do not use  
non-genuine wheels, otherwise  
it may not be possible to install  
the tire pressure sensors.  
NOTE  
Be sure to install the tire pressure sensors  
whenever tires or wheels are replaced. Refer to  
Tires and Wheels on page 5-31.  
When replacing a wheel, make sure the  
new one is the same as the original factory  
wheel in diameter, rim width, and offset.  
Proper tire balancing provides the best  
riding comfort and helps reduce tread  
wear. Out-of-balance tires can cause  
vibration and uneven wear, such as  
cupping and flat spots.  
8-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page331  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (331,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Light Bulbs  
Overhead light (Rear)  
Overhead light/Map lights (Front)  
Luggage compartment light  
Front side marker lights  
Fog lights  
Front turn signal lights/Parking lights  
Headlights (Low beam)  
Headlights (High beam)  
High-mount brake light  
License plate lights  
Rear turn signal lights  
Rear side marker lights  
Brake lights/Taillights  
Reverse lights  
Some models.  
8-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page332  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (332,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
3. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
Carefully remove the High-beam bulb  
from its socket in the reflector by  
gently pulling it straight backward out  
of the socket.  
WARNING  
Do not replace the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself:  
Replacing the xenon fusion bulbs  
yourself is dangerous. Because the  
xenon fusion bulbs require high  
voltage, you could receive an electric  
shock if the bulbs are handled  
incorrectly. Consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer when the replacement  
is necessary.  
4. Disconnect the bulb from the electrical  
connector by pressing the tab on the  
connector with your finger and pulling  
the bulb upward.  
Never touch the glass portion of a  
halogen bulb with your bare hands and  
always wear eye protection when  
handling or working around the bulbs:  
When a halogen bulb breaks, it is  
dangerous. These bulbs contain  
pressurized gas. If one is broken, it  
will explode and serious injuries  
could be caused by the flying glass.  
If the glass portion is touched with  
bare hands, body oil could cause the  
bulb to overheat and explode when  
lit.  
5. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
NOTE  
Always keep halogen bulbs out of the  
reach of children:  
l
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
Playing with a halogen bulb is  
dangerous. Serious injuries could be  
caused by dropping a halogen bulb  
or breaking it some other way.  
l
If the halogen bulb is accidentally touched,  
it should be cleaned with rubbing alcohol  
before being used.  
l
Use the protective cover and carton of the  
replacement bulb to dispose of the old bulb  
promptly out of the reach of children.  
qReplacing Exterior Light Bulbs  
Replacing a headlight bulb  
High-beam bulb  
Low-beam bulb  
(Xenon fusion bulb)  
You cannot replace the low beam bulbs by  
yourself.  
The bulbs must be replaced at an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
(Halogen bulbs)  
1. Make sure the ignition switch is turned  
off and the headlight switch is off.  
2. Lift the hood.  
1. Make sure the headlight switch is off.  
8-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page333  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:19 PM  
Black plate (333,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
2. If you are changing the right Low-  
beam bulb, start the engine, turn the  
steering wheel all the way to the right,  
and turn off engine. If you are  
7. Swing the retaining spring out and  
away to free the bulb.  
changing the left Low-beam bulb, turn  
the steering wheel to the left.  
3. Turn the screws and the center section  
of the plastic retainers  
counterclockwise and remove them,  
then partially peel back the mudguard.  
Sealing  
cover  
Removal  
8. Carefully remove the bulb from the  
socket by pulling it straight back.  
Installation  
4. Detach the electrical connector from  
the bulb by pulling it to the rear.  
9. Replace the bulb.  
10. Install the new bulb in the reverse  
order of removal.  
NOTE  
l
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
l
If the halogen bulb is accidentally touched,  
it should be cleaned with rubbing alcohol  
before being used.  
5. Pull off the sealing cover.  
l
6. Unhook the bulb retaining spring.  
Use the protective cover and carton for the  
replacement bulb to dispose of the old bulb  
promptly and out of the reach of children.  
8-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page334  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (334,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
Front side marker lights, Front turn  
signal lights/Parking lights  
Front turn signal lights/Parking lights  
1. Make sure the headlight switch is off.  
2. If you are changing a bulb in the right  
headlight unit, start the engine, turn the  
steering wheel all the way to the right,  
and turn off engine. If you are  
changing a bulb in the left headlight  
unit, turn the steering wheel to the left.  
3. Turn the screws and the center section  
of the plastic retainers  
counterclockwise and remove them,  
then partially peel back the mudguard.  
6. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
Fog lightsí  
Removal  
1. Make sure the headlight switch is off.  
2. If you are changing the right fog light  
bulb, start the engine, turn the steering  
wheel all the way to the right, and turn  
off engine. If you are changing the left  
fog light bulb, turn the steering wheel  
to the left.  
Installation  
3. Turn the screws and the center section  
of the plastic retainers  
4. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
counterclockwise and remove them,  
then partially peel back the mudguard.  
5. Disconnect the bulb from the socket.  
Removal  
Front side marker lights  
Installation  
8-42  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page335  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (335,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
4. Disconnect the electrical connector  
from the bulb by pressing the tab on  
the connector with your finger and  
pulling the connector downward.  
Brake lights/Taillights, Rear turn signal  
lights, Reverse lights, Rear side-marker  
lights  
1. Remove the cover.  
5. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
Carefully remove the bulb from its  
socket in the reflector by gently pulling  
it straight backward out of the socket.  
2. Turn the socket and bulb assembly  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
3. Disconnect the bulb from the socket.  
6. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
NOTE  
l
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
l
If the halogen bulb is accidentally touched,  
it should be cleaned with rubbing alcohol  
before being used.  
Rear side-maker light  
Brake light/Taillight  
l
Use the protective cover and carton for the  
replacement bulb to dispose of the old bulb  
promptly and out of the reach of children.  
Rear direction indication light  
Reverse light  
4. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
NOTE  
To replace the bulb, contact an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
High-mount brake light  
Due to the complexity and difficulty of  
the procedure, the LED bulbs should be  
replaced by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
8-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page336  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (336,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
NOTE  
2. Disconnect the bulb by pulling it out.  
LED bulb replacement is not possible. The  
rear combination component must be replaced.  
License plate lights  
1. Wrap a flathead screwdriver with a soft  
cloth to prevent damage to the lens and  
remove the lens by carefully prying on  
the edge of the lens with a flathead  
screwdriver.  
2. Disconnect the bulb by pulling it out.  
3. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
3. Install the new bulb in the reverse order  
of removal.  
qReplacing Interior Light Bulbs  
Overhead light/Map lights (Front)  
Due to the complexity and difficulty of  
the procedure, the bulbs should be  
replaced by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Overhead light (Rear), Luggage  
compartment light  
1. Wrap a small flathead screwdriver with  
a soft cloth to prevent damage to the  
lens and remove the lens by carefully  
prying on the edge of the lens with the  
flathead screwdriver.  
8-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page337  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (337,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
3. Pull the fuse straight out with the fuse  
puller provided on the inside of the  
cover for the fuse panel and the fuse  
block cover inside of the engine  
compartment.  
Fuses  
Your vehicle's electrical system is  
protected by fuses.  
If any lights, accessories, or controls don't  
work, inspect the appropriate circuit  
protector. If a fuse has blown, the inside  
element will be melted.  
If the same fuse blows again, avoid using  
that system and consult an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.  
qFuse Replacement  
Replacing the fuses on the driver's side  
If the electrical system does not work,  
first inspect the fuses on the driver's side.  
4. Inspect the fuse and replace it if it's  
blown.  
1. Turn off the ignition switch and other  
switches.  
2. Open the fuse panel cover.  
Blown  
Normal  
5. Insert a new fuse of the same amperage  
rating, and make sure it fits tightly. If it  
does not fit tightly, have an expert  
install it. We recommend an  
Fuse panel cover  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
If you have no spare fuses, borrow one  
of the same rating from a circuit not  
essential to vehicle operation, such as  
the ROOM circuit.  
8-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page338  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (338,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
4. If any fuse but the MAIN fuse is  
blown, replace it with a new one of the  
same amperage rating.  
CAUTION  
Always replace a fuse with one of the  
same rating. Otherwise you may  
damage the electric system.  
Replacing the fuses under the hood  
If the headlights or other electrical  
components do not work and the fuses in  
the cabin are normal, inspect the fuse  
block under the hood. If a fuse is blown, it  
must be replaced. Follow these steps:  
Normal  
Blown  
1. Turn off the ignition switch and all  
other switches.  
2. Remove the fuse block cover.  
WARNING  
Do not replace the main fuse by  
yourself. Have an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer perform the replacement:  
Replacing the fuse by yourself is  
dangerous because the MAIN fuse is  
a high current fuse. Incorrect  
replacement could cause an electrical  
shock or a short circuit resulting in a  
fire.  
3. Pull the fuse straight out with the fuse  
puller provided on the inside of the  
engine compartment fuse block cover.  
8-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page339  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (339,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
qFuse Panel Description  
Fuse block (Engine compartment)  
DESCRIPTION  
IGN 2  
FUSE RATING  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
1
2
40A  
40A  
60A  
40A  
40A  
40A  
40A  
30A  
20A  
30A  
30A  
20A  
30A  
30A  
40A  
20A  
7.5A  
20A  
Ignition system  
BLOWER  
BTN  
Blower motor  
3
For protection of various circuits  
Cooling fan  
4
FAN 2  
5
IGN 1  
Ignition system  
6
FAN 1  
Cooling fan  
í
7
P.SEAT  
INJ  
Power seat  
8
Injector  
í
9
ROOF  
Moonroof  
í
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
BOSE  
Bose audio system  
ENGINE  
D.LOCK  
P.WIND  
FUEL  
Engine control system  
Power door locks  
Power windows  
Fuel pump  
ABS  
ABS 1  
ABS 2  
DSC  
ABS  
DSC  
í
FOG  
Fog lights  
íSome models.  
8-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page340  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (340,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
DESCRIPTION  
FUSE RATING  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
19  
20  
DEF  
30A  
Rear window defroster  
Parking lights, License plate lights,  
Illuminated entry system  
í
TNS  
15A  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
A/C  
ETC  
10A  
20A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
7.5A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
10A  
20A  
25A  
10A  
Air conditioner  
Accelerator position sensor  
í
H/L HI  
Headlight leveling  
í
DRL  
DRL  
H/L LO RH  
H/L LO LH  
ENG BAR 2  
ECM  
Headlight low beam (RH)  
Headlight low beam (LH)  
PCM  
Engine control system  
Air flow sensor, EGR control valve  
Power windows  
ENG BAR 1  
P.WIND 2  
STOP  
Brake lights  
HORN  
Horn  
ENG B+  
HAZARD  
PCM  
Hazard warning flashers, Turn signals  
Fuse block (Driver's side)  
DESCRIPTION  
FUSE RATING  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
1
OUTLET 1  
15A  
Accessory Socket  
8-48  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page341  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (341,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Owner Maintenance  
DESCRIPTION  
FUSE RATING  
15A  
PROTECTED COMPONENT  
2
3
OUTLET 2  
P.MIR  
Accessory Socket  
7.5A  
30A  
Power control mirror  
4
WIPER  
M.DEF  
ENG BAR 3  
P.WIND  
A/B  
Windshield wiper and washer  
í
5
7.5A  
7.5A  
15A  
Mirror defroster  
6
Air flow sensor, EGR control valve  
Power windows  
7
8
7.5A  
15A  
Advance Restraint System  
Engine control system  
9
ENGINE  
METER  
ROOM  
ILLUMI  
SEAT  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
10A  
Instrument cluster  
15A  
Audio system, Overhead light  
Dashboard illumination  
í
10A  
20A  
Seat warmer  
í
A/C  
10A  
Air conditioner  
R.WIP  
10A  
Rear window wiper and washer  
íSome models.  
8-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page342  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (342,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
qDamage Caused by Bird  
How to Minimize  
Environmental Paint Damage  
Dropping, Insects, or Tree Sap  
Occurrence  
The paintwork on your Mazda represents  
the latest technical developments in  
composition and methods of application.  
Bird droppings contain acids. If these  
aren't removed they can eat away the clear  
and color base coat of the vehicle's  
paintwork.  
Environmental hazards, however, can  
harm the paint's protective properties, if  
proper care is not taken.  
When insects stick to the paint surface  
and decompose, corrosive compounds  
form. These can erode the clear and color  
base coat of the vehicle's paintwork if  
they are not removed.  
Here are some examples of possible  
damage, with tips on how to prevent  
them.  
Tree sap will harden and adhere  
qEtching Caused by Acid Rain or  
permanently to the paint finish. If you  
scratch the sap off while it is hard, some  
vehicle paint could come off with it.  
Industrial Fallout  
Occurrence  
Prevention  
Industrial pollutants and vehicle emissions  
drift into the air and mix with rain or dew  
to form acids. These acids can settle on a  
vehicle's finish. As the water evaporates,  
the acid becomes concentrated and can  
damage the finish.  
It is necessary to have your Mazda  
washed and waxed to preserve its finish  
according to the instructions in this  
section. This should be done as soon as  
possible.  
And the longer the acid remains on the  
surface, the greater the chance is for  
damage.  
Bird droppings can be removed with a  
soft sponge and water. If you are traveling  
and these are not available, a moistened  
tissue may also take care of the problem.  
The cleaned area should be waxed  
according to the instructions in this  
section.  
Insects and tree sap are best removed with  
a soft sponge and water or a commercially  
available chemical cleaner.  
Prevention  
It is necessary to wash and wax your  
vehicle to preserve its finish according to  
the instructions in this section. These  
steps should be taken immediately after  
you suspect that acid rain has settled on  
your vehicle's finish.  
Another method is to cover the affected  
area with dampened newspaper for one to  
two hours. After removing the newspaper,  
rinse off the loosened debris with water.  
8-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page343  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (343,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
NOTE  
l
qWater Marks  
The paint chipping zone varies with the  
speed of the vehicle. For example, when  
traveling at 90 km/h (56 mph), the paint  
chipping zone is 50 m (164 ft).  
In low temperatures a vehicle's finish  
hardens. This increases the chance of paint  
chipping.  
Chipped paint can lead to rust forming on  
your Mazda. Before this happens, repair the  
damage by using Mazda touch-up paint  
according to the instructions in this section.  
Failure to repair the affected area could  
lead to serious rusting and expensive  
repairs.  
Occurrence  
Rain, fog, dew, and even tap water can  
contain harmful minerals such as salt and  
lime. If moisture containing these  
minerals settles on the vehicle and  
evaporates, the minerals will concentrate  
and harden to form white rings. The rings  
can damage your vehicle's finish.  
l
l
Prevention  
It is necessary to wash and wax your  
vehicle to preserve its finish according to  
the instructions in this section. These  
steps should be taken immediately after  
you find water marks on your vehicle's  
finish.  
qPaint Chipping  
Occurrence  
Paint chipping occurs when gravel thrown  
in the air by another vehicle's tires hits  
your vehicle.  
How to avoid paint chipping  
Keeping a safe distance between you and  
the vehicle ahead reduces the chances of  
having your paint chipped by flying  
gravel.  
8-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page344  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (344,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
l
Use plenty of lukewarm or cold water  
and a soft cloth when washing the  
vehicle. Do not use a nylon cloth.  
Rub gently when washing or drying the  
vehicle.  
Take your vehicle only to a car wash  
that keeps its brushes well maintained.  
Don't use abrasive cleansers or wax  
that contain abrasives.  
Exterior Care  
Follow all label and container directions  
when using a chemical cleaner or polish.  
Read all warnings and cautions.  
l
l
l
qMaintaining the Finish  
Washing  
To help protect the finish from rust and  
deterioration, wash your Mazda  
thoroughly and frequently, at least once a  
month, with lukewarm or cold water.  
CAUTION  
Ø Don't use steel wool, abrasive  
cleaners, or strong detergents  
containing highly alkaline or  
caustic agents on chrome-plated  
or anodized aluminum parts. This  
may damage the protective  
coating; also, cleaners and  
detergents may discolor or  
deteriorate the paint.  
Ø To prevent damaging the antenna,  
remove it before entering a car  
wash facility or passing beneath a  
low overhead clearance.  
If the vehicle is washed improperly, the  
paint surface could be scratched. Here are  
some examples of how scratching could  
occur.  
Scratches occur on the paint surface  
when:  
l
The vehicle is washed without first  
rinsing off dirt and other foreign  
matter.  
The vehicle is washed with a rough,  
l
Pay special attention to removing salt,  
dirt, mud, and other foreign material from  
the underside of the fenders, and make  
sure the drain holes in the lower edges of  
the doors and rocker panels are clean.  
dry, or dirty cloth.  
l
l
The vehicle is washed at a car wash  
that uses brushes that are dirty or too  
stiff.  
Cleansers or wax containing abrasives  
are used.  
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,  
industrial fallout, and similar deposits can  
damage the finish if not removed  
immediately. When prompt washing with  
plain water is ineffective, use a mild soap  
made for use on vehicles.  
NOTE  
l
Mazda is not responsible for scratches  
caused by automatic car washes or  
improper washing.  
l
Scratches are more noticeable on vehicles  
with darker paint finishes.  
Thoroughly rinse off all soap with  
lukewarm or cold water. Don't allow soap  
to dry on the finish.  
To minimize scratches on the vehicle's  
paint finish:  
l
Rinse off any dirt or other foreign  
matter using lukewarm or cold water  
before washing.  
8-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page345  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (345,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
After washing the vehicle, dry it with a  
clean chamois to prevent water spots from  
forming.  
qRepairing Damage to the Finish  
Deep scratches or chips on the finish  
should be repaired promptly. Exposed  
metal quickly rusts and can lead to major  
repairs.  
WARNING  
Dry wet brakes by driving very slowly  
and applying the brakes lightly until  
brake performance is normal:  
Driving with wet brakes is  
CAUTION  
If your Mazda is damaged and needs  
metal parts repaired or replaced,  
make sure the body shop applies  
anti-corrosion materials to all parts,  
both repaired and new. This will  
prevent them from rusting.  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
qPaint Damage Touch-up  
Waxing  
Repair damage to the finish caused by  
stone chipping, damage during parking  
etc., by using Mazda touch-up paint  
before rust begins to form. First, remove  
the dirt and grease with a clean soft cloth.  
Your vehicle needs to be waxed when  
water no longer beads on the finish.  
Always wash and dry the vehicle before  
waxing it. In addition to the vehicle body,  
wax the metal trim to maintain its luster.  
If rust has already begun to form:  
1. Use wax which contains no abrasives.  
Waxes containing abrasive will remove  
paint and could damage bright metal  
parts.  
1. Remove rust completely with  
sandpaper.  
2. Wipe with a clean soft cloth.  
2. Use a good grade of natural wax for  
metallic, mica, and solid colors.  
3. Apply rust preventive primer to the  
area.  
3. When waxing, coat evenly with the  
sponge supplied or a soft cloth.  
4. After drying it completely, apply a  
suitable top coat material to the area.  
4. Wipe off the wax with a soft cloth.  
Of course there will be no problem if you  
assign the work to an Authorized Mazda  
Dealer.  
NOTE  
A spot remover to remove oil, tar, and similar  
materials will usually also take off the wax.  
Rewax these areas even if the rest of the  
vehicle doesn't need it.  
8-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page346  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (346,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
qCavity Protection  
qUnderbody Maintenance  
Cavities are treated for protection at the  
factory, but additional protective treatment  
after the vehicle has been put into use will  
extend the life of the body.  
We recommend that you consult an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer concerning this  
additional precaution.  
Road chemicals and salt used for ice and  
snow removal and solvents used for dust  
control may collect on the underbody. If  
not removed, they will speed up rusting  
and deterioration of such underbody parts  
as fuel lines, frame, floor pan, and exhaust  
system, even though these parts may be  
coated with anti-corrosive material.  
qBright-Metal Maintenance  
Thoroughly flush the underbody and  
wheel housings with lukewarm or cold  
water at the end of each winter. Try also  
to do this every month.  
l
Use tar remover to remove road tar and  
insects. Never do this with a knife or  
similar tool.  
To prevent corrosion on bright-metal  
l
surfaces, apply wax or chrome  
preservative and rub it to a high luster.  
During cold weather or in coastal areas,  
cover bright-metal parts with a coating  
of wax or preservative heavier than  
usual. It would also help to coat them  
with noncorrosive petroleum jelly or  
some other protective compound.  
Pay special attention to these areas  
because they easily hide mud and dirt. It  
will do more harm than good to wet  
down the road grime without removing  
it.  
l
The lower edges of doors, rocker panels,  
and frame members have drain holes that  
should not be clogged. Water trapped  
there will cause rusting.  
CAUTION  
Don't use steel wool, abrasive  
cleaners, or strong detergents  
containing highly alkaline or caustic  
agents on chrome-plated or anodized  
aluminum parts. This may result in  
damage to the protective coating and  
cause discoloration or paint  
WARNING  
Dry wet brakes by driving very slowly  
and applying the brakes lightly until  
brake performance is normal:  
Driving with wet brakes is  
dangerous. Increased stopping  
distance or the vehicle pulling to one  
side when braking could result in a  
serious accident. Light braking will  
indicate whether the brakes have  
been affected.  
deterioration.  
8-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page347  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (347,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
qUndercoating  
Interior Care  
This special coating is applied to the  
critical parts of the underside to protect  
vehicles from damage caused by  
chemicals or stones. This coating is liable  
to be damaged with time. Check this  
coating periodically.  
qDashboard Precautions  
Prevent caustic solutions such as perfume  
and cosmetic oils from contacting the  
dashboard. They'll damage and discolor it.  
If these solutions get on the dashboard,  
wipe them off immediately.  
An Authorized Mazda Dealer are well  
informed on how repairs should be made.  
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
CAUTION  
Do not use glazing agents.  
Glazing agents contain ingredients  
which may cause discoloration,  
wrinkling, cracks and peeling.  
qAluminum Wheel Maintenance  
A protective coating is provided over the  
aluminum wheels. Special care is needed  
to protect this coating.  
qCleaning the Upholstery and  
Interior Trim  
NOTE  
l
Don't use a wire brush or any abrasive  
Vinyl  
cleaner, polishing compound, or solvent on  
aluminum wheels. They may damage the  
coating.  
Remove dust and loose dirt from vinyl  
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.  
Clean vinyl with a leather-and-vinyl  
cleaner.  
l
Only use a mild soap or neutral detergent  
and always use a sponge or soft cloth to  
clean the wheels.  
Rinse thoroughly with lukewarm or cold  
water. Also, be sure to clean the wheels  
after driving on dusty or salted roads. This  
helps prevent corrosion.  
Leatherí  
Real leather isn't uniform and may have  
scars, scratches, and wrinkles. Clean it  
with a leather cleaner or mild soap.  
l
Avoid washing your vehicle in an automatic  
Wipe it with a damp soft cloth; then dry  
and buff it with a dry soft cloth.  
car wash that uses high-speed or hard  
brushes.  
l
If your aluminum wheels lose luster, wax  
the wheels.  
Fabric  
Remove dust and loose dirt from fabric  
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.  
Clean it with a mild soap solution good  
for upholstery and carpets. Remove fresh  
spots immediately with a fabric spot  
cleaner.  
íSome models.  
8-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page348  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (348,1)  
Maintenance and Care  
Appearance Care  
To keep the fabric looking clean and  
fresh, take care of it. Otherwise its color  
will be affected, it can be stained easily,  
and its fire-resistance may be reduced.  
qCleaning the Window Interiors  
If the windows become covered with an  
oily, greasy, or waxy film, clean them  
with glass cleaner. Follow the directions  
on the container.  
CAUTION  
Use only recommended cleaners and  
procedures. Others may affect  
appearance and fire-resistance.  
CAUTION  
Don't scrape or scratch the inside of  
the rear window. You may damage  
the rear window defroster grid.  
Piano black panelí  
The following parts are fitted with panels  
that have been treated with a special  
coating that resists scratching.  
Steering wheel (partial)  
When the panel needs to be cleaned, use a  
soft cloth to wipe off dirt from the surface.  
NOTE  
Scratches or nicks on the panels resulting from  
the use of a hard brush or cloth may not be  
repairable.  
qCleaning the Lap/Shoulder Belt  
Webbing  
Clean the webbing with a mild soap  
solution recommended for upholstery or  
carpets. Follow instructions. Don't bleach  
or dye the webbing; this may weaken it.  
After cleaning the belts, thoroughly dry  
the belt webbing and make sure there is  
no remaining moisture before retracting  
them.  
WARNING  
Have an Authorized Mazda Dealer  
replace damaged seat belts  
immediately:  
Using damaged seat belts is  
dangerous. In a collision, damaged  
belts cannot provide adequate  
protection.  
8-56  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page349  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (349,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting  
Safety Defects  
9
Important consumer information including warranties and add-on equipment.  
9-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page350  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (350,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (U.S.A.)  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. We are here to serve you. All  
Authorized Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle  
in top condition.  
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of  
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take  
the following steps:  
NOTE  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary restraint  
system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in accordance with a  
certified physician, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
qSTEP 1: Contact Your Mazda Dealer  
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to  
address the issue.  
l
If your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS, SALES,  
SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL MANAGER of  
the dealership or the OWNER.  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary  
l
restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in  
accordance with a certified physician, go to STEP2.  
qSTEP 2: Contact Mazda North American Operations  
If for any reason you feel the need for further assistance after contacting your dealership  
management and it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the  
supplementary restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical  
conditions in accordance with a certified physician, you can reach Mazda North American  
Operations by one of the following ways.  
Log on: at www.mazdaUSA.com  
Answers to many questions, including how to locate or contact a local Mazda dealership in  
the U.S., can be found here.  
E-mail: click on Contact Usat the bottom of the page at www.mazdaUSA.com  
By phone at: 1 (800) 222-5500  
9-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page351  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (351,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
By letter at:  
Attn: Customer Assistance  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Irvine, CA 92618-2922  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734  
In order to serve you efficiently and effectively, please help us by providing the following  
information:  
1. Your name, address, and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on  
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)  
4. Purchase date and current mileage  
5. Your dealer's name and location  
6. Your question(s)  
If you live outside the U.S.A., please contact your nearest Mazda Distributor.  
qSTEP 3: Contact Better Business Bureau (BBB)  
Mazda North American Operations realizes that mutual agreement on some issues may not  
be possible. As a final step to ensure that your concerns are being fairly considered, Mazda  
North American Operations has agreed to participate in a dispute settlement program  
administered by the Better Business Bureau (BBB) system, at no cost to you the consumer.  
BBB AUTO LINE works with consumers and the manufacturer in an attempt to reach a  
mutually acceptable resolution of any warranty related concerns. If the BBB is not able to  
facilitate a settlement they will provide an informal hearing before an arbitrator.  
You are required to resort to BBB AUTO LINE before exercising rights or seeking  
remedies under the Federal Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, 15 U.S.C. § 2301 et seq. To the  
extent permitted by the applicable state Lemon Law, you are also required to resort to  
BBB AUTO LINE before exercising any rights or seeking remedies under the Lemon  
Law. If you choose to seek remedies that are not created by the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act or the applicable state Lemon Law, you are not required to first use BBB AUTO  
LINE.  
9-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page352  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (352,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
The whole process normally takes 40 days or less. The arbitration decision is not binding  
on you or Mazda else you accept the decision. For more information about BBB AUTO  
LINE, including current eligibility standards, please call 1-800-955-5100 or visit the BBB  
website at www.lemonlaw.bbb.org.  
Being truly committed to customer satisfaction is more than a phrase with Mazda. We hope  
to satisfy every customer directly, but if there is ever a question about our decision, Mazda  
believes in providing a fast, fair and free method such as the BBB AUTO LINE to ensure  
Mazda delivers on our commitment to do the right thing for our customers!  
9-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page353  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (353,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (Canada)  
qSatisfaction Review Process  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is of primary concern to Mazda. All Authorized  
Mazda Dealers have both the knowledge and tools to keep your Mazda in top condition. In  
our experience, any questions, problems, or complaints regarding the operation of your  
Mazda or any other general service transactions are most effectively resolved by your  
dealer. If the cause of your dissatisfaction cannot adequately be addressed by normal  
dealership procedures, we recommend that you take the following steps:  
qSTEP 1: Contact the Mazda Dealer  
Discuss the matter with a member of dealership management. If the Service Manager has  
already reviewed your concerns, contact the owner of the dealership or its General  
Manager.  
qSTEP 2: Contact the Mazda Regional Office  
If you feel that you still require assistance, ask the dealer Service Manager to arrange for  
you to meet the local Mazda Service Representative. If more expedient, contact Mazda  
Canada Inc.Regional Office nearest you for such arrangements. Regional Office address  
and phone numbers are shown (page 9-7).  
qSTEP 3: Contact the Mazda Customer Relations Department  
If still not substantially satisfied, contact the Customer Relations Department, Mazda  
Canada Inc., 55 Vogell Road, Richmond Hill, Ontario, L4B 3K5 Canada TEL: 1 (800)  
263-4680.  
Provide the Department with the following information:  
1. Your name, address and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). Refer to the Vehicle Identification Labelspage  
of section 10 of this manual for the location of the VIN.  
4. Purchase date  
5. Present odometer reading  
6. Your dealer's name and location  
7. The nature of your problem and/or cause of dissatisfaction  
The Department, in cooperation with the local Mazda Service Representative, will review  
the case to determine if everything possible has been done to ensure your satisfaction.  
9-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page354  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (354,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Please recognize that the resolution of service problems in most cases requires the use of  
your Mazda dealer's service facilities, personnel and equipment. We urge you to follow the  
above three steps in sequence for most effective results.  
qMediation/Arbitration Program  
Occasionally a customer concern cannot be resolved through Mazda's Customer  
Satisfaction Program. If after exhausting the procedures in this manual your concern is still  
not resolved, you have another option.  
Mazda Canada Inc. participates in an arbitration program administered by the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP). CAMVAP will advise you about  
how your concern may be reviewed and resolved by an independent third party through  
binding arbitration.  
Your complete satisfaction is the goal of Mazda Canada Inc. and our dealers.  
Mazda's participation in CAMVAP makes a valuable contribution to our achieving that  
goal. There is no charge for using CAMVAP. CAMVAP results are fast, fair and final as the  
award is binding on both you and Mazda Canada Inc.  
qCanadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP)  
If a specific item of concern arises, where a solution cannot be reached between an owner,  
Mazda, and/or one of it's dealers (that all parties cannot agree upon), the owner may wish  
to use the services offered by the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).  
CAMVAP uses the services of Provincial Administrators to assist consumers in scheduling  
and preparing for their arbitration hearings. However, before you can proceed with  
CAMVAP you must follow your Mazda dispute resolution process as outlined previously.  
9-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page355  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (355,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
CAMVAP is fully implemented in all provinces and territories.  
Consumers wishing to obtain further information about the Program should contact the  
Provincial Administrator at 1 (800) 207-0685, or by contacting the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan Office at:  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan  
235 Yorkland Boulevard, suite 300  
North York, Ontario  
M2J 4Y8  
http://camvap.ca  
Provincial Administrators may be reached locally as listed below:  
Province/Territory  
British Columbia & Yukon Territories  
Alberta & Northwest Territories  
Saskatchewan  
CAMVAP Number  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
1 (800) 207-0685  
Manitoba  
Ontario  
Atlantic Canada  
Quebec  
qRegional Offices  
REGIONAL OFFICES  
AREAS COVERED  
MAZDA CANADA INC.  
WESTERN REGION  
8171 ACKROYD ROAD  
SUITE 2000  
ALBERTA,  
BRITISH COLUMBIA,  
MANITOBA,  
RICHMOND B.C.  
V6X 3K1  
SASKATCHEWAN,  
YUKON  
(604) 303-5670  
MAZDA CANADA INC.  
CENTRAL/ATLANTIC REGION  
55 VOGELL ROAD,  
ONTARIO  
RICHMOND HILL,  
ONTARIO, L4B 3K5  
(905) 787-7000  
MAZDA CANADA INC.  
QUEBEC REGION  
6111 ROUTE TRANS  
CANADIENNE  
QUEBEC,  
NEW BRUNSWICK,  
NOVA SCOTIA,  
POINTE CLAIRE, QUEBEC  
H9R 5A5  
PRINCE EDWARD ISLAND,  
NEWFOUNDLAND  
(514) 694-6390  
9-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page356  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (356,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (Puerto Rico)  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. That is why all Authorized  
Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle in top  
condition.  
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of  
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take  
the following steps:  
qSTEP 1  
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to  
address the issue. If your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS,  
SALES, SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL  
MANAGER of the dealership or the OWNER.  
qSTEP 2  
If, after following STEP 1, you feel the need for further assistance, please contact your  
area's Mazda representative (Indicated on the next page).  
Please help us by providing the following information:  
1. Your name, address, and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on  
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)  
4. Purchase date and current mileage  
5. Your dealer's name and location  
6. Your question(s)  
9-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page357  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (357,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
Customer Assistance (Mexico)  
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. We are here to serve you. All  
Authorized Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle  
in top condition.  
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of  
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take  
the following steps:  
qSTEP 1: Contact Your Mazda Dealer  
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to  
address the issue.  
l
If your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS, SALES,  
SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL MANAGER of  
the dealership or the OWNER.  
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary  
l
restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in  
accordance with a certified physician, go to STEP2.  
qSTEP 2: Contact Mazda Motor de Mexico  
If for any reason you feel the need for further assistance after contacting your dealership  
management and it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the  
supplementary restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical  
conditions in accordance with a certified physician, you can reach Mazda Motor de Mexico  
by one of the following ways.  
Log on: at www.MazdaMexico.com.mx  
Answers to many questions, including how to locate or contact a local Mazda dealership in  
Mexico, can be found here.  
E-mail: click on Contactanosat the top of the page at www.MazdaMexico.com.mx  
By phone at: 1 (866) 315 0220  
By letter at:  
Attn: Customer Assistance  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Irvine, CA 92618-2922  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734  
9-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page358  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (358,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Customer Assistance  
In order to serve you efficiently and effectively, please help us by providing the following  
information:  
1. Your name, address, and telephone number  
2. Year and model of vehicle  
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on  
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)  
4. Purchase date and current mileage  
5. Your dealer's name and location  
6. Your question(s)  
9-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page359  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (359,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Mazda Importer/Distributors  
Importer/Distributor  
Distributor in Each Area  
qU.S.A.  
qCANADA  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Mazda Canada Inc.  
55 Vogell Road, Richmond Hill,  
Irvine, CA 92618-2922 U.S.A.  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734 U.S.A.  
TEL: 1 (800) 222-5500 (in U.S.A.)  
(949) 727-1990 (outside U.S.A.)  
Ontario, L4B 3K5 Canada  
TEL: 1 (800) 263-4680 (in Canada)  
(905) 787-7000 (outside Canada)  
q
PUERTO RICO/U.S. Virgin Island  
Plaza Motors Corp. (Mazda de Puerto  
Rico)  
P.O. Box 362722, San Juan, Puerto Rico  
00936-2722  
TEL: (787) 641-9300  
qMEXICO  
Mazda Motor de Mexico  
Circuito Guillermo Gonzalez Camarena N  
1500 Col. Centro de Ciudad Santa Fe.  
01210, Mexico, D.F.  
TEL: Center of Attention to Clients:  
01 (800) 016 2932. in Mexico  
qGUAM  
Triple J Motors  
157 South Marine Drive, Tamuning,  
GUAM 96911 USA  
P.O. Box 6066 Tamuning, Guam 96931  
TEL: (671) 649-6555  
qSAIPAN  
Pacific International Marianas, Inc.  
(d.b.a. Midway Motors)  
P.O. Box 887 Saipan, MP 96950  
TEL: (670) 234-7524  
9-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page360  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (360,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Mazda Importer/Distributors  
Triple J Saipan, Inc.  
(d.b.a. Triple J Motors)  
P.O. Box 500487 Saipan, MP 96950-0487  
TEL: (670) 234-7133/3051  
qAMERICAN SAMOA  
Polynesia Motors, Inc.  
P.O. Box 1120, Pago Pago, American  
Samoa 96799  
TEL: (684) 699-9347  
9-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page361  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (361,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Warranties for Your Mazda  
l
l
l
l
l
New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
Distributor Major Component Limited Warranty (Canada only)  
Safety Restraint System Limited Warranty  
Anti-perforation Limited Warranty  
Federal Emission Control Warranty (U.S.A. only)  
l
Emission Defect Warranty  
Emission Performance Warranty  
l
l
l
l
l
California Emission Control Warranty (U.S.A. only)  
Emission Control Warranty (Canada only)  
Replacement Parts and Accessories Limited Warranty  
Tire Warranty  
NOTE  
Detailed warranty information is provided with your Mazda.  
9-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page362  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (362,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Outside the United States and Canada  
Government regulations in the United States and Canada require that automobiles meet  
specific emission regulations and safety standards. Therefore, vehicles built for use in the  
United States, its territories, and Canada may differ from those sold in other countries.  
The differences may make it difficult or even impossible for your vehicle to receive  
satisfactory servicing in other countries. We strongly recommend that you NOT take your  
Mazda outside these areas.  
You may have these problems if you do:  
l
Recommended fuel may be unavailable. Any kind of leaded fuel or low-octane fuel will  
affect vehicle performance and damage the emission controls and engine.  
Proper repair facilities, tools, testing equipment, and replacement parts may not be  
l
available.  
The Mazda warranty applies only to Mazda vehicles registered and normally operated in  
the United States, its territories, and Canada.  
9-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page363  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (363,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Outside the United States  
Government regulations in the United States require that automobiles meet specific  
emission regulations and safety standards. Therefore, vehicles built for use in the United  
States may differ from those sold in other countries.  
The differences may make it difficult or even impossible for your vehicle to receive  
satisfactory servicing in other countries. We strongly recommend that you NOT take your  
Mazda outside the United States. However, in the event that you are moving to Canada  
permanently, Mazda vehicles built for use in the United States could be eligible for  
exportation to Canada with specific vehicle modifications to comply with the Canadian  
Motor Vehicle Safety requirements (CMVSS).  
NOTE  
The above is applicable for a permanent import/export situation and not related to travelers on  
vacation.  
You may have the following problems if you do take your vehicle outside of the United  
States:  
l
Recommended fuel may be unavailable. Any kind of leaded fuel or low-octane fuel will  
affect vehicle performance and damage the emission controls and engine.  
Proper repair facilities, tools, testing equipment, and replacement parts may not be  
l
available.  
Please refer to your Manufacturer's Warranty Booklet for more information.  
9-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page364  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (364,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Outside Canada  
Government regulations in Canada require that automobiles meet specific emission  
regulations and safety regulations. Therefore, vehicles built for use in Canada may differ  
from those sold in other countries.  
The differences may make it difficult or even impossible for your vehicle to receive  
satisfactory servicing in other countries. We strongly recommend that you NOT take your  
Mazda outside Canada. However, in the event that you are moving to the United States  
permanently, Mazda vehicles built for use in Canada could be eligible for exportation to the  
United States with specific vehicle modifications to comply with the United States Federal  
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards (FMVSS).  
NOTE  
The above is applicable for a permanent import/export situation and not related to travelers on  
vacation.  
You may have the following problems if you do take your vehicle outside of Canada:  
l
Recommended fuel may be unavailable. Any kind of leaded fuel or low-octane fuel will  
affect vehicle performance and damage the emission controls and engine.  
Proper repair facilities, tools, testing equipment, and replacement parts may not be  
l
available.  
Please refer to your Manufacturer's Warranty Booklet for more information.  
9-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page365  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (365,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Registering Your Vehicle in A Foreign Country (Except  
United States and Canada)  
Government regulations in your country could require that automobiles meet specific  
emission and safety standards.  
Vehicles built for your country may differ from those built for other countries. In addition  
to registration problems, satisfactory service may be difficult or even impossible in another  
country.  
The fuel specified for your vehicle may be unavailable.  
Parts, servicing techniques, and tools necessary to maintain and repair your vehicle may be  
unavailable.  
There might not be an Authorized Mazda Dealer in the country you plan to take your  
vehicle.  
The Mazda warranty is valid only in certain countries.  
9-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page366  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (366,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Warranty  
Add-On Non-Genuine Parts and Accessories  
Non-genuine parts and accessories for Mazda vehicles can be found in stores.  
These may fit your vehicle, but they are not approved by Mazda for use with Mazda  
vehicles. When you install non-genuine parts or accessories, they could affect your  
vehicle's performance or safety systems; the Mazda warranty doesn't cover this. Before you  
install any non-genuine parts or accessories, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
WARNING  
Always consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer before you install non-genuine parts or  
accessories:  
Installation of non-genuine parts or accessories is dangerous. Improperly designed  
parts or accessories could seriously affect your vehicle's performance or safety  
systems. This could cause you to have an accident or increase your chances of  
injuries in an accident.  
Be very careful in choosing and installing add-on electrical equipment, such as  
mobile telephones, two-way radios, stereo systems, and car alarm systems:  
Incorrectly choosing or installing improper add-on equipment or choosing an  
improper installer is dangerous. Essential systems could be damaged, causing engine  
stalling, air-bag (SRS) activation, ABS inactivation, or a fire in the vehicle.  
Mazda assumes no responsibility for death, injury, or expenses that may result from the  
installation of add-on non-genuine parts or accessories.  
9-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page367  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (367,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Cell Phones  
Cell Phones Warning  
WARNING  
Please comply with the legal regulations concerning the use of communication  
equipment in vehicles in your country:  
Use of any electrical devices such as cell phones, computers, portable radios, vehicle  
navigation or other devices by the driver while the vehicle is moving is dangerous.  
Dialing a number on a cell phone while driving also ties-up the driver's hands. Use of  
these devices will cause the driver to be distracted and could lead to a serious  
accident. If a passenger is unable to use the device, pull off the right-of-way to a safe  
area before use. If use of a cell phone is necessary despite this warning, use a hands-  
free system to at least leave the hands free to drive the vehicle. Never use a cell  
phone or other electrical devices while the vehicle is moving and, instead,  
concentrate on the full-time job of driving.  
9-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page368  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (368,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Type Approval of Equipment  
Type Approval of Equipment (Mexico)  
Immobilizer system  
9-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page369  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (369,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)  
This information relates to the tire grading system developed by the U.S. National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration for grading tires by tread wear, traction, and  
temperature performance.  
qTread Wear  
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a specified government test course.  
For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one-and-a-half times as well on the government  
course as a tire graded 100.  
The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,  
and may depart significantly from the norm because of variations in driving habits, service  
practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.  
qTraction-AA, A, B, C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent  
the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on  
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
WARNING  
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on braking (straight ahead) traction  
tests and does not include acceleration cornering (turning), hydroplaning, or peak  
traction characteristics.  
qTemperature-A, B, C  
The temperature grades A (the highest), B, and C, represent the tire's resistance to the  
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions  
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire  
life, and excessive temperatures can lead to sudden tire failure.  
Grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger vehicle tires must meet  
under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent  
higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by  
law.  
9-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page370  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (370,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)  
WARNING  
Keep your vehicle's tires properly inflated and not overloaded:  
Driving with improperly inflated or overloaded tires is dangerous. Excessive speed,  
underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause  
heat buildup and possible tire failure. The temperature grade for this tire is  
established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.  
These grades will be added to the sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires over the next several  
years according to a schedule established by the NHTSA and the tire manufacturers.  
The grade of tires available as standard or optional equipment on Mazda vehicles may vary  
with respect to grade.  
ALL PASSENGER VEHICLE TIRES MUST CONFORM TO THESE GRADES AND  
TO ALL OTHER FEDERAL TIRE-SAFETY REQUIREMENTS.  
qUniform Tire Quality Grading  
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder  
and maximum section width.  
For example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
UTQGS MARK (example)  
TREADWEAR 200 TRACTION AA  
TEMPERATURE A  
9-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page371  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (371,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Tire Labeling  
Federal law requires tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of  
all tires. This information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire  
and also provides a tire identification number for safety standard certification and in case of  
a recall.  
qInformation on Passenger Vehicle Tires  
Please refer to the diagram below.  
1. TIN: U.S. DOT tire identification number  
2. Passenger car tire  
3. Nominal width of tire in millimeters  
4. Ratio of height to width (aspect ratio)  
5. Radial  
6. Rim diameter code  
7. Load index & speed symbol  
8. Severe snow conditions  
9. Tire ply composition and materials used  
10. Max. load rating  
9-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page372  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (372,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
11. Tread wear, traction and temperature grades  
12. Max. permissible inflation pressure  
13. SAFETY WARNING  
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a tire size and load index rating. Here is an explanation  
of the various components of that tire size and load index rating. Note that the tire size and  
load index rating may be different from the example.  
P
Indicates a tire that may be installed on cars, SUVs, minivans and light trucks as designated  
by the Tire and Rim Association (T&RA).  
NOTE  
If your tire size does not begin with a letter this may mean it is designated by either ETRTO  
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire Manufacturing Association).  
215  
215is the nominal width of the tire in millimeters. This three-digit number gives the  
width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger  
the number, the wider the tire.  
65  
65is the aspect ratio. This two-digit number indicates the tire's ratio of height to width.  
R
Ris the tire construction symbol. R indicates Radial ply construction.  
15  
15is the wheel rim diameter in inches.  
95  
95is the Load Index. This two-or three-digit number indicates how much weight each  
tire can support.  
9-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page373  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (373,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
H
His the speed rating. The speed rating denotes the maximum speed for which the use of  
the tire is rated.  
Letter Rating  
Speed Rating  
99 mph  
Q
R
S
106 mph  
112 mph  
118 mph  
124 mph  
130 mph  
149 mph  
168* mph  
186* mph  
T
U
H
V
W
Y
* For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph, tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For  
tires with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph, tire manufacturers always use the letters ZR.  
M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow  
AT: All Terrain.  
AS: All Season. The M+Sor M/Sindicates that the tire has some functional use in  
mud and snow.  
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
This begins with the letters DOTwhich indicates the tire meets all federal standards. The  
next two numbers or letters are the plant code where it was manufactured, and the last four  
numbers represent the week and year the tire was manufactured. For example, the numbers  
457 means the 45st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example,  
the number 2102 means the 21th week of 2002. The other numbers are marketing codes  
used at the manufacturer's discretion. This information is used to contact consumers if a tire  
defect requires a recall.  
Tire Ply Composition and Materials Used  
The number of plies indicates the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire. In  
general, the greater the number of plies, the more weight a tire can support. Tire  
manufacturers also must indicate the tire materials, which include steel, nylon, polyester,  
and other.  
Maximum Load Rating  
This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by  
the tire.  
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure  
This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should ever be put in the tire under  
normal driving conditions.  
9-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page374  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (374,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Tread Wear, Traction and Temperature Grades  
Tread wear: The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire  
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For  
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the  
government course as a tire graded 100.  
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The grades  
represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions  
on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have  
poor traction performance.  
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the tire's  
resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under  
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
Snow Tires  
In some heavy snow areas, local governments may require true snow tires, those with very  
deeply cut tread. These tires should only be used in pairs or placed on all four wheels.  
Make sure you purchase snow tires that are the same size and construction type as the other  
tires on your vehicle.  
SAFETY WARNING  
The following safety warning appears on the tire's sidewall.  
SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT FROM:  
l
EXPLOSION OF TIRE/RIM ASSEMBLY DUE TO IMPROPER MOUNTING-  
MATCH TIRE DIAMETER TO RIM DIAMETER; NEVER EXCEED 40 psi (275 kPa)  
TO SEAT BEADS-ONLY SPECIALLY TRAINED PERSONS SHOULD MOUNT  
TIRES.  
l
TIRE FAILURE DUE TO UNDER-INFLATION/OVERLOADING/DAMAGE-  
FOLLOW OWNER'S MANUAL AND PLACARD IN VEHICLE-FREQUENTLY  
CHECK INFLATION PRESSURE AND INSPECT FOR DAMAGE.  
9-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page375  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (375,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
qInformation on Temporary Tires  
Please refer to the diagram below.  
1. Temporary tires  
2. Nominal width of tire in millimeters  
3. Ratio of height to width (aspect ratio)  
4. Diagonal  
5. Rim diameter code  
6. Load index&speed symbol  
T115/70D 16 90M is an example of a tire size and load index rating. Here is an explanation  
of the various components of that tire size and load index rating. Note that the tire size and  
load index rating may be different from the example.  
T
Indicates a tire that may be installed on cars, SUVs, minivans and light trucks as designated  
by the Tire and Rim Association (T&RA).  
115  
115is the nominal width of the tire in millimeters. This three-digit number gives the  
width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger  
the number, the wider the tire.  
9-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page376  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (376,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
70  
70is the aspect ratio. This two-digit number indicates the tire's ratio of height to width.  
D
Dis the tire construction symbol. D indicates diagonal ply construction.  
16  
16is the wheel rim diameter in inches.  
90  
90is the Load Index. This two-or three-digit number indicates how much weight each  
tire can support.  
M
Mis the speed rating. The speed rating denotes the maximum speed for which the use of  
the tire is rated.  
Letter Rating  
Speed Rating  
M
81 mph  
9-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page377  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (377,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Location of the Tire Label (Placard)  
You will find the tire label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size and other important  
information on the driver's side B-pillar or on the edge of the driver's door frame.  
SAMPLE  
qRecommended Tire Inflation Pressure  
On the tire label you will find the recommended tire inflation pressure in both kPa and psi  
for the tires installed as original equipment on the vehicle. It is very important that the  
inflation pressure of the tires on your vehicle is maintained at the recommended pressure.  
You should check the tire pressure regularly to insure that the proper inflation pressure is  
maintained.  
Refer to Tires on page 10-6.  
NOTE  
Tire pressures listed on the vehicle placard or tire information label indicate the recommended cold  
tire inflation pressure, measured when the tires are cold, after the vehicle has been parked for at least  
3 hours. As you drive, the temperature in the tire warms up, increasing the tire pressure.  
9-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page378  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (378,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
WARNING  
Always check the tire inflation pressures on a regular basis according to the  
recommended tire inflation pressure on the tire label and in conjunction with the  
information in this owner's manual:  
Driving your vehicle with under-inflated tires is dangerous.  
Under-inflation is the most common cause of failures in any kind of tire and may  
result in severe cracking, tread separation or blowout, with unexpected loss of  
vehicle control and increased risk of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing  
and rolling resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It  
results in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of control and accidents. A tire  
can lose up to half of its air pressure and not appear to be flat!  
It is impossible to determine whether or not tires are properly inflated just by looking  
at them.  
qChecking Tire Pressure  
1. When you check the air pressure, make sure the tires are cold meaning they are not  
hot from driving even a mile.  
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire.  
3. Firmly press a tire gauge onto the valve.  
4. Add air to achieve recommended air pressure.  
5. If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in the center of the  
valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.  
6. Replace the valve cap.  
7. Repeat with each tire, including the spare.  
NOTE  
Some spare tires require higher inflation pressure.  
8. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other objects embedded that  
could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air leak.  
9. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts, bulges, cracks or other  
irregularities.  
NOTE  
Warm tires normally exceed recommended pressures. Don't release air from warm tires to adjust the  
pressure.  
Under-inflation can cause serious failures and accidents.  
Over-inflation can produce a harsh ride and the greater possibility of damage from road hazards.  
9-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page379  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (379,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
qGlossary of Terms  
Tire Placard: A label indicating the OE tire sizes, recommended inflation pressure, and  
the maximum weight the vehicle can carry.  
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of each tire providing  
information about the tire brand and manufacturing plant, tire size, and date of  
manufacture.  
Inflation Pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.  
kPa: Kilopascal, the metric unit for air pressure.  
psi: Pounds per square inch, the English unit for air pressure.  
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the front door.  
Original Equipment (OE): Describes components originally equipped on the vehicle.  
Vehicle Load Limit: The maximum value of the combination weight of occupants and  
cargo.  
Bead Area of the Tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.  
Sidewall Area of the Tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.  
Tread Area of the Tire: Area on the perimeter of the tire that contacts the road when it's  
mounted on the vehicle.  
Seating capacity means the total allowable number of vehicle occupants. Seating capacity  
is described on the tire label.  
Production options weight is the combination weight of installed regular production  
options weighing over 2.3 kilograms in excess of the standard items which they replace,  
and not previously considered in the curb weight or accessory weight, including heavy  
duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery, and special trim.  
Rim is the metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly upon which the tire  
beads are seated.  
9-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page380  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (380,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Tire Maintenance  
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear abnormally. Here are  
some important maintenance points:  
qTire Inflation Pressure  
Inspect all tire pressure monthly (including the spare) when the tires are cold. Maintain  
recommended pressures for the best ride, top handling, and minimum tire wear. Use the  
pressures specified on the vehicle tire information placard or tire label for optimum service.  
qTire Rotation  
To equalize tread wear, rotate the tires every 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or sooner if irregular  
wear develops. During rotation, inspect them for correct balance.  
Forward  
Do not include (TEMPORARY USE ONLY)  
spare tire in rotation.  
Inspect the tires for uneven wear and damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused by one or a  
combination of the following:  
l
Incorrect tire pressure  
Improper wheel alignment  
Out-of-balance wheel  
Severe braking  
l
l
l
After rotation, inflate all tire pressures to specification (page 10-6) and inspect the lug nuts  
for tightness.  
9-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page381  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (381,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
CAUTION  
Rotate unidirectional tires and radial tires that have an asymmetrical tread pattern  
or studs only from front to rear, not from side to side. Tire performance will be  
weakened if rotated from side to side.  
(With limited-slip differential)  
Don't use the following:  
Ø Tires not of the designated size  
Ø Tires of different sizes or types at the same time  
Ø Tires not sufficiently inflated  
If these instructions aren't followed, the rotation of the left and right wheels will be  
different and will thus apply a constant load on the limited-slip differential.  
This will cause a malfunction.  
qReplacing a Tire  
WARNING  
Always use tires that are in good condition:  
Driving with worn tires is dangerous. Reduced braking, steering, and traction could  
result in an accident.  
If a tire wears evenly, a wear indicator will appear as a solid band across the tread. Replace  
the tire when this happens.  
Tread wear indicator  
New tread  
Worn tread  
You should replace it before the band is across the entire tread.  
NOTE  
Tires degrade over time, even when they are not being used on the road. It is recommended that tires  
generally be replaced when they are 6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates or frequent high  
loading conditions can accelerate the aging process. You should replace the spare tire when you  
replace the other road tires due to the aging of the spare tire. Regarding the manufacturing week and  
year is indicated with 4 digit. Refer to The tire labeling on page 9-23.  
9-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page382  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (382,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
qSafety Practices  
The way you drive has a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety. So cultivate  
good driving habits for your own benefit.  
l
Observe posted speed limits  
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns  
Avoid potholes and objects on the road  
Do no run over curbs or hit the tire against the curb when parking  
l
l
l
CAUTION  
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving or you suspect your  
tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your speed. Drive with caution  
until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and inspect the tire for damage. If the tire  
is under-inflated or damaged, deflate it, remove the tire and rim and replace it with  
your spare tire. If you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest  
vehicle or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.  
9-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page383  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (383,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Vehicle Loading  
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or trailer, to keep  
your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating capability, with or without a trailer.  
Properly loading your vehicle will provide maximum return of vehicle design performance.  
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining  
your vehicle's weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle's Safety  
Certification Label and Tire and Load Information Label:  
WARNING  
Overloaded Vehicle:  
Overloading a vehicle is dangerous. The results of overloading can have serious  
consequences in terms of passenger safety. Too much weight on a vehicle's  
suspension system can cause spring or shock absorber failure, brake failure,  
handling or steering problems, irregular tire wear, tire failure or other damage.  
Overloading makes a vehicle harder to drive and control. It also increases the  
distance required for stopping. In cases of serious overloading, brakes can fail  
completely, particularly on steep grades. The load a tire will carry safely is a  
combination of the size of the tire, its load range, and corresponding inflation  
pressure.  
Never overload the vehicle and always observe the vehicle's weight ratings from the  
vehicle's Safety Certification and Tire and Load Information labels.  
Base Curb Weight is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of fuel and all  
standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or optional equipment.  
Vehicle Curb Weight is the weight of your new vehicle when you picked it up from your  
dealer plus any aftermarket equipment.  
PAYLOAD  
9-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page384  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (384,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Payload is the combination weight of cargo and passengers that the vehicle is designed to  
carry. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found on the Tire and Load  
Information label on the driver's door frame or door pillar. Look for THE  
COMBINATION WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND CARGO SHOULD NEVER  
EXCEED XXX kg or XXX lbsfor your maximum payload. The payload listed on the tire  
label is the maximum payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If any  
aftermarket or dealer installed equipment has been installed on the vehicle, the weight of  
the equipment must be subtracted from the payload listed on the tire label in order to be  
accurate.  
SAMPLE  
9-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page385  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (385,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
CARGO  
Cargo Weight includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight, including cargo and  
optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load or king pin weight is also part of  
cargo weight.  
The cargo weight limit decreases depending on the number of vehicle occupants. The cargo  
weight limit can be calculated by subtracting the total weight of the vehicle occupants from  
the combination weight of occupants and cargo should never exceedvalue on the tire  
label.  
Examples: Based on a single occupant weight of 68 kg (150 lbs), and a value of 385 kg  
(849 lbs) for the combination weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed:  
_
The cargo weight limit with one occupant is 385 kg (849 lbs) 68 kg (150 lbs) = 317 kg  
(699 lbs)  
_
The cargo weight limit with two occupants is 385 kg (849 lbs) (68 × 2) kg ( (150 × 2)  
lbs) = 249 kg (549 lbs)  
If the weight of the occupant increases, the cargo weight limit decreases by that much.  
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) is the total weight placed on each axle (front and rear) -  
including vehicle curb weight and all payload.  
9-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page386  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (386,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight that can be carried  
by a single axle (front or rear). These numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label located on the driver's door frame or door pillar. The total load on  
each axle must never exceed its GAWR.  
GVW  
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo + passengers.  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight of the fully  
loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment, passengers and cargo). The GVWR is  
shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label located on the driver's door  
frame or door pillar. The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.  
9-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page387  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (387,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
SAMPLE  
WARNING  
Exceeding Axle Weight Rating Limits:  
Exceeding the Safety Certification Label axle weight rating limits is dangerous and  
could result in death or serious injury as a result of substandard vehicle handling,  
performance, engine, transmission and/or structural damage, serious damage to the  
vehicle, or loss of control.  
Always keep the vehicle within the axle weight rating limits.  
Do not taw a trailer with this vehicle:  
Towing a trailer with this vehicle is dangerous because it has not been designed to  
tow a trailer and doing so will affect the drive system which could result in vehicle  
damage.  
9-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page388  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (388,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
GCW  
GCW (Gross Combination Weight) is the weight of the loaded vehicle (GVW) plus the  
weight of the fully loaded trailer.  
GCWR (Gross Combination Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight of the  
vehicle and the loaded trailer - including all cargo and passengers - that the vehicle can  
handle without risking damage. (Important: The towing vehicle's braking system is rated  
for operation at GVWR, not at GCWR. Separate functional brakes should be used for safe  
control of towed vehicles and for trailers weighing more than 1,500 lbs). The GCW must  
never exceed the GCWR.  
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight is the highest possible weight of a fully loaded trailer  
the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only mandatory options, no cargo (internal or  
_
_
external), a tongue load of 10 15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15 25%  
(fifth-wheel trailer), and driver only (150 lbs). Consult your dealership (or the RV and  
Trailer Towing Guide provided by your dealership) for more detailed information.  
Tongue Load or Fifth-Wheel King Pin Weight refers to the amount of the weight that a  
trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.  
Examples: For a 5000 lb conventional trailer, multiply 5000 by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a  
proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lbs. For an 11,500 lb fifth-wheel trailer, multiply by  
0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to 2,875 lbs.  
9-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page389  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (389,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
WARNING  
Exceeding GVWR or GAWR Specifications:  
Exceeding the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the certification label is dangerous.  
Exceeding any vehicle rating limitation could result in a serious accident, injury, or  
damage to the vehicle.  
Do not use replacement tires with lower load carrying capacities than the originals  
because they may lower the vehicle's GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement  
tires with a higher limit than the originals do not increase the GVWR and GAWR  
limitations.  
Never exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the certification label.  
9-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page390  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (390,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Tire Information (except Canada)  
Steps for Determining the Correct Load Limit:  
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit:  
(1) Locate the statement The combined weight of occupants and cargo should  
never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbson your vehicle's placard.  
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be  
riding in your vehicle.  
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg  
or XXX lbs.  
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load  
capacity. For example, if the XXXamount equals 1400 lbs. and there  
will be five 150 lb passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available  
_
cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400 750 (5 × 150) = 650  
lbs.)  
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the  
vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage  
load capacity calculated in Step 4.  
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, the load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
9-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page391  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (391,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S.A.)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could  
cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mazda Motor  
Corporation (Your Mazda Importer/Distributor).  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it  
finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and  
remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual  
problems between you, your dealer, or Mazda Motor Corporation (Your Mazda  
Importer/Distributor).  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-  
327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153) ; go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590. You  
can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://  
www.safercar.gov.  
NOTE  
If you live in the U.S.A., all correspondence to Mazda Motor Corporation should be forwarded to:  
Mazda North American Operations  
7755 Irvine Center Drive  
Irvine, California 92618-2922  
P.O. Box 19734  
Irvine, CA 92623-9734  
Customer Assistance Center or toll free at 1 (800) 222-5500  
If you live outside of the U.S.A., please contact the nearest Mazda Distributor shown (page 9-11) in  
this booklet.  
9-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page392  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (392,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects (Canada)  
Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect  
Investigations and Recalls, may telephone the toll free hotline 1-800-333-0510, or contact  
Transport Canada by mail at: Transport Canada, ASFAD, Place de Ville Tower C, 330  
Sparks Street, Ottawa ON K1A 0N5.  
For additional road safety information, please visit the Road Safety website at:  
http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety/menu.htm  
9-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page393  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (393,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Service Publications  
Service Publications  
Factory-authorized Mazda service publications are available for owners who wish to do  
some of their own maintenance and repair.  
When requesting any of our publications through an Authorized Mazda Dealer, refer to the  
chart below.  
If they don't have what you need in stock, they can order it for you.  
PUBLICATION ORDER NUMBER  
9999-95-034B-08  
PUBLICATION DESCRIPTION  
2008 WORKSHOP MANUAL (English)  
2008 WORKSHOP MANUAL (Spanish)  
2008 WIRING DIAGRAM (English)  
2008 WIRING DIAGRAM (Spanish)  
2008 OWNER'S MANUAL  
9999-MX-034B-08  
9999-95-068G-08  
9999-MX-068G-08  
9999-95-080C-08 (U.S.A. only)  
9999-EC-080C-08 (Canada only)  
9999-PR-080C-08 (Puerto Rico, Mexico only)  
9999-95-MODL-08  
2008 OWNER'S MANUAL  
2008 OWNER'S MANUAL  
2008 SERVICE HIGHLIGHTS  
9999-95-011C-08NAV (U.S.A. only)  
9999-EC-011C-08NAV (Canada only)  
2008 NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL  
2008 NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL  
qWORKSHOP MANUAL:  
Covers recommended maintenance and repair procedures of the drive train, body and  
chassis.  
qWIRING DIAGRAM:  
Provides electrical schematics as well as component location for the entire electrical  
system.  
qOWNER'S MANUAL:  
This booklet contains information regarding the proper care and operation of your vehicle.  
This is not a technician's manual.  
qSERVICE HIGHLIGHTS:  
Provides description and operation of the many systems of your Mazda.  
9-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page394  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (394,1)  
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects  
Service Publications  
qNAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL:  
This booklet contains information regarding the proper operation and use of the navigation  
system. This is not a technician's manual.  
9-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page395  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (395,1)  
Specifications  
10  
Technical information about your Mazda.  
10-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page396  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (396,1)  
Identification Numbers  
qChassis Number  
Vehicle Information Labels  
qVehicle Identification Number  
The vehicle identification number legally  
identifies your vehicle. The number is on  
a plate attached to the cowl panel located  
on the left corner of the dashboard. This  
plate can easily be seen through the  
windshield.  
qVehicle Emission Control  
Information Label  
q
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label  
q
Tire Pressure Label (Except Canada)  
10-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page397  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (397,1)  
Identification Numbers  
qEngine Number  
Forward  
10-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page398  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (398,1)  
Specifications  
Specifications  
qEngine  
Item  
Specification  
Type  
DOHC-16V in-line, 4-cylinder  
87.5 × 94.0 mm (3.44 × 3.70 in)  
2,261 ml (2,261 cc, 137.9 cu in)  
9.5  
Bore×Stroke  
Displacement  
Compression ratio  
qElectrical System  
Item  
Classification  
12V-48AH/5HR MF  
12V-55AH/5HR MF  
L3K9 18 110A*1  
L3Y3 18 110  
Battery  
Spark-plug number  
Spark-plug gap  
*1 ex factory  
0.700.80 mm (0.0280.031 in)  
CAUTION  
When cleaning the iridium plugs, do not use a wire brush. The fine particulate  
coating on the iridium alloy and platinum tips could be damaged.  
qLubricant Quality  
Lubricant  
Classification  
Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers on page 8-19.  
JWS3309  
Engine oil  
Automatic transaxle fluid  
Transfer case oil  
API Service GL-5 (SAE 80W-90)  
Rear differential oil  
Power steering fluid  
Brake fluid  
API Service GL-5 (SAE 80W-90)  
ATF M-III, M-V, or equivalent (e.g. Dexron® II)  
SAE J1703, or FMVSS116 DOT-3  
10-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page399  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (399,1)  
Specifications  
qCapacities  
(Approximate Quantities)  
Item  
Capacity  
With oil filter replacement  
Without oil filter replacement  
5.7 L (6.0 US qt, 5.0 Imp qt)  
5.3 L (5.6 US qt, 4.7 Imp qt)  
9.0 L (9.5 US qt, 7.9 Imp qt)  
7.0 L (7.4 US qt, 6.2 Imp qt)  
1.2 L (1.3 US qt, 1.1 Imp qt)  
1.0 L (1.1 US qt, 0.9 Imp qt)  
Engine oil  
Coolant  
Automatic transaxle fluid  
Transfer case oil  
Rear differential oil  
With low washer fluid level  
warning light  
4.5 L (4.8 US qt, 4.0 Imp qt)  
Washer fluid  
Without low washer fluid level  
warning light  
2.5 L (2.6 US qt, 2.2 Imp qt)  
Fuel tank  
69.0 L (18.2 US gal, 15.2 Imp gal)  
Check oil and fluid levels with dipsticks or reservoir gauges.  
qDimensions  
Item  
Vehicle specification  
4,680 mm (184.3 in)  
4,675 mm (184.1 in)  
1,872 mm (73.7 in)  
1,645 mm (64.8 in)  
1,617 mm (63.7 in)  
1,612 mm (63.5 in)  
2,750 mm (108.3 in)  
With license plate holder  
Overall length  
Without license plate holder  
Overall width  
Overall height  
Front tread  
Rear tread  
Wheelbase  
qWeights  
Weight  
Item  
2WD  
AWD  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)  
2,168 kg (4,780 lbs)  
1,150 kg (2,535 lbs)  
1,022 kg (2,253 lbs)  
2,267 kg (4,998 lbs)  
1,189 kg (2,621 lbs)  
1,083 kg (2,388 lbs)  
Front  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)  
Rear  
qAir Conditioner  
Item  
Classification  
HFC134a (R-134a)  
Refrigerant Type  
10-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page400  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (400,1)  
Specifications  
qLight Bulbs  
Exterior light  
Category  
Light bulb  
Wattage  
60  
ECE R (SAE)  
HB3 (#9005)  
H7 (H7)  
High beam  
Headlights  
Low beam  
Halogen  
55  
Xenon fusion  
35  
D2S ()  
Front turn signal lights/Parking lights  
Front side-marker lights  
Fog lightsí  
27/8  
5
(#1157NA)  
W5W (#168)  
H11 (H11)  
55  
High-mount brake light*1  
Rear turn signal lights  
Brake lights/Taillights  
Reverse lights  
2.4  
21  
()  
WY21W ()  
W21/5W (#7743)  
W21W (#7440)  
W5W (#168)  
W5W (#168)  
21/5  
21  
License plate lights  
5
Rear side-marker lights  
5
*1 Bulb replacement is not possible because it is built into the unit. Replace the unit.  
Interior light  
Category  
Light bulb  
Wattage  
ECE R  
W5W  
Overhead lights/Map lights (Front)  
Overhead light (Rear)  
5
10  
10  
Luggage compartment light  
qTires  
NOTE  
The tires have been optimally matched with the chassis of your vehicle.  
When replacing tires, Mazda recommends that you replace tires of the same type originally fitted to  
your vehicle. For details, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Check the tire pressure label for tire size and inflation pressure.  
Refer to Tire Inflation Pressure on page 8-34.  
Standard tire  
(Except Mexico)  
Inflation pressure  
Tire size  
Front  
Rear  
P235/60R18 102H  
220 kPa (32 psi)  
220 kPa (32 psi)  
10-6  
íSome models.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page401  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (401,1)  
Specifications  
(Mexico)  
Inflation pressure  
Tire size  
Front  
Rear  
235/60R18 103H  
230 kPa (34 psi)  
230 kPa (34 psi)  
Temporary spare tire  
(Except Mexico)  
Tire size  
Inflation pressure  
T155/90D18 103M  
420 kPa (60 psi)  
(Mexico)  
Tire size  
Inflation pressure  
205/80R16 100M  
250 kPa (36 psi)  
qFuses  
Refer to the fuse rating on page 8-45.  
10-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page402  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (402,1)  
10-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page403  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (403,1)  
Index  
11  
11-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
 
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page404  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (404,1)  
Index  
A
B
Beeps  
Brake  
Brakes  
Automatic Transaxle  
C
Child Restraint  
B
Battery  
11-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page405  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (405,1)  
Index  
C
E
Engine  
Engine Coolant  
D
Defroster  
F
Flasher  
Fluids  
E
Fuel  
11-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page406  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (406,1)  
Index  
F
I
G
H
Headlights  
J
I
K
Ignition  
L
Light Bulbs  
11-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page407  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (407,1)  
Index  
L
R
M
Maintenance  
Mirrors  
S
Seat Belt System  
Seats  
O
P
Security System  
11-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page408  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (408,1)  
Index  
S
T
Towing  
V
T
Tiedown  
Tires  
11-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page409  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (409,1)  
Index  
W
Windows  
11-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
CX-7_8X59-EA-07E_Edition3 Page410  
Wednesday, July 25 2007 3:20 PM  
Black plate (410,1)  
11-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Form No.8X59-EA-07E  
Preparation  
Before Use  
NAVIGATION  
SYSTEM  
See page  
for specific information.  
4
Getting  
started  
Immediate use  
See page  
for specific information.  
4
Routing  
Address  
Book  
Advanced use  
See page  
for specific information.  
5
Voice  
Recognition  
Volume  
Adjustment  
If  
If necessary  
necessary  
See page  
5
for specific information.  
Audio  
System  
Audio System  
61  
See page  
for specific information.  
Rear View  
Monitor  
Rear View Monitor  
85  
See page  
for specific information.  
Bluetooth  
Hands-Free  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
91  
See page  
for specific information.  
©2007 Mazda Motor Corporation  
Printed in Japan July 2007(Print1)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
Please contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer if you are missing the  
following accessory.  
l Map Disc  
CAUTION:  
THIS PRODUCT IS A CLASS I LASER PRODUCT.  
HOWEVER THIS PRODUCT USES A VISIBLE/  
INVISIBLE LASER BEAM WHICH COULD CAUSE  
HAZARDOUS RADIATION EXPOSURE IF DIRECTED.  
BE SURE TO OPERATE THIS PRODUCT  
CORRECTLY AS INSTRUCTED.  
USE OF CONTROLS OR ADJUSTMENTS OR  
PERFORMANCE OF PROCEDURES OTHER THAN  
THOSE SPECIFIED HEREIN MAY RESULT IN  
HAZARDOUS RADIATION EXPOSURE. DO NOT  
OPEN COVERS AND DO NOT REPAIR YOURSELF.  
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED PERSONNEL.  
Laser products:  
Wavelength: 650 nm  
Laser power: No hazardous radiation is emitted with safety protection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2
MEMO  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3
Contents  
Preparation  
n Before Use  
Accessories........................................................................................ 2  
Laser products: .................................................................................. 2  
Contents............................................................................................. 4  
Safety Information .............................................................................. 6  
Introduction ........................................................................................ 8  
(Product Use Safety), (Navigation System),  
(Beep sound and voice guidance restrictions while using Bluetooth Hands-Free  
(Mazda CX-9 only)), (Screens)  
Names and Functions ........................................................................ 9  
Immediate use  
n Getting started  
l Activation....................................................................................... 12  
(Removing the Map Disc), (On-screen Buttons)  
l Set Clock....................................................................................... 14  
l Navigation Set Up ......................................................................... 15  
(Language), (Calibration), (User Setting), (Quick POI Selection),  
(Restore System Defaults), (Map Configuration)  
l Screen Names and Functions....................................................... 25  
(Screens Before Setting Route), (Screens During Route Guidance),  
(Menu), (Screen adjustments, beep alert and other settings)  
l Screen change.............................................................................. 29  
(Changing the Map Orientation/Scale)  
n Routing  
l Destination Entry and Route Search............................................. 30  
(Change (Change Search Area)), (Address), (Point of interest),  
(Emergency), (Memory Point), (Home), (Preset Destination),  
(Previous Destination), (Intersection), (Freeway On/Off Ramp),  
(Coordinates), (Select from map)  
l Quick POI...................................................................................... 38  
(Displaying POI(s) on a Map), (Local Search), (Deleting POI Markers),  
(Showing POI Data)  
l Character Entry............................................................................. 39  
(Street name, city name, and other input),  
(House phone number, and other input)  
l Direct Destination Input................................................................. 40  
(Direct Destination Input), (Selecting Route)  
l POI Icons on Maps / Delete Destination....................................... 41  
(POI (Point of Interest) Icons), (Delete destination)  
l Route Options............................................................................... 42  
(Route Preferences), (Modification of Destination or Way Point Positions),  
(Deletion of Destination or Way Points), (Detour), (Turn List),  
(Display Preview), (Route Preview)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4
Advanced use  
n Address Book  
l Address Book................................................................................46  
(Memory Point Storage), (Memory Point Confirmation and Modification),  
(Preset Destinations or Home Storage), (Memory Point Deletion),  
(All Memory Point Deletion), (Displays Icons at Memory Points),  
(Avoid Area Storage), (Avoid Area Confirmation and Modification),  
(Avoid Area Deletion), (All Avoid Area Deletion),  
(Category Name Modification),(Previous Destination Deletion),  
(All Preset Destination Deletion)  
n Voice Recognition  
l Voice Recognition..........................................................................50  
(Voice Recognition Structure), (Language Select), (Basic Usage Pattern),  
(Cancel Voice Recognition), (Voice Recognition Command)  
n Volume Adjustment  
l Volume Adjustment........................................................................52  
If necessary  
n If necessary  
l Precautions/System Performance.................................................53  
(Voice Guidance), (GPS), (Map Matching), (Positioning Accuracy),  
(Route Guide), (Route Search)  
l Troubleshooting .............................................................................57  
(Verification First), (Error Messages)  
l Maintenance..................................................................................60  
(Care of the Product), (Handling and Care of Map Discs)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5
Safety Information  
n Read this owner’s manual for your Navigation System carefully before using the system.  
It contains instructions about how to use the system in a safe and effective manner.  
Mazda assumes no responsibility for any problems resulting from failure to observe the instructions  
given in this manual.  
n This manual uses pictographs to show you how to use the product safely and to alert you to potential  
dangers resulting from improper connections and operation. The meanings of the pictographs are  
explained below. It is important that you fully understand the pictographs and explanations in order to  
use this manual and the system properly.  
The presence of this Warning symbol in the text is intended to  
alert you to the importance of heeding the operation  
Warning  
instructions. Failure to heed the instructions may result in  
Warning  
severe injury or death.  
n Do not keep your eyes fixed on the monitor screen or operate the system  
while driving.  
Do not change the settings and destination locations while driving. Minimize the time  
spent on viewing the monitor screen and listening to the voice guidance while driving.  
Operating the system will distract the driver from looking ahead of the vehicle and can  
cause accidents. Always stop the vehicle in a safe location and use the parking brake  
before operating the system.  
Warnings  
n Always obey local traffic regulations.  
Your guided route may include roads that are not open to vehicles or are closed due to  
traffic regulations. Comply with the local traffic regulations and take another route.  
n Do not use the unit when it is out of order.  
If the unit is out of order (no image, no sound) or in an abnormal state (has foreign matter  
in it, is exposed to water, is smoking, or smells), then turn it off immediately and consult  
with an authorized dealer, we recommend an Authorized Mazda Dealer. Using the unit in  
an out-of-order condition may lead to accidents, fires, or electric shocks.  
n Use the proper power supply.  
This product is designed for operation with a negative grounded 12 V DC battery system.  
n Do not disassemble.  
Do not disassemble the product or attempt to repair it yourself. If the product needs to be  
repaired, take it to an authorized dealer, we recommend an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6
The presence of this Caution symbol in the text is intended to  
alert you to the importance of heeding the operation  
instructions. Failure to heed the instructions may result in injury  
or material damage.  
Caution  
Caution  
Cautions  
n Do not use the product where it is exposed to water, moisture, or dust.  
Exposure to water, moisture, or dust may lead to smoke, fire, or other damage to the unit.  
Make especially sure that the unit does not get wet in car washes or on rainy days.  
n Keep the voice guidance volume at an appropriate level.  
Keep the volume level low enough to be aware of road and traffic conditions while driving.  
n Protect the Deck Mechanism.  
Do not insert any foreign objects into the slot of this unit.  
n This navigation system is designed exclusively for use in automobiles.  
This navigation system should only be installed in an automobile. Do not install it in a  
ship, aircraft, or any other vehicles except an automobile. Do not use it detached from the  
vehicle.  
n Do not insert or allow your hand or fingers to be caught in the unit.  
To prevent injury, do not get your hand or fingers caught in moving parts or in the disc  
slot. Especially watch out for infants.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions;  
(1) this device may not cause interference, and  
(2) this device must accept any interference,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7
Introduction  
Product Use Safety  
n Extremely low or high temperatures may interfere with normal operation  
The inside of the vehicle can become very hot or cold when it is parked for extended  
periods in direct sunlight or in cold places with the engine turned off. The navigation system  
may not operate normally under such circumstances. Turn off the navigation system until  
the inside of the vehicle has cooled down or warmed up. If the system does not operate  
thereafter, consult an authorized dealer, we recommend an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Navigation System  
This navigation system utilizes GPS* satellite signals, a speed sensor and gyrosensor to track  
and display your vehicle’s current position, and to guide you from your starting point to your  
destination along a calculated route.  
* : GPS (Global Positioning System) is a position detecting system utilizing the signals from GPS satellites  
deployed by the U.S. Defense Department.  
Beep sound and voice guidance restrictions while  
using Bluetooth Hands-Free (Mazda CX-9 only)  
The beep sound and voice guidance related to the navigation system operation are not heard  
while a Bluetooth Hands-Free is being used.  
Screens  
Screens displayed in this manual may differ from those on the actual display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8
Names and Functions  
The navigation system can be operated by pressing a button on the panel (panel button) or  
selecting a button displayed on the screen (on-screen button).  
Mazda CX-9  
5
10  
6
7
11  
8
1
9
2
13  
12  
3
4
Panel button  
On-screen button  
3
Panel button  
4
Mazda CX-7  
2
1
5
6
10  
7
8
9
11  
12  
13  
Panel button  
On-screen button Panel button  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9
1. FM/AM button:  
FM/AM broadcast reception. Each time the button is pressed,  
the reception mode switches through three reception modes:  
FM 1  
FM 2  
AM.  
2. SAT button:  
3. CD button:  
SIRIUS digital satellite radio reception.  
CD playback.  
4. MEDIA button:  
Image and Sound playback is possible using a portable video  
player connected to an external input terminal.*1  
Sound playback is possible using an audio player connected to  
an external input terminal.*1  
AUX1: External sound  
AUX2: External image  
5. LOAD/EJECT button:  
CD loading and ejection.  
If the display is left in the lowered position for a certain period  
of time, a beep sound is heard and the display closes  
automatically.  
6. NAVI button*2  
:
Display of the navigation screen and the vehicle's present  
location.  
7. MENU button*2  
:
Menu screen display (various settings).  
8. RTN button*2  
9. DISP button:  
:
Button used to return to the previous screen.  
Screen brightness/contrast mode selection and adjustment  
display.  
10.POWER/VOLUME button: The volume can be adjusted by turning the dial. Turn the audio  
unit off by pressing the dial.  
11.TUNE/SEEK button:  
Performs tuning (short press) and searching (long press) in  
FM/AM mode. Performs track skip (short press) and fast-  
forward/reverse (long press) in CD mode.  
12.SCAN button:  
13.AUDIO button:  
Performs scanning operation in FM/AM and CD modes.  
Audio unit-related operation screen display (preset display of  
FM and AM).  
The on-screen touch button "SOUND" is constantly displayed  
at the bottom of the audio unit-related screen for displaying the  
sound quality adjustment screen when selected.  
*1 : The external input terminal is not equipped on your vehicle  
because it is not standard equipment.  
*2 : For navigation unit operation  
Note  
l If there is no response after selecting the on-screen button, remove your finger from the  
screen and select it again.  
l On-screen buttons that cannot be operated are not illuminated.  
Select the on-screen button lightly with your finger.  
Selecting the on-screen buttons using objects that have a hard or sharp end such  
as a ball point pen or mechanical pencil could cause a malfunction.  
Caution  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10  
MEMO  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
Activation  
Insert the map disc into the unit to start the Mobile Navigation System.  
n Map Disc  
l Refer to “Handling and Care of Map Discs” to know how to handle a map  
Cautions  
disc (  
page 60).  
Note  
l The map disc cannot be inserted or ejected while the ignition switch is in the OFF position.  
l Remember that the battery can run down if the ignition switch is kept in the ACC or ON  
position for a long time while the engine not running.  
Remove the cover.  
Note  
(Mazda CX-9 only)  
1
l The main unit is located on the right side of the  
cargo sub-compartment under the trunk board.  
(Mazda CX-9)  
The main unit is located under the front passenger  
seat. (Mazda CX-7)  
l Condensation may form on the optical lens or the  
map disc inside the unit when the temperature in  
the vehicle increases in a short time such as when  
Cover  
heating the car on a cold day. This condensation  
may cause malfunctions. If so, unload the map disc  
and do not operate the unit for approximately 1  
hour. Wipe the condensation off the map disc with a  
soft cloth.  
If the unit does not operate correctly after 1 hour,  
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Insert the map disc  
with the printed side  
facing up.  
2
(CAUTION) screen  
Note  
l When the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON  
position, the screen changes as follows to activate  
the navigation system.  
l The screen (audio or navigation) that was displayed  
prior to the engine being turned off is displayed.  
Before the navigation screen is displayed, the  
CAUTION screen will be displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
12  
Read the CAUTION  
carefully, and select  
Most functions are inhibited while the  
vehicle is in motion.  
3
the  
on-screen  
Please read the handbook for operation  
instructions.  
Caution  
button.  
Always obey traffic regulations.  
l The Current Position screen appears.  
Note  
l You can select the language by selecting the  
change the selected language using Language Selection. (  
on-screen button. You can also  
page 22)  
l The CAUTION screen remains on the display unless you select the  
on-screen  
button.  
(Mazda CX-9)  
If the mobile telephone is programmed to the hands-free unit for use with the Bluetooth  
hands-free telephone, the Bluetooth hands-free information is displayed on the screen  
momentarily. While this information is displayed, the  
on-screen button cannot be  
selected. Select the on-screen button after the display is cleared.  
Removing the Map Disc  
With the ignition switch in the ACC position, remove the cover.  
Mazda CX-7  
1
2
Mazda CX-9  
Bracket  
Screw  
Cover  
Screw  
Press  
(EJECT).  
Do not get your hand or fingers caught in  
moving parts or in the disc slot. This can  
cause injuries. Children are inquisitive, try  
to install or remove the map disc without  
infants looking on.  
Caution  
On-screen Buttons  
Select the on-screen button lightly with your finger.  
Colors for unavailable buttons will be pale.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13  
Set Clock  
The current time is set using this function. Since time notification is provided by a GPS  
satellite.  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open the [SET CLOCK] screen  
Select  
if you prefer 24-hour display;  
for 12-hour display.  
Select  
to move the setting ahead by one hour,  
and similarly, select  
hour.  
to move it back by one  
How to exit  
.
Note  
Minutes and seconds are adjusted by the GPS, however, it is necessary to  
adjust hours under the following conditions:  
l Driving across different time zones  
l Daylight saving time start and end  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14  
Navigation Set Up  
l You can alter the map display conditions, the route guidance conditions and show the  
system information.  
n Stop your vehicle before the following operations.  
Do not change the settings and destination locations while driving. Minimize the time  
spent viewing the monitor screen and listening to the voice guidance while driving.  
Operating the system will distract the driver from looking ahead of the vehicle and may  
Warning  
cause an accident.  
Always stop the vehicle in a safe location and put the parking brake on before operating  
the system.  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open  
(
(
(
page 20)  
page 22)  
page 16)  
[NAVIGATION SET UP]  
(
(
(
page 24)  
page 18)  
page 23)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
15  
Language  
Navigation Set Up  
You can change the language of the menu and the voice guidance.  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
select  
Open the [LANGUAGE] screen  
Select your preferred language from the list.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
16  
MEMO  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
17  
Calibration  
Navigation Set Up  
This function allows you to correct any error in the position or direction of your vehicle display.  
MENU  
select  
Before Steps  
Adjusting Current Position and Direction  
select  
Open the [Calibrate Position] screen  
Move to the correct position and select  
.
Use  
or  
to adjust the direction in which you are  
heading, and select  
.
Distance  
This function automatically corrects any error in the display of the current  
position that might occur after tire replacement.  
select  
You will have to drive about 6 miles (10 km) before distance correction is complete.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
18  
select  
Map Version  
The map and software version numbers can be confirmed using this function.  
select  
Map and software versions are now displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
19  
User Setting  
Navigation Set Up  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
select  
Open the  
n Map Color  
[USERSETTINGS]  
screen  
Select a screen color from  
to  
options.  
n Map Mode  
l Auto : The display will automatically switch between Day  
and Night illumination mode when the headlights are  
turned off and on respectively.  
l Day  
:
The display will be presented in Day illumination mode  
regardless of whether the headlights are on or off.  
l
Night : The display will be presented in Night illumination mode  
regardless of whether the headlights are on or off.  
n Distance  
Select the distance unit from  
or  
.
n Average Speed  
Set the average speed for each road to be driven.  
(This function sets the standard speed (average vehicle speed  
for each route) used for calculating the estimated arrival time  
when calculating the route time.)  
:
Average speed setting  
:Changes back to default  
n Road Restriction Warnings  
The display of warnings during route guidance when passing  
through areas with traffic restrictions can be turned on or off.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
20  
User Setting  
Navigation Set Up  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
select  
Open the  
n Arrival Time  
[USERSETTINGS]  
screen  
The time which is displayed until reaching the destination or a  
way point can be set as an estimated arrival time or the  
remaining time.  
Select  
to display the estimated arrival time, or  
to  
display the remaining time.  
n Keyboard Layout  
The layout of input keys can be selected as  
or  
.
n Clock  
Allows selection of whether clock is to be displayed.  
When the time display setting is switched on in the "USER  
SETTINGS" screen on the navigation screen, the time will be  
displayed on the navigation, SETTINGS, SOUND, LOAD/  
EJECT, and DISPLAY MODE screens.  
Even if the display of the clock on the navigation is not set, the  
clock on the information display remains displayed.  
n Beep  
Allows selection of whether beep will sound.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21  
Quick POI Selection  
Navigation Set Up  
This function allows you set the categories on the area displayed when the (Point of Interest)  
menu is selected on the map. Quick POI enables you store up to six different kinds of  
categories which you use most regularly.  
select  
MENU  
1
2
Select  
Open the [QUICK POI SELECTION] screen  
Select the button for Quick POI storage.  
Note  
l Select the category to be changed  
:This button allows you to restore the factory  
settings.  
Select a category.  
Once selected, subcategories will be displayed.  
:Subcategories from all of the  
individual categories will be  
displayed together.  
Select the subcategories to be displayed on the  
map.  
Repeat the above steps to add further POI markers displayed on the menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
22  
Restore System Defaults  
Navigation Set Up  
This function replaces all the settings in the mobile navigation system with the initial default  
settings.  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
select  
Open the [SYSTEM DEFAULTS] screen  
Select  
.
If you execute Restore System Defaults, all of your stored setting data will be deleted.  
[Default List]  
Item  
Initial condition  
Menu names  
Map Orientation  
North up  
Map display mode  
Single-screen display  
Map Display scale/Map scale for Dual-screen is not object of backup.  
Display guidance language  
Quick-POI map display  
Single-screen: 10,000 map (1/16 mi)  
English  
All Off  
Quick-POI Selection  
A : Gas station  
B : ATM  
C : Police Station  
D : Grocery store  
E : All Restaurant  
F : Hotel  
Search Area  
US9 (including Washington DC)  
Map Color  
1
Day/Night/Auto Setting  
Distance Units (Miles/KM) (Global setting)  
Volume Presets  
Auto  
Miles  
4
Time display change (12h/24h)  
Keyboard layout  
Arrival Time  
Navigation Setup (Clock)  
Navigation Setup (Beep)  
Map Configuration  
Freeway Information  
Junction Detail  
24h  
ABC  
Time  
Off  
On  
Off  
ON  
Map screen  
Turn Guidance Screen  
Single  
Turn List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
23  
Map Configuration  
Navigation Set Up  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
select  
Open the  
[MAP  
CONFIGURATION]  
screen  
n Map Screen  
Select single or dual map display.  
Single map  
Dual map  
n Turn Guidance  
Turn Arrow (on first screen)  
While using route guidance, the  
directions for the next junction where  
you have to turn are shown as a Turn  
Arrow in the upper right.  
Turn List  
While using route guidance, the  
directions for the next junction where  
you have to turn are shown as a Turn  
List.  
Turn Arrow (on second screen)  
While using route guidance, the  
directions for the next junction where  
you have to turn are shown as Turn  
Arrow.  
Note  
Before a fork in the road, an enlarged diagram of the junction automatically  
appears in a second screen.This is to make route guidance even clearer.  
n Junction Detail  
Select whether the Enlarged Junction diagram screen is  
displayed automatically.  
n Freeway Information  
Allows selection of whether the guidance screen is to be  
displayed while driving on a freeway.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
24  
Screen Names and Functions  
Screens Before Setting Route  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4)  
MAP SCROLL  
(5)  
(7)  
(11)  
(12)  
NAVI  
(6)  
(9)  
(8) (10)  
(1) Map Orientation control  
(7) Current Road Name  
(
page 29)  
Shows the name of the road you are  
currently driving on.  
(2) GPS (Global Positioning System) marker  
(
page 54)  
(8) Set Destination button  
(3) Clock  
The destination, memory point or way point  
Clock will be displayed when you set up  
Clock on Navigation Set Up On.  
(4) Vehicle marker  
will be set at the position pointed by  
scroll screen.  
in the  
(9) Store Memory Point button  
Stores markers on the map.  
(10) Quick POI Display button  
Shows the current position and  
direction of your vehicle.  
(5) Scale display  
(
page 38)  
Displays the scale of the map.  
(6) Distance from current position  
Displays the distance from the current  
(11) Zoom in  
(
page 29)  
(12) Zoom out  
position to the position pointed by  
.
(
page 29)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
25  
Screens During Route Guidance  
(3)  
(2)  
(1)  
(4)  
(1) Distance and Time to Destination display (3) Turn Arrow display  
Displays the time* and distance to the  
destination or way point.  
Shows the direction to turn at the next  
junction and the distance to the junction.  
Selecting this will display the next and  
further information on the way point or  
time and distance to the destination.  
(* Either required time or estimated time  
arrival)  
(4) Route Preferences button  
(
page 42)  
(2) Route display  
Shows the provided route as a thick  
blue line.  
Menu  
Menu appears when pressing  
.
MENU  
Destination Entry and Route Search (  
page 30)  
Address Book (  
Cancel Guidance (  
Route Options (  
page 46)  
page 41)  
page 42)  
Volume (  
Set Clock (  
page 52)  
page 14)  
Navigation Set Up (  
page 15)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
26  
Screen adjustments, beep alert and other settings  
Display menu screen will be shown when you press the (DISP) button.  
Press the (DISP) button to display the display menu.  
n Adjusting the screen quality  
l Screen brightness  
Press the  
l Screen contrast  
Press the  
on-screen button to brighten the screen, or  
to darken.  
to decrease.  
on-screen button to increase contrast,  
Note  
l
Select the  
on-screen button to restore the adjustment values to the default settings.  
l The screen changes to SETTINGS when the  
on-screen button is selected.  
n Turning off the display  
Select the  
on-screen button to turn off the display.  
The screen will reappear if the (NAVI) button is pressed, or the  
on-screen  
button, which is displayed on the screen when the (DISP) button is pressed, is selected.  
n Daytime/Night screen  
When the headlights are on, daytime mode can also be selected (Daytime mode can also  
be selected while the headlights are turned on.).  
n Tilt display operation  
Select the  
on-screen button to tilt the display,  
to close it.  
The display angle can be adjusted in three stages.  
When opening, the display angle changes one stage at a time each time the  
screen button is pressed.  
on-  
When closing, the display angle changes one stage at a time each time the  
button is pressed.  
on-screen  
Press the (DISP) button followed by the  
settings menu.  
on-screen button to display the  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
27  
n Returning to the navigation screen from the audio unit screen  
l Select the on-screen button to set the function to return to the navigation screen  
from the audio unit screen by operation of the button only.  
l Select the  
on-screen button to set the function to return to the navigation screen  
from the audio unit screen automatically after 20 seconds.  
n Beep sound settings  
l Select the  
on-screen button to activate the operation beep sound.  
l Select the  
on-screen button to deactivate the operation beep sound.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
28  
Changing the Map Orientation/Scale  
Screen change  
n Do not keep your eyes fixed on the monitor screen or operate the system  
while driving  
Do not change the settings and destination locations while driving. Minimize the time  
spent viewing the monitor screen and listening to the voice guidance while driving.  
Operating the system will distract the driver from looking ahead of the vehicle and may  
cause an accident. Always stop the vehicle in a safe location and use the parking brake  
before operating the system.  
Warning  
l North Up: Geographic north is up.  
Select  
,
on-  
1
1
screen button.  
Map  
orientation  
l
Head Up: The direction you are  
heading is up.  
l ZOOM OUT  
Select or on-screen  
button.  
l The map can be displayed in  
13 steps with scales from  
to  
.
l ZOOM IN  
Map scale  
(more detail.)  
Position before change  
<Scale bar>  
Imperial 1/32 mi  
display (mile)  
1/4 mi  
(mile)  
2 mi  
(mile)  
16 mi  
(mile)  
128 mi  
(mile)  
Metric  
display  
50 m  
500 m  
4 km  
32 km  
256 km  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
29  
Destination Entry and Route Search  
l You can set the destination using various methods provided by the system.  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open the [DESTINATION  
ENTRY] Menu  
Change  
(Change  
Search Area)  
Select  
Open the  
[DESTINATION  
ENTRY] Menu  
Select  
When narrowing  
down to city name  
Select  
Address  
When narrowing  
down to street name  
Select  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
30  
l
l
Do not keep your eyes fixed on the monitor screen or operate the system while driving.  
Do not change the settings and destination locations while driving. Minimize the time spent  
viewing the monitor screen and listening to the voice guidance while driving. Operating the system  
will distract the driver from looking ahead of the vehicle and may cause an accident. Always stop  
the vehicle in a safe location before operating the system.  
Route searches with the navigation system can include roads that you cannot drive on and roads that you  
are prohibited from driving on due to traffic regulations. Please comply with the traffic regulations.  
Warnings  
Select the desired Search Area  
: ID, OR, WA,  
: AR, AL, LA, MS, TN  
: CA, NV  
: CT, MA, ME, NH, NJ, NY, RI, VT  
: DC, DE, MD, PA, VA, WV  
: FL, GA, NC, SC  
: AZ, CO, MT, NM, UT, WY  
: IA, KS, MN, MO, ND, NE, SD  
: OK, TX  
: CANADA  
: IL, IN, KY, MI, OH, WI  
:
Cancel the  
city selection.  
Select  
the  
Enter  
the  
Select  
:
Direct  
destination  
input  
Enter  
Select  
Displays list of  
the  
the  
5 city name  
s
city  
street  
name  
and  
street  
name  
from  
the  
house  
no.  
n
earest the  
name  
from  
the  
(
current  
position.  
page 40)  
select  
list  
list  
Select  
the  
Enter  
the  
Select the  
street name  
from the list  
:
Enter  
the  
Displays the  
city name  
city  
street  
name  
and  
city  
input screen.  
name  
from  
the  
name  
and  
select  
select  
list  
Enter  
the  
house  
no.  
Select  
Enter the  
street  
name and  
select  
Select the  
street name  
from the list  
Select the city  
name from the  
list  
l
For Character Entry, please refer to page 39.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
31  
Destination Entry and Route Search  
When entering  
Open the  
[DESTINATION  
ENTRY] Menu  
Select  
the destination  
point directly  
Select  
When narrowing  
down to city  
name  
Select  
When narrowing  
down to  
Point of  
interest  
category name  
Select  
When narrowing  
down to the  
nearest facility  
Select  
When narrowing  
down to a phone  
number  
Select  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
32  
Enter the  
POI name  
and select  
Select the  
POI from  
the list  
:
Cancel the  
city selection.  
Select the  
city name  
from the  
list  
:
Displays list of  
5 city names  
nearest the  
current  
Select  
position.  
Enter the  
city name  
andselect  
Select the  
city name  
from the  
list  
:
Displays the  
city name  
input screen.  
Select the  
category  
name from  
the list  
Select the  
city center  
name from  
the list and  
select  
Enter the city  
center name  
and select  
: Searches  
for facilities close to the  
nearest city hall.  
: Searches  
for facilities near the current  
position.  
Select the  
Category  
name from  
the list and  
select  
Select  
Scroll the map  
as necessary  
and select  
: Searches for  
facilities near the current  
position.  
Select the  
facility from  
the list and  
:
Searches for registered  
facilities at the destinations.  
select  
Enter the phone number  
and select  
l
For Character Entry, please refer to page 39.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
33  
Destination Entry and Route Search  
When stopped  
Select  
Displays the police  
station select screen.  
Displays the hospital  
select screen.  
When driving  
Emergency  
Sets the destination to the  
nearest police station  
automatically.  
Sets the destination to the  
nearest hospital  
automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
34  
Select the  
name from  
the list  
Select the sort methods  
Select  
: Sorts the police station or  
the hospital by Distance.  
: Sorts the police station or  
the hospital by name.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
35  
Destination Entry and Route Search  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Select  
Open the  
[DESTINATION  
ENTRY] Menu  
Memory Point  
Select  
Select  
Home  
Preset Destination  
Previous Destination  
Intersection  
Select  
Select  
Select  
Freeway On/  
Off Ramp  
Select  
Select  
Coordinates  
Select from  
map  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
36  
Select the desired Memory Point  
: Display up to five previous suggestions.  
: Display the five previous suggestions.  
: The order of the displayed list can be changed.  
Select the desired Preset Destination.  
Select the Previous Destination.  
Direct destination  
input  
Select the 2nd street  
Select the 1st  
street name  
name  
(
page 40)  
Select the  
name of the  
freeway  
Select the  
desired the  
On Ramp or  
the Off Ramp  
name.  
Select  
or  
Enter the latitude  
Enter the longitude  
Select  
: degrees  
: minutes  
: seconds  
l
For Character Entry, please refer to page 39.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
37  
Quick POI  
l You can select one of the Six Categories on the menu or List Categories and then select the  
POI(s) to be displayed on the map.  
Select  
Before Steps  
Select the  
Open the  
[QUICK POI]  
categories to be  
displayed up to a  
maximum of five.  
l POI icon chart  
Displaying  
POI(s) on a  
Map  
(
page 41)  
For categories  
other than the six  
displayed, select  
and  
select them from  
the list shown.  
Select the POI  
you want to find  
from the listed  
categories.  
After you make a  
selection, the point of  
interest you selected  
appears on the map.  
: Search POI  
Local  
Search  
along the route  
during the guidance  
and show the list.  
Deleting  
POI  
Markers  
Displaying POI(s) on a Map (  
above)  
Before Steps  
Display the POI.  
Select the desired  
POI by moving  
top of the POI icon.  
The name of the selected  
POI appears.  
Select  
on  
(Information)  
The POI(s) data is  
displayed.  
Showing  
POI Data  
If no data is stored for the  
selected POI, the POI  
name is not displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
38  
Character Entry  
Select the first several characters  
Select your target  
in the list.  
on the screen. (Step 1)  
Names of which spelling starts  
with the entered character appear.  
l If a desired name is not in  
the list, go back to Step 1,  
and try fewer characters.  
Select  
Select  
Select  
:
Display up to five previous  
suggestions.  
Select  
:
Display the previous  
suggestions.  
:
:
Text flow (Right)  
Text flow (Left)  
Street name,  
city name,  
and other  
input  
:
The order of the displayed list  
can be changed. (Displayed  
list varies or  
may not be  
:
:
Move the cursor to the previous  
position and delete a character.  
The list appears.  
displayed depending on what  
was input.)  
:
Additional text can be input.  
(Use when inputting  
additional characters after  
the list is displayed.)  
l Examples  
Street: CANAL  
Street: 52nd Ave.  
Enter by selecting characters:  
Enter by selecting characters:  
C A  
5 2 n d  
A
Street: MAIN STREET  
Enter by selecting characters:  
M A I N  
S
Select the characters on  
the screen.  
Select  
Housephone  
number, and  
other input  
:Move the cursor to  
the previous position  
and delete a  
character.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
39  
Direct Destination Input  
Touch the map to set the  
cursor to the desired  
1
destination.The map  
scrolls faster the further  
away the touched  
location is from the  
cursor.  
Scroll the map and change the map  
scale if necessary.  
Select  
2
Direct  
Destination  
Select  
.
Input  
Route calculation will be carried out and the entire route  
will be displayed on the map.  
3
4
Select  
on your route (  
points per trip.  
(Way point) to set the address as a way point  
page 46). You can set up to 5 way-  
Select  
.
Route guidance begins using displayed route.  
Note  
l If your desired route cannot be found,  
(Route  
Options) allows the route option settings to be changed.  
page 42)  
(
l Selecting  
for five seconds or more will launch the  
Demo mode.  
Operate after Step 3 of [Direct Destination Input]  
The calculation route can be selected from one of three  
types namely, Quick (the fastest route), Altern. (the  
standard route), or Short (the shortest route).  
4
5
Selecting  
Route  
Select  
(Information).  
Details regarding the individual routes (i.e., required time  
total distance, roads used, etc.)  
Select either  
,
, or  
, and then select  
when you have decided  
on the route to be used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
40  
POI Icons on Maps / Delete Destination  
n POI (Point of Interest) Icons  
The following are POI icons shown on maps.  
Restaurant  
All restaurants  
Travel  
Community  
Convention Center  
Bus Station  
Ferry Terminal  
Hotel  
American  
Chinese  
Court House  
Government Offices  
Higher Education  
Hospital  
Continental  
Fast Food  
French  
Rental Car Agency  
Rest Area  
Train Station  
Library  
Park & Recreation  
(All Search Areas)  
Airport (All Search  
Areas)  
Italian  
Japanese  
Mexican  
Police Office  
School  
Recreation  
Casino  
Seafood  
City Center  
Golf Course  
Thai  
Historical  
Banking  
Monument  
Other Restaurants  
Bank  
ATM  
Marina  
Shopping  
Museum  
Grocery Store  
Shopping Mall  
Ski Resort  
Other  
Sports Complex  
Performing Arts  
Business Facility  
Automotive  
Tourist Attraction  
(All Search Areas)  
Automobile Club  
Gas Station  
Parking  
Tourist Information  
Winery  
Auto Service &  
Maintenance  
Amusement Park  
(All Search Areas)  
Delete  
destination  
MENU  
Select  
Select  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
41  
l During route guidance you can  
change the route options, stop or  
check the route.  
Route Options  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open the  
[ROUTE  
Select  
OPTIONS] Menu  
Route  
Preferences  
Select the  
Select  
button for the  
location to be  
modified.  
Modification  
of Destination  
or Way Point  
Positions  
Select the way points  
to change the order.  
Change the destination  
and the passing order of  
the destination and way  
points.  
Select the button  
Deletion of  
Destinationor  
Way Points  
corresponding to the  
destination or way  
point to be deleted.  
Select  
Select  
Detour  
The Enter Route  
screen appears.  
Turn List  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
42  
n
Do not keep your eyes fixed on the monitor screen or operate the system while driving  
Do not change the settings and destination locations while driving. Minimize the time spent  
viewing the monitor screen and listening to the voice guidance while driving. Operating the system  
will distract the driver from looking ahead of the vehicle and may cause an accident. Always stop  
the vehicle in a safe location and use the parking brake before operating the system.  
Warning  
Select  
or  
for toll  
NAVI  
roads, major roads, ferry,  
and restricted roads.  
The route will not necessarily follow  
the specified conditions.  
Select  
(Change  
Location).  
Move  
to location and then  
.
select  
Shows the map for the  
destination/way points.  
Press  
order.  
to change the  
NAVI  
NAVI  
:
Select  
:Cancel the deletion  
:
Searches the detour routes at one, three, and five miles from  
the present position to the selected routes. (Display range  
varies according to the set distance of the selected route.)  
Whole Route searches the route that detours from the  
present position for all routes.  
Select  
the roads to be  
avoided.  
from  
:
NAVI  
:Cancel the setting  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
43  
Route Options  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open the  
[ROUTE  
OPTIONS] Menu  
Select  
Select  
Display  
Preview  
Route  
Preview  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
44  
Use the buttons displayed on-screen to carry out a simulation run.  
: Move to the start point.  
:
Carry out a simulation run in the direction of the start point. When the Simulation starts the button  
will be displayed as , and when selected, it will cause the Simulation to advance quickly.  
: Stop the simulation run.  
: Carry out a simulation run in the direction of the destination. When the Simulation starts the button  
will be displayed as  
, and when selected, it will cause the Simulation to advance quickly.  
: Move to the destination.  
: Displays the [EDIT ROUTE PREVIEW] screen.  
: Stops at the destination or the next way-point.  
Stops at a point of interest which has been setup on the route.  
RTN  
:
: Delete the POI which has been selected.  
POIs: Display the six POIs from Quick-POI storage. When one of these is selected,  
it will be displayed on the map; furthermore,  
can be selected to  
display items other than shown here. For more details, refer to page 22.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
45  
l You can, edit, or delete any  
marked point.  
Address Book  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open the  
[ADDRESS  
BOOK]  
Memory Point  
Storage  
Select  
MemoryPoint  
Confirmation  
and  
Modification  
Preset  
Destinations  
or Home  
Storage  
Memory  
Point  
Deletion  
All Memory  
Point  
Deletion  
Show all  
icon  
or  
Displays  
Icons at  
Memory  
Points  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
46  
Set a memory  
point using your  
preferred method.  
Select a memory  
point to be  
modified  
: Allows the display icon to be  
selected. Page 1 and 2 contain  
standard icons, whereas the  
With Sound page contains icons  
which also playback sounds.  
(With direction icon function)  
The beep alert only activates  
when the vehicle approaches to  
within about 500m of the memory  
point from the set direction.  
: Allows the name to be changed.  
When editing has been  
completed, select  
.
Furthermore, select  
to  
display names on the map, or  
if these names are not to  
be displayed.  
: Allows memory points to be  
checked and modified on the  
map screen. After checking.  
: Allows the telephone number to  
be modified. When editing has  
been completed, select  
.
:
: Changes the category to  
Preset Destinations  
Select a memory  
point to be stored  
in Preset  
Destinations or  
Home.  
Allows the storage  
category to be  
changed. Select the  
buttoncorresponding  
to the new category.  
: Changes the category to  
Home  
Select a memory  
point to be  
deleted.  
: Cancel the deletion.  
: Cancel the deletion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
47  
Address Book  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open the  
[ADDRESS  
BOOK]  
AvoidArea  
Storage  
Select  
Avoid Area  
Confirmation  
and  
Modification  
Avoid Area  
Deletion  
All Avoid  
Area  
Deletion  
Category  
Name  
Modification  
Select  
Previous  
Destination  
Deletion  
All Preset  
Destination  
Deletion  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
48  
: Reduces the size of the  
avoid area.  
: Increases the size of  
the avoid area.  
Select an avoid  
area using your  
preferred method.  
Select an avoid area  
to be modified.  
:
Allows the name to be  
changed. When editing has  
been completed, select  
. Furthermore, select  
to display names on  
the map, or  
if these  
names are not to be  
displayed.  
: Allows avoid area  
to be checked and  
modified on the  
map screen.  
Extends  
the  
detour  
range  
After checking.  
Shorten  
s the  
detour  
range  
Select an avoid  
area to be deleted.  
: Cancel the deletion.  
Cancel the deletion.  
:
Select a destination to  
be deleted.  
: Cancel the deletion.  
: The order of the  
displayed list can be  
changed.  
: Cancel the deletion.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
49  
l
Voice control can be carried out by simply  
Pressing VOICE switch on the steering wheel  
switch and using a voice command  
Voice Recognition  
(
page 51) spoken into the microphone.  
l Microphone surface  
Voice entry recognition.  
Mazda CX-9  
Mazda CX-7  
Voice  
Recognition  
Structure  
Microphone  
l VOICE switch on the steering wheel switch  
Use for switching to voice recognition or canceling.  
VOICE Switch  
Set up the language in advance.  
Press  
MENU  
1
2
select  
select  
Language  
Select  
select  
Select your preferred language from the list.  
3
Note  
To return to current position screen, press  
.
NAVI  
Press VOICE switch on the steering wheel switch.  
Speak the desired voice command.  
Basic  
1
2
Usage  
Pattern  
Long press VOICE switch on the steering wheel switch.  
(Press it more than 0.7 second.)  
Cancel  
Voice  
1
Recognition  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
50  
Avoiding Voice Recognition Errors.  
Read the notes listed below to allow the Voice Recognition function to recognize your voice properly.  
l Speak a voice command clearly.  
l Keep yourself in a safe driving position. Do not face or approach the microphone to make  
your voice command recognizable.  
Voice recognition may fail to recognize your command due to voice tone. If this happens,  
change the tone of your voice by speaking more loudly and clearly.  
Keep the inside of the vehicle quiet when making a voice command. Your command may be compromised  
by noises made by people, blinkers, the horn, vehicle vibration, and noises from outside the vehicle.  
l
l Use the language you selected in voice recognition.  
Please be aware that the voice recognition may error or not function despite following the above points.  
Note  
VOICE switch cannot be used while a Bluetooth Hands-Free is being used. (Mazda CX-9 only)  
Voice Recognition Command  
The following voice commands can be used with voice control.  
School  
(Go to/Previous) Starting Point  
[Go to] Previous Destination  
[Go to] Preset Destination [Number] 1  
[Go to] Preset Destination [Number] 2  
[Go to] Preset Destination [Number] 3  
[Go to] Preset Destination [Number] 4  
[Go to] Preset Destination [Number] 5  
Cancel  
Shortcut Commands  
[Show] Current (Position/Location)  
[Show] Map  
Repeat [Voice] [Guidance]  
Cancel  
Map Operation Commands  
Zoom In  
Zoom Out  
Zoom In Maximum  
Zoom Out Maximum  
Right Map Zoom In  
Right Map Zoom Out  
Right Map (Zoom In Maximum/  
Minimum Scale)  
Right Map (Zoom Out Maximum/Maximum Scale)  
[Change to/Show] North up [Mode]  
[Change to/Show] Heading up [Mode]  
[Change] Map Direction  
Right Map [Change to/Show] North up [Mode]  
Right Map [Change to/Show] Heading Up [Mode]  
Right Map [Change Map] Direction  
[Show/Change to] Dual Map [Mode]  
[Show/Change to] Single Map [Mode]  
(Store/Mark) [This Point]  
POI Display Commands  
Automobile Club  
Amusement Park  
Casino  
Golf Course  
Historical Monument  
Marina  
Museum  
Ski Resort/Skiing  
Sports Complex/Stadium  
Performing Arts  
Tourist Attraction  
Tourist Information  
Winery  
Restaurant/I'm Hungry/Show Restaurant  
American Restaurant/American Food  
Chinese Restaurant/Chinese Food  
Continental Restaurant/  
Continental Food  
Fast Food/Fast Food Restaurant  
French Restaurant/French Food  
Italian Restaurant/Italian Food  
Japanese Restaurant/Japanese Food  
Mexican Restaurant/Mexican Food  
Seafood Restaurant/Seafood  
Thai Restaurant/Thai Food  
Other Restaurant/Other Food  
Grocery Store  
Shopping Mall  
Airport  
Bus Station  
Ferry Terminal  
Hotel  
Rental Car Agency  
Rest Area  
Train Station  
Business Facility  
Guidance Commands  
Louder  
Softer  
[Show] (Whole/Entire) Route [Map]  
[Show] Next Way Point [Map]  
Show First Way Point [Map]  
Show Second Way Point [Map]  
Show Third Way Point [Map]  
Show Fourth Way Point [Map]  
Show Fifth Way Point [Map]  
Show Destination [Map]  
(Delete/Cancel) Next Way Point  
Yes  
No  
(Delete/Cancel) Destination  
(Delete/Cancel) All Way Points and  
Destination  
Voice Guidance Off  
Voice Guidance On  
Quick  
Alternative  
Short  
Detour  
Gas Station/Gas  
Parking/Parking Lot/Parking Garage/Car Park  
Auto Service & Maintenance/Auto Service  
ATM  
Bank  
Detour Entire Route  
Town Center/City Center  
Convention Center/Exhibition Center  
Court House  
Government Offices  
Higher Education/University/College  
Hospital  
[Change to] Arrow (Guide/Guidance)  
[Change to] Turn List (Guide/Guidance)  
[Change to] Freeway (Guide/Guidance)  
[Change to] Intersection (Guide/Guidance)  
Display Commands  
display [set] day [mode]  
display [set] night [mode]  
display [set] auto [mode]  
POI Off  
Destination Operation Commands  
[Go] Home  
Library  
Parks & Recreation/Park & Recreation  
Police Station  
Enter Destination  
Add to Waypoint  
( ): Indicates the commands to be the object of “/”  
[]: Recognizes without saying the command in “[]”  
“/”: Recognizes when saying either commands before and after “/”  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
51  
Volume Adjustment  
You can adjust the volume control for the voice guidance.  
select  
MENU  
Before Steps  
Open the [VOLUME] screen  
Select the appropriate button to set the  
volume to between (minimum) and  
(maximum).  
1
2
:Sound output will be muted.  
Press the (NAVI) button to return to the  
current vehicle position screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
52  
Precautions/System Performance  
Voice Guidance  
l The navigation system is just a support system for the driver. The driver should  
always pay attention to the traffic situation to safely make decisions. You may  
be unable at times to arrive at your destination due to out-of-date information  
on a map disc. You should be especially careful when selecting an urgent  
destination such as a hospital or a police station.  
Warnings  
l Your route may sometimes include roads that are not open to vehicles or are  
closed due to traffic regulations. Please comply with the local traffic  
regulations.  
l Do not change the settings and destination locations while driving. Minimize  
the time spent viewing the monitor screen and listening to the voice guidance  
while driving. Operating the system will distract the driver from looking ahead  
of the vehicle and may cause an accident. Always stop the vehicle in a safe  
location and use the parking brake before operating the system.  
Voice guidance has the following functions:  
n Intersection guidance  
l The system voice announces the distance to an upcoming turn and the turning direction.  
This guidance function is automatic. Therefore, you do not have to set it, and it cannot be  
disabled.  
l The system vocally announces the distance to an upcoming highway branching point or  
junction.  
Route  
Second branching point  
First branching point  
150m  
Roundabout.  
Take the second  
exit.  
Left turn ahead,  
then right turn.  
100m  
In 700m left turn.  
When two intersections are close together, the  
voice guidance may be late.  
When two roundabouts are close together, the  
voice guidance for the second may be late.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
53  
GPS  
GPS is a position detecting system utilizing the signals  
from GPS satellites deployed by the U.S. Department of  
Defense. The Mobile Navigation System uses input from  
three or more satellites and calculates the vehicle position  
based on the principle of triangulation.  
The positioning accuracy of the system corresponds to the  
error display of the GPS which is from about 30 to 200 meters  
.
l If you are using the system for the first time, or if you have not used it for some time, it takes  
about 5 minutes (or about 2 minutes in open areas) to calculate your vehicle’s position.  
n GPS signal reception is poor in the following places  
In tunnels  
Among high-rise buildings Under elevated roads  
In wooded areas  
l The GPS satellites are controlled by the U.S. Defense Department, which may intentionally  
lower positioning accuracy. In such cases, there may be vehicle position deviations.  
l There may be vehicle position deviations for some time until GPS signals are received after  
turning on the ignition.  
Map Matching  
This function compares your vehicle’s tracking data with the road data on the map  
disc, applies dead reckoning to determine the road you are driving on, and displays  
your vehicle on that road on the map.  
l Intelligent map matching addresses the following problems to achieve high accuracy in  
vehicle positioning.  
Position Correction for Elevated Roads  
Position accuracy is improved by detecting if the vehicle is  
running on or under an elevated road.  
Position Correction for Parking Garages  
Position accuracy is improved by detecting if the vehicle is  
driving in an elevated or underground parking garage.  
High-precision Gyrosensor  
A gyro detects turns with an accuracy of 0.05° per second.  
Combined with a speed sensor, it enables the system to  
display the current vehicle position even where GPS signals  
may be blocked.  
l Using a spare tire in place of the regular one may cause vehicle position deviations.  
l Any difference between the direction which your vehicle actually travels and that shown on  
the map is automatically eliminated by azimuth correction.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
54  
Precautions/System Performance  
Positioning Accuracy  
In the following situations, your vehicle position may not be displayed correctly on the  
map. But, as you keep driving, your vehicle position will be automatically corrected  
utilizing map matching and GPS data.  
Running on an  
elevated road  
Making a turn after Running on a steep Running on a spiral Entering an intersection  
driving on a long  
straight road  
mountain road  
road  
where a road branches  
off at a small angle  
CAR FERRY  
STOP  
Running on gridiron Running on a  
Snaking on a wide When your vehicle After getting off a  
layout of roads  
slippery road with  
tire chains  
road  
is on a turntable  
with the ignition  
turned off  
ferryboat or vehicle  
train  
Route Guide  
Although you may encounter the following problems in route guide, there is nothing  
wrong with the system.  
In 300 m  
right turn  
Left turn  
ahead  
For certain intersection shapes,  
For certain intersection shapes,  
Voice guidance for the planned  
the upcoming turn or the name of you may be prompted to turn right route may continue even after you  
the intersection may not be  
announced.  
or left When you should actually  
stay on the same road.  
have deviated from that route  
such as having turned too early.  
300m  
In 300 m  
right turn  
0m  
Some points where the road  
The Intersection Zoom Map may The announced distance to an  
divides on highways or toll roads not always agree with the actual  
upcoming turn may differ slightly  
from reality.  
may not be displayed or  
announced.  
shape of the intersection.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
55  
The navigation system is just a support system for the driver. The driver should always pay  
attention to the traffic situation to safely make decisions. You may be unable to arrive at your  
destination due to out-of-date information on a map disc. You should be especially careful  
when selecting an urgent destination such as a hospital or a police station.  
Warning  
Route Search  
Although you may encounter the following problems in a route search, there is nothing  
wrong with the system.  
The guide map may  
It may also show roads  
show roads that are not  
that are out of use due  
passable due to closure  
to the opening of a new  
in winter or for other  
road or for other  
reasons.  
It may also show  
roads that only permit  
one-way traffic.  
reasons.  
Road  
out of  
use  
Destination  
?
?
?
which  
exit?  
Depending upon the shape of  
roundabout (rotary), the guide  
map may show a wrong exit.  
?
• There may be cases  
where the route remains  
unchanged after another  
search.  
• A congested route may  
be shown.  
Destination  
?
?
?
Destination  
It may show a  
common road under  
or over an elevated  
road.  
The route shown only  
reaches a point near  
your destination if your  
destination has no  
direct access road or  
the road is too narrow.  
It may show a route  
where you'll have to  
make a U-turn.  
?
Destination  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
56  
Verification First  
Troubleshooting  
Note  
There may be some problems due to operational errors or mistakes. Please read this manual  
again and verify that there really is a problem before calling an Expert Dealer, we recommend  
an Authorized Mazda Dealer to ask for repair services.  
Symptom  
Check point  
No picture  
l Check if a fuse has blown.  
Consult an Expert Dealer, we recommend an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
l Check if the voltage level of the vehicle battery is low.  
Display does  
not open or  
close  
Recharge the battery or change batteries.  
l Check if the vehicle position changed when ACC was set to  
OFF.  
When, for example,  
The vehicle  
position is not  
correct  
• The vehicle was transported by a ferry boat.  
• The vehicle was rotated on a turn table in a parking lot.  
• The vehicle was transported by a tow track or other such  
vehicle.  
Drive the vehicle for a while where you are receiving  
GPS signals.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
57  
Symptom  
Check point  
No GPS  
symbols are  
displayed  
l GPS signals may not be received because of obstructions.  
After moving the vehicle away from obstructions, the GPS  
signals can be received.  
The vehicle  
position is not  
displayed  
l Check if the mode is set to the current position screen.  
Press  
NAVI  
l Check if the volume control for the voice guidance has been  
turned off.  
l Check if the vehicle is off the route.  
Repeat the route search while checking the route guide  
screen.  
l Check if you are driving the vehicle in the wrong direction on  
No voice  
guidance  
the route.  
Repeat the route search checking the direction of the  
destination.  
Buttons on the  
remote control  
do not beep  
l Check if [Beep] is set to [Off] (  
page 21).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
58  
Error Messages  
Troubleshooting  
Error message  
Solution  
l
The disc is not installed.  
Check if the disk is installed. If installed, check if the  
installed disk is correct.  
Please insert a  
MAP DVD.  
MAP DVD-Read  
Error  
l
The disc is wet, dirty, scratched, or upside down, or the disc  
cannot be played with this unit or the incorrect disk is installed.  
Eject the disc and check it (  
page 13).  
The disc  
installed is not  
a MAP DVD.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
59  
Maintenance  
Care of the Product  
n Cleaning this product  
Use a dry, soft cloth to wipe it.  
n Cautions for cleaning  
Never use solvents such as benzene and thinners, they could mar the surface of the unit.  
n Map disc  
If you require the latest map disc, consult an Expert Dealer, we recommend an Authorized  
Mazda Dealer.  
Handling and Care of Map Discs  
n How to hold the disc  
Label side  
l Do not touch the underside of the disc.  
l Do not scratch the disc.  
l Do not bend the disc.  
l When not in use, keep the disc in the case.  
n Disc Cleaning  
l Use a dry, soft cloth to wipe from the center outward.  
<Right>  
<Wrong>  
n Do not leave discs in the following places:  
l Direct sunlight  
l Near car heaters  
l In dirty, dusty and damp areas  
l On seats and dashboards  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
60  
Contents  
Audio system  
n Audio Operation  
l Operating Tips for Audio system ...................................................62  
(Radio Reception), (Operating Tips for In-Dash CD Changer),  
(Operating tips for MP3), (CD-TEXT)  
l Operating Tips for Display .............................................................68  
l Beep sound and voice guidance restrictions while using Bluetooth  
Hands-Free (Mazda CX-9 only).....................................................68  
l Power/Volume/Sound Controls......................................................69  
(Power ON/OFF), (Volume adjustment), (Audio sound adjustment),  
(Sound quality adjustment), (Volume balance adjustment), (AudioPilot™),  
(Centerpoint®), (Rear seat-optimized (With Rear Entertainment System)  
(Mazda CX-9 only)), (Surround)  
l Operating the Radio ......................................................................73  
(Radio ON), (Band selection), (Tuning), (Manual tuning), (Seek tuning),  
(Scan tuning), (Preset channel tuning), (Auto memory tuning),  
(Audio Sound Adjustment), (Satellite Radio (SAT))  
l Operating the In-Dash CD Changer..............................................76  
(Inserting the CD), (During CD playback), (During MP3 CD playback),  
(Normal insertion), (Inserting CDs into desired tray number),  
(Multiple insertion), (Normal ejection),  
(Ejecting CDs from desired tray number), (Multiple ejection),  
(Playing), (Fast-forward/Reverse), (Track search), (Disc search),  
(Folder search (during MP3 CD playback)), (Music scan), (Repeat play),  
(Audio sound adjustment), (Operating tips for audio control switch),  
(Safety Certification)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
61  
Audio Operation  
Operating Tips for Audio system  
Signals from an FM transmitter are similar to  
beams of light because they do not bend  
around corners, but they do reflect.  
n Radio Reception  
AM characteristics  
AM signals bend around such things as  
buildings or mountains and bounce off the  
ionosphere. Therefore, they can reach  
longer distances than FM signals. Because  
of this, two stations may sometimes be  
picked up on the same frequency at the  
same time.  
Unlike AM signals, FM signals cannot travel  
beyond the horizon. Therefore, FM stations  
cannot be received at the great distances  
possible with AM reception.  
Ionosphere  
FM wave  
AM wave  
Ionosphere  
FM wave  
100—200 km (60—120 miles)  
Atmospheric conditions can also affect FM  
reception. High humidity will cause poor  
reception. However, cloudy days may pro-  
vide better reception than clear days.  
Station 1  
Station 2  
FM characteristics  
An FM broadcast range is usually about 40–  
50 km (25–30 miles) from the source.  
Because of extra coding needed to break the  
sound into two channels, stereo FM has  
even less range than monaural (non-stereo)  
FM.  
Multipath noise  
Since FM signals can be reflected by  
obstructions, it is possible to receive both the  
direct signal and the reflected signal at the  
same time. This causes a slight delay in  
reception and may be heard as a broken  
sound or a distortion. This problem may also  
be encountered when in close proximity to  
the transmitter.  
FM Station  
40—50km  
(25—30 miles)  
Reflected wave  
Direct  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
62  
Flutter/Skip noise  
Strong signal noise  
Signals from an FM transmitter move in  
straight lines and become weak in valleys  
between tall buildings, mountains, and other  
obstacles. When a vehicle passes through  
such an area, the reception conditions may  
change suddenly, resulting in annoying  
noise.  
This occurs very close to a transmitter tower.  
The broadcast signals are extremely strong,  
so the result is noise and sound breakup at  
the radio receiver.  
Station drift noise  
When a vehicle reaches the area of two  
strong stations broadcasting at similar fre-  
quencies, the original station may be tempo-  
rarily lost and the second station picked up.  
At this time there will be some noise from  
this disturbance.  
Weak signal noise  
In suburban areas, broadcast signals  
become weak because of distance from the  
transmitter. Reception in such fringe areas is  
characterized by sound breakup.  
Station 2  
Station 1  
88.1 MHz  
88.3 MHz  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
63  
l Do not use non-conventional discs such as  
heart-shaped, octagonal discs, etc. The  
disc may not eject resulting in a  
malfunction.  
n Operating Tips for In-Dash CD  
Changer  
Condensation phenomenon  
Immediately after turning on the heater  
when the vehicle is cold, the CD or optical  
components (prism and lens) in the In-dash  
CD changer may become clouded with  
condensation. At this time, the CD will eject  
immediately when placed in the unit. A  
clouded CD can be corrected simply by  
wiping it with a soft cloth. Clouded optical  
components will clear naturally in about an  
hour. Wait for normal operation to return  
before attempting to use the unit.  
l If the memory portion of the CD is  
transparent or translucent, do not use the  
disc.  
Handling the In-dash CD changer  
The following precautions should be  
observed.  
l Do not spill any liquid on the audio system.  
Transparent  
l A new CD may have rough edges on its  
inner and outer perimeters. If a disc with  
rough edges is used, proper setting will not  
be possible and the In-dash CD changer  
will not play the CD. In addition, the disc  
may not eject resulting in a malfunction.  
Remove the rough edges in advance by  
using a ball-point pen or pencil as shown  
below. To remove the rough edges, rub the  
side of the pen or pencil against the inner  
and outer perimeter of the CD.  
l Do not insert any objects, other than CDs,  
into the slot.  
l The CD revolves at high speed within the  
unit. Defective (cracked or badly bent) CDs  
should never be used.  
l When driving over uneven surfaces,  
the sound may jump.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
64  
l Use discs that have been legitimately  
produced. If illegally-copied discs such as  
pirated discs are used, the system may not  
operate properly.  
Handling the In-dash CD changer  
l This unit may not be able to play certain  
CD-R/CD-RWs made using a computer or  
music CD recorder due to disc  
l Be sure never to touch the signal surface  
when handling the CDs. Pick up a CD by  
grasping the outer edge or the edge of the  
hole and the outer edge.  
characteristics, scratches, smudges, dirt,  
etc., or due to dust or condensation on the  
lens inside the unit.  
l Storing CDs in the vehicle exposed to  
direct sunlight or high temperature may  
damage the CD-R/CD-RWs, and make  
them unplayable.  
l CD-R/CD-RWexceeding 700 MB cannot  
be played.  
l This unit may not be able to play certain  
discs made using a computer due to the  
application (writing software) setting used.  
(For details, consult the store where the  
application was purchased.)  
l Do not stick paper or tape on the CD.  
Avoid scratching the reverse side (the side  
without a label). The disc may not eject  
resulting in a malfunction.  
l It is possible that certain text data, such as  
titles, recorded on a CD-R/CD-RW may  
not be displayed when musical data (CD-  
DA) is playing.  
l Dust, finger smudges, and dirt can  
decrease the amount of light reflected from  
the signal surface, thus affecting sound  
quality. If the CD should become soiled,  
gently wipe it with a soft cloth from the  
center of the CD to the edge.  
l The period from when a CD-RWis inserted  
to when it begins playing is longer than a  
normal CD or CD-R.  
l Completely read the instruction manual  
and cautions for CD-R/CD-RWs.  
l Do not use record sprays, antistatic  
agents, or household spray cleaners.  
Volatile chemicals such as benzine and  
thinner can also damage the surface of the  
CD and must not be used. Anything that  
can damage, warp, or fog plastic should  
never be used to clean CDs.  
l Do not use discs with cellophane tape  
adhering, partially peeled off labels, or  
adhesive material exuding from the edges  
of the CD label. Also, do not use discs with  
a commercially-available CD-R label  
affixed. The disc may not eject resulting in  
a malfunction.  
l Insert discs one by one. If two discs are  
inserted at the same time, the system may  
not operate properly.  
l The In-dash CD changer ejects the CD if  
the CD is inserted upside down. Also dirty  
and/or defective CDs may be ejected.  
l Do not insert any disc with a peel-off seal  
affixed to it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
65  
n Operating tips for MP3  
CAUTION  
NOTE  
This unit can only play MP3 files that have  
an MP3 file extension (.mp3) attached.  
Do not attach an MP3 file extension to  
any other type file as it could cause noise  
to be emitted or a malfunction in the unit.  
Supply of this product only conveys a  
license for private, non-commercial use  
and does not convey a license nor imply  
any right to use this product in any  
commercial (i.e. revenue-generating) real  
time broadcasting (terrestrial, satellite,  
cable and/or any other media),  
Specialized glossary  
MP3  
broadcasting/streaming via the Internet,  
intranets and/or other networks or in other  
electronic content distribution systems,  
such as pay-audio or audio-ondemand  
applications. An independent license for  
such use is required. For details, please  
visit http://www.mp3licensing.com.  
Abbreviation for “MPEG Audio Layer 3”.  
A technical standard for audio compression  
as decided by an ISO (International  
Organization for Standardization) MPEG  
working group.  
Use of MP3 allows for audio data to be  
compressed to approximately a tenth of the  
source data size.  
l This audio system handles MP3 files that  
have been recorded on CD-R/CDRW/CD-  
ROMs. Discs that have been recorded  
using the following formats can be played:  
ISO 9660  
An international standard for logical  
formatting of CD-ROM files and folders.  
It is divided into three separate levels based  
on differences in file naming procedures,  
data configuration and other characteristics.  
• ISO9660 level 1  
• ISO 9660 level 2  
• Joliet extended format  
• Romeo extended format  
Bit rate  
Refers to the volume of data per second,  
expressed in bps (bits per second).  
Generally, the larger the number of the  
transfer bit rate when compressing an MP3  
file, the more information regarding musical  
reproduction it carries, and therefore the  
better the sound quality.  
l This unit handles MP3 files conforming to  
the MP3 format containing both header  
frames and data frames.  
l If a disc has both music data (CD-DA) and  
MP3 files, playback of the two file types  
differs depending on how the disc was  
recorded.  
Packet writing  
l Packet written discs cannot be played on  
this unit.  
A general term for the method, similar to that  
used for floppy discs or hard drives, of  
recording the required file in a single  
increment on a CD-R and similar.  
l This unit does not play CDs recorded  
using MP3i (MP3 interactive), MP3 PRO  
and RIFF MP3 formats.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
66  
n CD-TEXT  
Music CDs are available in which separate  
music data including album/title names,  
music name, artist name, and other textual  
information can be recorded. The data stan-  
dard for recording textual information to  
these kinds of music CDs is termed CD-  
TEXT.  
As for this audio unit, textual information  
(Track/artist information), which can be  
recorded on individual track regions,  
appears on the display. Textual information  
(Album/artist and other information), which  
can be recorded to regions related to the  
entire CD, does not appear on the display.  
There are two regions of a CD where textual  
information can be recorded which include  
regions related to the entire CD (Attributes  
recorded for the entire CD) and individual  
track regions (Attributes recorded for individ-  
ual tracks).  
Unless all the textual information is input in  
one-byte characters, a dotted line (----) will  
appear in place of the textual information,  
even if one of the characters is not a one-  
byte character (Two-byte character).  
Textual information recording attributes for  
the entire CD.  
Textual information does not appear  
on the display.  
CD-TEXT  
Album/artist information  
Textual information recording attributes for  
each track.  
Textual information such  
01 Track (Track/artist information 1)  
02 Track (Track/artist information 2)  
as "ABCDEFG" appears in  
the display.  
Textual information such  
as "HIJKLMN" appears in  
the display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
67  
Operating Tips for Display  
n Do not place any objects on the dashboard. If you drop any objects onto  
the dashboard or spill liquid on it, it may result in system malfunction.  
n Be careful not to pinch your hands or fingers when the liquid crystal  
display is closed.  
n Do not open/close the liquid crystal display manually. It may damage the  
equipment.  
l The liquid crystal display may not open if the power supply had been interrupted due to the  
vehicle battery being disconnected.  
l If the liquid crystal display stays open/closed (or partly opened) and does not move when  
the liquid crystal display is pressed, turn the ignition switch and then on again. Then try the  
open/close operation again. If the liquid crystal display still does not move, contact an  
Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Beep sound and voice guidance restrictions while  
using Bluetooth Hands-Free (Mazda CX-9 only)  
The beep sound and voice guidance related to the audio operation are not heard while a  
Bluetooth Hands-Free is being used.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
68  
Power/Volume/Sound Controls  
Power / Volume dial  
Mazda CX-9  
AUDIO button  
MEDIA button CD button  
CD button MEDIA button  
Mazda CX-7  
Power / Volume dial  
Audio button  
n Power ON/OFF  
Turn the ignition switch to the ACC or ON position.  
Press the power/volume dial to turn the audio system on.  
Press the power/volume dial again to turn the audio system off.  
Note  
To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the audio system on for a long  
period of time when the engine is not running.  
n Volume adjustment  
To adjust the volume, turn the power/volume dial.  
Turn the power/volume dial to the right to increase volume, to the left to decrease it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
69  
n Audio sound adjustment  
(Mazda CX-9)  
1.Press the desired button corresponding to one of the following modes.  
• Audio button (AUDIO): Audio mode  
• CD button (CD):  
CD mode  
• MEDIA button (MEDIA): Image and Sound playback is possible using a portable video  
player connected to an external input terminal.*  
The external input terminal is not equipped on your vehicle because it is not standard equipment.  
*
2.Select the (SOUND) on-screen button to display the sound adjustment screen.  
3.Select the on-screen button to display the sound adjustment screen (AudioPilot™,  
Centerpoint®, Rear seat-optimized).  
Select the  
on-  
screen  
button.  
(Mazda CX-7)  
1.Press the desired button corresponding to one of the following modes.  
• Audio button (AUDIO): Audio mode  
• CD button (CD):  
CD mode  
• MEDIA button (MEDIA): Image and Sound playback is possible using a portable video  
player connected to an external input terminal.*  
*The external input terminal is not equipped on your vehicle because it is not standard  
equipment.  
2.Select the (SOUND) on -screen button to display the sound adjustment screen.  
n Sound quality adjustment  
TREB (treble sound)  
Select the  
BASS (low pitch sound)  
Select the on-screen button to increase bass, and  
on-screen button to increase treble, and  
to decrease.  
to decrease.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
70  
n Volume balance adjustment  
Front/back volume balance  
Select the FRONT on-screen button  
to increase the volume to the back.  
to increase the volume at the front, and REAR  
to increase the volume to the right, and LEFT  
Left/right volume balance  
Select the RIGHT on-screen button  
increase the volume to the left.  
to  
Note  
l Pressing an on-screen adjustment button for 0.5 seconds or more progressively changes  
the adjustment range towards +/–, up/down, or left/right.  
l While an adjustment button is selected in this manner, the level indicator will momentarily  
stop at the medium range position and a beep sound will be heard before proceeding.  
l Select the  
on-screen button to reset bass, treble, and balance.  
l To return to the previous screen, select the  
on-screen button.  
n AudioPilot™  
AudioPilot automatically adjusts audio volume and sound quality in accordance with the level  
of noise entering the vehicle interior while driving. When AudioPilot is turned ON, the system  
automatically calculates the conditions for optimum hearing of sound which may be difficult to  
hear depending on exterior noise.  
(Mazda CX-9)  
ON  
Select the AUDIOPILOT on-screen  
button when AudioPilot is on. Select the  
OFF  
AUDIOPILOT on-screen  
(Mazda CX-7)  
button when AudioPilot is off.  
Each time the  
on-screen button is selected, the Audio Pilot turns on and off.  
AudioPilot™ is a registered trademark of Bose Corporation.  
n Centerpoint®  
Centerpoint offers you the experience of 5.1 channel surround sound in your vehicle even  
with your conventional 2 channel sound.  
(Mazda CX-9)  
ON  
Select the Centerpoint on-screen  
button when Centerpoint is on. Select the Centerpoint  
OFF  
on-screen  
(Mazda CX-7)  
button when Centerpoint is off.  
When Centerpoint is on, the true surround sound effect of Centerpoint can be adjusted to any  
one of five level between minimum and maximam enhancement.  
Note  
l Centerpoint does not work with AM/FM/SIRIUS/AUX.  
l Centerpoint operates only with a 2-channel stereo CD. Poor sound quality in the audio  
signal playback could result from playing highly compressed audio such as MP3 with  
Centerpoint operating.  
l
If a CD or a DVD is inserted in the Rear Entertainment System main unit and selected as an audio  
source, and the CD or DVD audio is 5.1 DolbyDigital/DTS audio, Centerpoint cannot be selected.  
(Mazda CX-9 only)  
Centerpoint® is a registered trademark of Bose Corporation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
71  
n Rear seat-optimized (With Rear Entertainment System) (Mazda CX-9 only)  
The rear seat-optimized function allows passengers to optimize the audio output to the rear  
for a more pleasurable acoustic field.  
ON  
Select the REAR SEAT-OPTIMIZED on-screen  
button to increase the surround effect to  
OFF  
the rear seat. Select the REAR SEAT-OPTIMIZED on-screen  
round effect to all seats.  
button to apply the sur-  
Note  
Rear seat-optimized is only effective if a CD or a DVD is inserted in the Rear Entertainment  
System main unit and selected as an audio source, and the CD or DVD audio is 5.1 DolbyDigital/  
DTS audio.  
n Surround  
Centerpoint  
When Centerpoint is on, the true surround sound effect of Centerpoint can be adjusted to any  
one of five level between minimum and maximum enhancement.  
Indication  
Enhance change  
Minimum  
Low  
Medium  
High  
Maximum  
Rear seat-optimized (Mazda CX-9 only)  
When rear seat-optimized is on, the surround effect can be enjoyed at five separate levels.  
Indication  
Enhance change  
Minimum  
Low  
Medium  
High  
Maximum  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
72  
Operating the Radio  
Channel preset  
on-screen button  
Mazda CX-9  
Seek tuning button  
Band selector button  
Satellite button  
Scan button  
on-screen button  
Mazda CX-7  
Band selector button  
Satellite button  
Seek tuning  
button  
Channel preset  
on-screen button  
Scan button  
on-screen button  
n Radio ON  
Press a band selector button (FM/AM) to turn the radio on.  
n Band selection  
Successively pressing the band selector button (FM/AM) switches the bands as follows:  
FM1 FM2 AM.  
The selected mode will be indicated. If FM stereo is being received, STEREO will be dis-  
played.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
73  
n Tuning  
The radio has the following tuning methods: Manual, Seek, Scan, Preset channel, and Auto  
memory tuning. The easiest way to tune stations is to set them on preset channels.  
Note  
l If the FM broadcast signal becomes weak, reception automatically changes from STEREO  
to MONO for reduced noise, and the STEREO indicator will go out.  
l To clear the information, press the NAVI button.  
l If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows or the battery is disconnected), the preset  
channels will be canceled.  
n Manual tuning  
Pressing the seek tuning button will change the frequency higher or lower.  
n Seek tuning  
Pressing and holding the seek tuning button (  
or lower frequency automatically.  
,
) will cause the tuner to seek a higher  
Note  
If you continue to press and hold the button, the frequency will continue changing without  
stopping.  
n Scan tuning  
Press the (SCAN) button to automatically sample strong stations.  
Scanning stops at each station for about 5 seconds. To hold a station, press the (SCAN)  
button again during this interval.  
n Preset channel tuning  
The 8 preset channels can be used to store 8 AM and 16 FM stations.  
1. To set a channel first select AM, FM1, or FM2. Tune to the desired station.  
2.Select any channel preset on-screen button for about 2 seconds until a beep sound is  
heard. The selected preset channel number and station frequency will be displayed. The  
station is now held in the memory.  
3.Repeat this operation for the other stations and bands you want to store. To tune one in the  
memory, select AM, FM1, or FM2 and then press its channel preset button. The station  
frequency and the channel number will be displayed.  
Note  
If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows or the battery is disconnected), the preset  
channels will be canceled.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
74  
n Auto memory tuning  
This is especially useful when driving in an area where the local stations are not known. Addi-  
tional AM/FM stations can be stored without disturbing the previously set channels.  
Select and hold the  
on-screen button for about 2 seconds until a beep sound is heard;  
the system will automatically scan and temporarily store up to 8 stations with the strongest  
frequencies in each selected band in that area.  
n Audio Sound Adjustment  
Refer to “Power/Volume/Sound Controls”.  
n Satellite Radio (SAT)  
Vehicles equipped with the separately purchased SIRIUS digital satellite radio unit have the  
ability to receive up to 100 channels of digital quality programming coast to coast via satellite.  
For information on use, read the Satellite Radio Kit manual accompanying the SIRIUS digital  
satellite radio unit. A subscription to SIRIUS digital satellite radio service is required (available  
in the U.S. - Except Alaska and Hawaii) to enable this feature once the separately purchased  
SIRIUS digital satellite radio unit has been installed. For subscription information or digital  
satellite radio technical issues contact SIRIUS directly at:  
-Web: www.siriusradio.com  
-Phone (24 hrs/day, 7 days/week): 888-539-SIRI (7474)  
-E-mail: [email protected]  
-Mailing Address: Sirius Satellite Radio  
1221 Avenue Of The Americas  
New York, NY 10020  
Attention: Customer Care  
Include your Sirius Radio ESN (Electronic Serial Number) when subscribing or requesting  
technical assistance. See the Satellite Radio Kit manual accompanying the SIRIUS unit for  
complete satellite radio activation procedures and information on how to display the ESN#.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
75  
Operating the In-Dash CD Changer  
Mazda CX-9  
Folder search on-screen button  
Disc on-screen button  
Track up button  
Scan button  
on-screen button  
on-screen button  
Track down button  
Mazda CX-7  
Track up button  
Track down button  
Scan button  
Disc on-screen  
button  
Folder search  
on-screen button  
on-screen button  
on-screen button  
n Inserting the CD  
The display must be open (lowered) to insert the CD.  
The CD must be label-side up when inserting. The auto-loading mechanism will set the CD  
and begin play. There will be a short lapse before play begins while the player reads the digi-  
tal signals on the CD.  
Note  
"IN" is displayed on the tray number for a CD that is inserted.  
n During CD playback  
The disc title, the track title, and the artist name will be displayed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
76  
n During MP3 CD playback  
The album title, the track title, the folder name, the file number, and the artist name will be dis-  
played.  
Note  
The CD will begin playback automatically after insertion. A CD cannot be inserted while the  
display reads "WAIT".  
n Normal insertion  
1.Press the (LOAD/EJECT) button.  
2.Press the  
on-screen button lightly.  
The display opens and "WAIT" is displayed.  
3.Lightly insert the CD after "IN" is displayed. The CD will be inserted and played  
automatically after the display is closed.  
Note  
l A CD cannot be inserted while "WAIT" is displayed. Wait until "IN" is displayed.  
l The CD loading operation cancels 15 seconds after "IN" is displayed or if the (LOAD/  
EJECT) button is pressed again.  
n Inserting CDs into desired tray number  
1.Press the (LOAD/EJECT) button.  
2.Press the desired tray number, then press the  
The display opens and "WAIT" is displayed.  
on-screen button lightly.  
Note  
The CD loading operation cancels if no button is pressed for about 30 seconds after the  
desired tray number is pressed, or if the (LOAD/EJECT) button is pressed again.  
3.Lightly insert the CD after "IN" is displayed. The CD will be inserted and played  
automatically after the display is closed  
Note  
l The CD loading operation cancels 15 seconds after the  
on-screen button is  
pressed or the (LOAD/EJECT) button is pressed again.  
l The CD cannot be inserted to the desired tray number if it is already occupied.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
77  
n Multiple insertion  
1.Press the (LOAD/EJECT) button.  
2.Press the  
on-screen button for 1.5 seconds or more.  
The display opens and "WAIT" is displayed.  
3.Lightly insert the CD after "IN" is displayed.  
4.When "IN" is displayed again, insert the next CD.  
Repeat this procedure for the number of CDs to be inserted (maximum of 6 including the  
CD in the tray).  
The CD will begin playback automatically after insertion and the display closes.  
Note  
The CD loading operation cancels 15 seconds after "IN" is displayed, or the (LOAD/EJECT)  
button is pressed again.  
n Normal ejection  
1.Press the (LOAD/EJECT) button.  
2.Press the  
on-screen button lightly.  
3.The CD ejects after the display is opened and the desired tray number flashes.  
4.The display closes automatically after the ejection is fully completed.  
Note  
If the CD is not removed from the slot within 15 seconds, it will be re-inserted. When this  
happens, or if the (LOAD/EJECT) button is pressed again, the CD ejecting operation will be  
canceled.  
n Ejecting CDs from desired tray number  
1.Press the (LOAD/EJECT) button.  
2.Press the desired CD tray number, then press  
on-screen button lightly.  
Note  
The CD ejecting operation cancels if the  
on-screen button is not pressed for  
about 30 seconds after the desired tray number is pressed, or if the (LOAD/EJECT) button is  
pressed again.  
3.The CD will be ejected automatically after the display is opened and the desired tray  
number flashes.  
Note  
l If only one CD is inserted in the tray, the display opens and the CD is ejected without  
pressing  
on-screen button.  
l If the CD is not removed from the slot within 15 seconds or if the (LOAD/EJECT) button is  
pressed, the CD ejecting operation will be canceled.  
4.The display closes after the CD is ejected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
78  
n Multiple ejection  
1.Press the (LOAD/EJECT) button.  
2.Press the  
on-screen button for 1.5 seconds or more.  
The CD ejects after the display is opened and the desired tray number flashes  
3.Pull out the CD.  
4.The next CD will be ejected automatically.  
This operation repeats until all the CDs are taken out.  
Note  
If the CD is not removed from the slot within 15 seconds or if the (LOAD/EJECT) button is  
pressed, the CD ejecting operation will be canceled.  
n Playing  
Press the (CD) button to start play when a CD is in the unit.  
If there is no CD in the unit when the (CD) button is pressed, “NO DISC”  
will flash on and off.  
The song information will be displayed during playback.  
Music CD  
MP3 CD  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
79  
Note  
l "-------" will be displayed for files without a file, track or other name input.  
l This unit can read English (including numerals), French, and Spanish one-byte characters.  
l The displayable number of characters on each title is a maximum of 64.  
(Music CDs)  
l Although textual information (Track/artist information) recorded to each track appears in the  
display, textual information (Album/artist information) recorded for the entire CD does not  
appear in the display.  
For details, refer to "CD-TEXT" (  
page 62).  
Select the on-screen button if the whole title cannot be displayed at one time. The  
screen changes to display the rest of the characters.  
n Fast-forward/Reverse  
Press the track up button (  
is heard.  
) to advance through a track at high speed until a beep sound  
Press the track down button (  
is heard.  
) to reverse through a track at high speed until a beep sound  
n Track search  
Press the track up button (  
) once to skip forward to the beginning of the next track.  
) once to skip back to the beginning of the current track.  
) during track search to skip back to the beginning of the  
Press the track down button (  
Press the track down button (  
previous track.  
n Disc search  
To change the disc, press any DISC on-screen button during playback.  
n Folder search (during MP3 CD playback)  
To change to the previous folder, select the  
button to advance to the next folder.  
on-screen button, or select the  
on-screen  
n Music scan  
This feature helps to find a program by playing about the first 10 seconds of each track.  
Press the (SCAN) button during play to start scan play operation (the track number will flash).  
Press the (SCAN) button once again to cancel scan play.  
Note  
If the unit is left in scan, normal play will resume where scan was selected.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
80  
n Repeat play  
During music CD playback  
1.Select the  
on-screen button during playback to play the current track repeatedly.  
2.Select the button again to cancel the repeat play.  
During MP3 CD playback  
(Track repeat)  
1.Select the  
on-screen button during playback to play the current track repeatedly.  
2.To cancel the repeat play, select the button again after 3 seconds.  
(Folder repeat)  
1.Select the  
on-screen button during playback, and then select the button again  
within 3 seconds to play the tracks in the current folder repeatedly.  
2.Select the button again to cancel the repeat play.  
Random play  
Tracks are randomly selected and played.  
During music CD playback  
1.Select the  
randomly.  
on-screen button during playback to play the tracks on the CD  
2.Select the button again to cancel the random play.  
During MP3 CD playback  
(Folder random)  
1.Select the  
randomly.  
on-screen button during playback to play the tracks in the folder  
2.To cancel the random play, press the button again after 3 seconds.  
(CD random)  
1.Select the  
on-screen button during playback, and then select the button again  
within 3 seconds to play the tracks on the CD randomly.  
2.Select the button again to cancel the random play.  
n Audio sound adjustment  
Refer to “Power/Volume/Sound Controls”.  
n Operating tips for audio control switch  
VOICE switch  
Refer to “Voice Recognition” (  
page 50).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
81  
Adjusting the Volume  
To increase the volume, pull up the volume switch.  
To decrease the volume, press down the volume switch.  
Changing the Source  
Press the mode switch (MODE) to change the audio source (FM1 radio > FM2 radio >  
AM radio > CD changer > SIRIUS > cyclical).  
Seek Switch  
When listening to the radio  
Pull up or press down the seek switch, the radio switches to the next/previous stored station  
in the order that it was stored (1-6).  
Pull up or press down the seek switch for about 2 seconds until a beep sound is heard to seek  
all usable stations at a higher or lower frequency whether programmed or not.  
When playing a CD  
Pull up the seek switch to skip to the next track.  
Press down the seek switch to repeat the current track.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
82  
n Safety Certification  
This CD player is made and tested to meet exacting safety standards. It meets FCC  
requirements and complies with safety performance standards of the U.S. Department of  
Health and Human Services.  
l This CD player should not be adjusted or repaired by anyone except  
qualified service personnel.  
If servicing is required, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.  
Cautions  
l Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than  
those specified herein may result in hazardous laser exposure. Never  
operate the CD player with the top case of the unit removed.  
l Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible  
for compliance could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
Note  
For CD player section:  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must  
accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Note  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital  
device, pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasona-  
ble protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment gener-  
ates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in  
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
83  
MEMO  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
84  
Contents  
Rear View Monitor  
n Rear View Monitor  
l Rear View Monitor Cautions..........................................................86  
l Rear View Parking Camera Location ............................................86  
l Switching to the Rear View Monitor Display..................................87  
l Displayable Range on the Screen.................................................87  
l Rear View Monitor Operation ........................................................88  
l Variance Between Actual Road Conditions and Displayed Image 89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
85  
Rear View Monitor  
Rear View Monitor Cautions  
The rear view monitor is a visual assist system when reversing the vehicle that provides  
images from the rear of the vehicle.  
The rear view monitor is only a visual assist device when reversing the vehicle. The images on  
the screen may be different from the actual conditions. Always drive carefully confirming the  
safety of the rear and the surrounding conditions by looking directly with your eyes. Reversing the  
vehicle by only looking at the screen may cause an accident or a collision with an object.  
Warning  
l
When the display is cold, images may course across the monitor or the screen  
and may be dimmer than usual, which could cause difficulty in confirming the  
surrounding conditions of the vehicle. Always drive carefully confirming the safety  
of the rear and the surrounding conditions by looking directly with your eyes.  
Cautions  
l Do not apply excessive force to the camera. The camera position and angle  
may deviate.  
l Do not disassemble, modify, or remove it as it may no longer be waterproof.  
l The camera cover is made of plastic. Do not apply degreasing agents,  
organic solvents, wax, or glass coating agents to the camera cover. If any  
are spilled on the cover, wipe off with a soft cloth immediately.  
l Do not rub the cover excessively, or polish it using an abrasive compound or  
a hard brush. The cover may be damaged affecting the image.  
Note  
l If water, snow, or mud is stuck on the camera lens, wipe it off using a soft cloth. If it cannot  
be wiped off, use a mild detergent.  
l If the camera temperature changes rapidly, such as by pouring hot water on it under cold  
temperature conditions, the rear view monitor may not operate correctly.  
Rear View Parking Camera Location  
Mazda CX-7  
Mazda CX-9  
Rear View Parking Camera  
Rear View Parking Camera  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
86  
Switching to the Rear View Monitor Display  
Shift the shift lever to R with the ignition switch in the ON position to switch the display to the  
rear view monitor display.  
Note  
When the shift lever is shifted from R to another shift lever position, the screen returns to the  
previous display.  
Displayable Range on the Screen  
The images on the screen may be different from the actual conditions.  
(Screen display)  
Both bumper ends are not displayed.  
(Actual view)  
Both bumper ends are not displayed.  
Object  
The figure is an example showing Mazda CX-9.  
Note  
l The displayable range varies depending on the vehicle and road conditions.  
l The displayable range is limited. Objects under the bumper or around the bumper ends  
cannot be displayed.  
l The distance appearing in the displayed image is different from the actual distance because  
the rear view parking camera is equipped with a specific lens.  
l Some optionally installed vehicle accessories may be picked up by the camera. Do not  
install any optional parts that can interfere with the camera view, such as illuminating parts  
or parts made of reflective material.  
l It may be difficult to see the display under the following conditions, however, it does not  
indicate a malfunction.  
• In darkened areas.  
• When the temperature around the lens is high/low.  
• When the camera is wet such as on a rainy day or during periods of high humidity.  
• When foreign material such as mud is stuck around the camera.  
• When the camera lens reflects sunlight or headlight beams.  
l If the camera picks up a high-intensity light such as sunlight reflected off the vehicle body, a  
bright belt (light line) may appear on the display. (Smear phenomenon)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
87  
Rear View Monitor Operation  
The operation of the rear view monitor when reversing the vehicle varies depending on the  
traffic, road, and vehicle conditions. The amount of steering and the timing also varies  
depending on conditions, so confirm the surrounding conditions directly with your eyes and  
steer the vehicle in accordance with the conditions.  
Be well aware of the above cautions prior to using the rear view monitor.  
Note  
Images displayed on the navigation display from the rear view parking camera are reversed  
images (mirror images).  
(1)Shift the shift lever to R to switch the display to the rear view monitor display.  
(2)Confirming the surrounding conditions, reverse the vehicle.  
(Screen display)  
(Actual view)  
The figure is an example showing Mazda CX-9.  
(3)When the shift lever is shifted from R to another shift lever position, the screen returns to  
the previous display.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
88  
Variance Between Actual Road  
Conditions and Displayed Image  
Some variance occurs between the actual road and the displayed road. Such variance in  
distance perspective could lead to an accident. Note the following conditions that may cause  
a variance in distance perspective.  
1 When the vehicle is tilted due to the weight of passengers and  
load  
When the vehicle rear is lowered, the object displayed on the screen appears farther than the  
actual distance.  
Object  
Variance  
The figure is an example showing Mazda CX-9.  
2 When there is a steep grade behind the vehicle  
When there is a steep upgrade (downgrade) behind the vehicle, the object displayed on the  
screen appears farther (downgrade: closer) than the actual distance.  
Appears  
farther than  
actual  
Appears  
closer than  
actual  
distance  
distance  
Object at actual position  
Object on screen  
Object on screen  
A: Distance between the vehicle and object displayed on the screen.  
B: Actual distance between the vehicle and object.  
Object at actual  
position  
The figure is an example showing Mazda CX-9.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
89  
MEMO  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
90  
Contents  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
n Bluetooth Hands-Free (Mazda CX-9 only)  
l Screen display of Bluetooth Hands-Free information ....................92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
91  
Bluetooth Hands-Free  
Screen display of Bluetooth Hands-Free information  
If the Bluetooth Hands-Free is operated, information such as radio wave reception conditions  
of the Bluetooth Hands-Free are displayed on the screen. For details, refer to the "Bluetooth  
Hands-Free" in the owner’s manual.  
Bluetooth Hands-Free information  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
92  

KTI Networks Switch KS 1080 User Manual
Land Pride Lawn Mower FDR15 User Manual
LG Electronics Cell Phone UX3300 User Manual
LG Electronics Microwave Oven LRM1260SB User Manual
Lincoln Electric Welding System IM826 A User Manual
Linksys Network Router WRT54G3G AT User Manual
Lucent Technologies Computer Monitor MDC 9000 User Manual
Makita Tablet Accessory HK1820L User Manual
Maytag Washer Dryer W10343072A User Manual
Melissa Indoor Furnishings 637 004 User Manual